Replace some xmalloc-family functions with XNEW-family ones
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / breakpoint.c
1 /* Everything about breakpoints, for GDB.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1986-2015 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GDB.
6
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
19
20 #include "defs.h"
21 #include "arch-utils.h"
22 #include <ctype.h>
23 #include "hashtab.h"
24 #include "symtab.h"
25 #include "frame.h"
26 #include "breakpoint.h"
27 #include "tracepoint.h"
28 #include "gdbtypes.h"
29 #include "expression.h"
30 #include "gdbcore.h"
31 #include "gdbcmd.h"
32 #include "value.h"
33 #include "command.h"
34 #include "inferior.h"
35 #include "infrun.h"
36 #include "gdbthread.h"
37 #include "target.h"
38 #include "language.h"
39 #include "gdb-demangle.h"
40 #include "filenames.h"
41 #include "annotate.h"
42 #include "symfile.h"
43 #include "objfiles.h"
44 #include "source.h"
45 #include "linespec.h"
46 #include "completer.h"
47 #include "gdb.h"
48 #include "ui-out.h"
49 #include "cli/cli-script.h"
50 #include "block.h"
51 #include "solib.h"
52 #include "solist.h"
53 #include "observer.h"
54 #include "memattr.h"
55 #include "ada-lang.h"
56 #include "top.h"
57 #include "valprint.h"
58 #include "jit.h"
59 #include "parser-defs.h"
60 #include "gdb_regex.h"
61 #include "probe.h"
62 #include "cli/cli-utils.h"
63 #include "continuations.h"
64 #include "stack.h"
65 #include "skip.h"
66 #include "ax-gdb.h"
67 #include "dummy-frame.h"
68 #include "interps.h"
69 #include "format.h"
70 #include "location.h"
71
72 /* readline include files */
73 #include "readline/readline.h"
74 #include "readline/history.h"
75
76 /* readline defines this. */
77 #undef savestring
78
79 #include "mi/mi-common.h"
80 #include "extension.h"
81
82 /* Enums for exception-handling support. */
83 enum exception_event_kind
84 {
85 EX_EVENT_THROW,
86 EX_EVENT_RETHROW,
87 EX_EVENT_CATCH
88 };
89
90 /* Prototypes for local functions. */
91
92 static void enable_delete_command (char *, int);
93
94 static void enable_once_command (char *, int);
95
96 static void enable_count_command (char *, int);
97
98 static void disable_command (char *, int);
99
100 static void enable_command (char *, int);
101
102 static void map_breakpoint_numbers (char *, void (*) (struct breakpoint *,
103 void *),
104 void *);
105
106 static void ignore_command (char *, int);
107
108 static int breakpoint_re_set_one (void *);
109
110 static void breakpoint_re_set_default (struct breakpoint *);
111
112 static void
113 create_sals_from_location_default (const struct event_location *location,
114 struct linespec_result *canonical,
115 enum bptype type_wanted);
116
117 static void create_breakpoints_sal_default (struct gdbarch *,
118 struct linespec_result *,
119 char *, char *, enum bptype,
120 enum bpdisp, int, int,
121 int,
122 const struct breakpoint_ops *,
123 int, int, int, unsigned);
124
125 static void decode_location_default (struct breakpoint *b,
126 const struct event_location *location,
127 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals);
128
129 static void clear_command (char *, int);
130
131 static void catch_command (char *, int);
132
133 static int can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *);
134
135 static void break_command_1 (char *, int, int);
136
137 static void mention (struct breakpoint *);
138
139 static struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *,
140 enum bptype,
141 const struct breakpoint_ops *);
142 static struct bp_location *add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *,
143 const struct symtab_and_line *);
144
145 /* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made
146 static. */
147 struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
148 struct symtab_and_line,
149 enum bptype,
150 const struct breakpoint_ops *);
151
152 static struct breakpoint *
153 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig,
154 enum bptype type,
155 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
156 int loc_enabled);
157
158 static void breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR, CORE_ADDR, int, int);
159
160 static CORE_ADDR adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
161 CORE_ADDR bpaddr,
162 enum bptype bptype);
163
164 static void describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *,
165 struct program_space *, CORE_ADDR,
166 struct obj_section *, int);
167
168 static int watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
169 struct bp_location *loc2);
170
171 static int breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl,
172 struct address_space *aspace,
173 CORE_ADDR addr);
174
175 static void breakpoints_info (char *, int);
176
177 static void watchpoints_info (char *, int);
178
179 static int breakpoint_1 (char *, int,
180 int (*) (const struct breakpoint *));
181
182 static int breakpoint_cond_eval (void *);
183
184 static void cleanup_executing_breakpoints (void *);
185
186 static void commands_command (char *, int);
187
188 static void condition_command (char *, int);
189
190 typedef enum
191 {
192 mark_inserted,
193 mark_uninserted
194 }
195 insertion_state_t;
196
197 static int remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *, insertion_state_t);
198 static int remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *, insertion_state_t);
199
200 static enum print_stop_action print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs);
201
202 static int watchpoint_check (void *);
203
204 static void maintenance_info_breakpoints (char *, int);
205
206 static int hw_breakpoint_used_count (void);
207
208 static int hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *);
209
210 static int hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except,
211 enum bptype type,
212 int *other_type_used);
213
214 static void hbreak_command (char *, int);
215
216 static void thbreak_command (char *, int);
217
218 static void enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *, enum bpdisp,
219 int count);
220
221 static void stop_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
222
223 static void stopin_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
224
225 static void stopat_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
226
227 static void tcatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
228
229 static void free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
230 static void incref_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
231 static void decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **loc);
232
233 static struct bp_location *allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt);
234
235 /* update_global_location_list's modes of operation wrt to whether to
236 insert locations now. */
237 enum ugll_insert_mode
238 {
239 /* Don't insert any breakpoint locations into the inferior, only
240 remove already-inserted locations that no longer should be
241 inserted. Functions that delete a breakpoint or breakpoints
242 should specify this mode, so that deleting a breakpoint doesn't
243 have the side effect of inserting the locations of other
244 breakpoints that are marked not-inserted, but should_be_inserted
245 returns true on them.
246
247 This behavior is useful is situations close to tear-down -- e.g.,
248 after an exec, while the target still has execution, but
249 breakpoint shadows of the previous executable image should *NOT*
250 be restored to the new image; or before detaching, where the
251 target still has execution and wants to delete breakpoints from
252 GDB's lists, and all breakpoints had already been removed from
253 the inferior. */
254 UGLL_DONT_INSERT,
255
256 /* May insert breakpoints iff breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now
257 claims breakpoints should be inserted now. */
258 UGLL_MAY_INSERT,
259
260 /* Insert locations now, irrespective of
261 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now. E.g., say all threads are
262 stopped right now, and the user did "continue". We need to
263 insert breakpoints _before_ resuming the target, but
264 UGLL_MAY_INSERT wouldn't insert them, because
265 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now returns false at that point,
266 as no thread is running yet. */
267 UGLL_INSERT
268 };
269
270 static void update_global_location_list (enum ugll_insert_mode);
271
272 static void update_global_location_list_nothrow (enum ugll_insert_mode);
273
274 static int is_hardware_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt);
275
276 static void insert_breakpoint_locations (void);
277
278 static void tracepoints_info (char *, int);
279
280 static void delete_trace_command (char *, int);
281
282 static void enable_trace_command (char *, int);
283
284 static void disable_trace_command (char *, int);
285
286 static void trace_pass_command (char *, int);
287
288 static void set_tracepoint_count (int num);
289
290 static int is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b);
291
292 static struct bp_location **get_first_locp_gte_addr (CORE_ADDR address);
293
294 /* Return 1 if B refers to a static tracepoint set by marker ("-m"), zero
295 otherwise. */
296
297 static int strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b);
298
299 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be inherited by all breakpoint_ops
300 that are implemented on top of software or hardware breakpoints
301 (user breakpoints, internal and momentary breakpoints, etc.). */
302 static struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
303
304 /* Internal breakpoints class type. */
305 static struct breakpoint_ops internal_breakpoint_ops;
306
307 /* Momentary breakpoints class type. */
308 static struct breakpoint_ops momentary_breakpoint_ops;
309
310 /* Momentary breakpoints for bp_longjmp and bp_exception class type. */
311 static struct breakpoint_ops longjmp_breakpoint_ops;
312
313 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in regular user created
314 breakpoints. */
315 struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
316
317 /* Breakpoints set on probes. */
318 static struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
319
320 /* Dynamic printf class type. */
321 struct breakpoint_ops dprintf_breakpoint_ops;
322
323 /* The style in which to perform a dynamic printf. This is a user
324 option because different output options have different tradeoffs;
325 if GDB does the printing, there is better error handling if there
326 is a problem with any of the arguments, but using an inferior
327 function lets you have special-purpose printers and sending of
328 output to the same place as compiled-in print functions. */
329
330 static const char dprintf_style_gdb[] = "gdb";
331 static const char dprintf_style_call[] = "call";
332 static const char dprintf_style_agent[] = "agent";
333 static const char *const dprintf_style_enums[] = {
334 dprintf_style_gdb,
335 dprintf_style_call,
336 dprintf_style_agent,
337 NULL
338 };
339 static const char *dprintf_style = dprintf_style_gdb;
340
341 /* The function to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to
342 call into the inferior. The value is simply a string that is
343 copied into the command, so it can be anything that GDB can
344 evaluate to a callable address, not necessarily a function name. */
345
346 static char *dprintf_function = "";
347
348 /* The channel to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to
349 call into the inferior; if a nonempty string, it will be passed to
350 the call as the first argument, with the format string as the
351 second. As with the dprintf function, this can be anything that
352 GDB knows how to evaluate, so in addition to common choices like
353 "stderr", this could be an app-specific expression like
354 "mystreams[curlogger]". */
355
356 static char *dprintf_channel = "";
357
358 /* True if dprintf commands should continue to operate even if GDB
359 has disconnected. */
360 static int disconnected_dprintf = 1;
361
362 /* A reference-counted struct command_line. This lets multiple
363 breakpoints share a single command list. */
364 struct counted_command_line
365 {
366 /* The reference count. */
367 int refc;
368
369 /* The command list. */
370 struct command_line *commands;
371 };
372
373 struct command_line *
374 breakpoint_commands (struct breakpoint *b)
375 {
376 return b->commands ? b->commands->commands : NULL;
377 }
378
379 /* Flag indicating that a command has proceeded the inferior past the
380 current breakpoint. */
381
382 static int breakpoint_proceeded;
383
384 const char *
385 bpdisp_text (enum bpdisp disp)
386 {
387 /* NOTE: the following values are a part of MI protocol and
388 represent values of 'disp' field returned when inferior stops at
389 a breakpoint. */
390 static const char * const bpdisps[] = {"del", "dstp", "dis", "keep"};
391
392 return bpdisps[(int) disp];
393 }
394
395 /* Prototypes for exported functions. */
396 /* If FALSE, gdb will not use hardware support for watchpoints, even
397 if such is available. */
398 static int can_use_hw_watchpoints;
399
400 static void
401 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
402 struct cmd_list_element *c,
403 const char *value)
404 {
405 fprintf_filtered (file,
406 _("Debugger's willingness to use "
407 "watchpoint hardware is %s.\n"),
408 value);
409 }
410
411 /* If AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE, gdb will not attempt to create pending breakpoints.
412 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE, gdb will automatically create pending breakpoints
413 for unrecognized breakpoint locations.
414 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO, gdb will query when breakpoints are unrecognized. */
415 static enum auto_boolean pending_break_support;
416 static void
417 show_pending_break_support (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
418 struct cmd_list_element *c,
419 const char *value)
420 {
421 fprintf_filtered (file,
422 _("Debugger's behavior regarding "
423 "pending breakpoints is %s.\n"),
424 value);
425 }
426
427 /* If 1, gdb will automatically use hardware breakpoints for breakpoints
428 set with "break" but falling in read-only memory.
429 If 0, gdb will warn about such breakpoints, but won't automatically
430 use hardware breakpoints. */
431 static int automatic_hardware_breakpoints;
432 static void
433 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
434 struct cmd_list_element *c,
435 const char *value)
436 {
437 fprintf_filtered (file,
438 _("Automatic usage of hardware breakpoints is %s.\n"),
439 value);
440 }
441
442 /* If on, GDB keeps breakpoints inserted even if the inferior is
443 stopped, and immediately inserts any new breakpoints as soon as
444 they're created. If off (default), GDB keeps breakpoints off of
445 the target as long as possible. That is, it delays inserting
446 breakpoints until the next resume, and removes them again when the
447 target fully stops. This is a bit safer in case GDB crashes while
448 processing user input. */
449 static int always_inserted_mode = 0;
450
451 static void
452 show_always_inserted_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
453 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
454 {
455 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s.\n"),
456 value);
457 }
458
459 /* See breakpoint.h. */
460
461 int
462 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now (void)
463 {
464 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()))
465 {
466 /* If breakpoints are global, they should be inserted even if no
467 thread under gdb's control is running, or even if there are
468 no threads under GDB's control yet. */
469 return 1;
470 }
471 else if (target_has_execution)
472 {
473 struct thread_info *tp;
474
475 if (always_inserted_mode)
476 {
477 /* The user wants breakpoints inserted even if all threads
478 are stopped. */
479 return 1;
480 }
481
482 if (threads_are_executing ())
483 return 1;
484
485 /* Don't remove breakpoints yet if, even though all threads are
486 stopped, we still have events to process. */
487 ALL_NON_EXITED_THREADS (tp)
488 if (tp->resumed
489 && tp->suspend.waitstatus_pending_p)
490 return 1;
491 }
492 return 0;
493 }
494
495 static const char condition_evaluation_both[] = "host or target";
496
497 /* Modes for breakpoint condition evaluation. */
498 static const char condition_evaluation_auto[] = "auto";
499 static const char condition_evaluation_host[] = "host";
500 static const char condition_evaluation_target[] = "target";
501 static const char *const condition_evaluation_enums[] = {
502 condition_evaluation_auto,
503 condition_evaluation_host,
504 condition_evaluation_target,
505 NULL
506 };
507
508 /* Global that holds the current mode for breakpoint condition evaluation. */
509 static const char *condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_auto;
510
511 /* Global that we use to display information to the user (gets its value from
512 condition_evaluation_mode_1. */
513 static const char *condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_auto;
514
515 /* Translate a condition evaluation mode MODE into either "host"
516 or "target". This is used mostly to translate from "auto" to the
517 real setting that is being used. It returns the translated
518 evaluation mode. */
519
520 static const char *
521 translate_condition_evaluation_mode (const char *mode)
522 {
523 if (mode == condition_evaluation_auto)
524 {
525 if (target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
526 return condition_evaluation_target;
527 else
528 return condition_evaluation_host;
529 }
530 else
531 return mode;
532 }
533
534 /* Discovers what condition_evaluation_auto translates to. */
535
536 static const char *
537 breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode (void)
538 {
539 return translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode);
540 }
541
542 /* Return true if GDB should evaluate breakpoint conditions or false
543 otherwise. */
544
545 static int
546 gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p (void)
547 {
548 const char *mode = breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ();
549
550 return (mode == condition_evaluation_host);
551 }
552
553 void _initialize_breakpoint (void);
554
555 /* Are we executing breakpoint commands? */
556 static int executing_breakpoint_commands;
557
558 /* Are overlay event breakpoints enabled? */
559 static int overlay_events_enabled;
560
561 /* See description in breakpoint.h. */
562 int target_exact_watchpoints = 0;
563
564 /* Walk the following statement or block through all breakpoints.
565 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE does so even if the statement deletes the
566 current breakpoint. */
567
568 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS(B) for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next)
569
570 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE(B,TMP) \
571 for (B = breakpoint_chain; \
572 B ? (TMP=B->next, 1): 0; \
573 B = TMP)
574
575 /* Similar iterator for the low-level breakpoints. SAFE variant is
576 not provided so update_global_location_list must not be called
577 while executing the block of ALL_BP_LOCATIONS. */
578
579 #define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS(B,BP_TMP) \
580 for (BP_TMP = bp_location; \
581 BP_TMP < bp_location + bp_location_count && (B = *BP_TMP); \
582 BP_TMP++)
583
584 /* Iterates through locations with address ADDRESS for the currently selected
585 program space. BP_LOCP_TMP points to each object. BP_LOCP_START points
586 to where the loop should start from.
587 If BP_LOCP_START is a NULL pointer, the macro automatically seeks the
588 appropriate location to start with. */
589
590 #define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR(BP_LOCP_TMP, BP_LOCP_START, ADDRESS) \
591 for (BP_LOCP_START = BP_LOCP_START == NULL ? get_first_locp_gte_addr (ADDRESS) : BP_LOCP_START, \
592 BP_LOCP_TMP = BP_LOCP_START; \
593 BP_LOCP_START \
594 && (BP_LOCP_TMP < bp_location + bp_location_count \
595 && (*BP_LOCP_TMP)->address == ADDRESS); \
596 BP_LOCP_TMP++)
597
598 /* Iterator for tracepoints only. */
599
600 #define ALL_TRACEPOINTS(B) \
601 for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next) \
602 if (is_tracepoint (B))
603
604 /* Chains of all breakpoints defined. */
605
606 struct breakpoint *breakpoint_chain;
607
608 /* Array is sorted by bp_location_compare - primarily by the ADDRESS. */
609
610 static struct bp_location **bp_location;
611
612 /* Number of elements of BP_LOCATION. */
613
614 static unsigned bp_location_count;
615
616 /* Maximum alignment offset between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS and
617 ADDRESS for the current elements of BP_LOCATION which get a valid
618 result from bp_location_has_shadow. You can use it for roughly
619 limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATION to scan for shadow bytes for
620 an address you need to read. */
621
622 static CORE_ADDR bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max;
623
624 /* Maximum offset plus alignment between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS
625 + bp_target_info.SHADOW_LEN and ADDRESS for the current elements of
626 BP_LOCATION which get a valid result from bp_location_has_shadow.
627 You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATION to
628 scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read. */
629
630 static CORE_ADDR bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max;
631
632 /* The locations that no longer correspond to any breakpoint, unlinked
633 from bp_location array, but for which a hit may still be reported
634 by a target. */
635 VEC(bp_location_p) *moribund_locations = NULL;
636
637 /* Number of last breakpoint made. */
638
639 static int breakpoint_count;
640
641 /* The value of `breakpoint_count' before the last command that
642 created breakpoints. If the last (break-like) command created more
643 than one breakpoint, then the difference between BREAKPOINT_COUNT
644 and PREV_BREAKPOINT_COUNT is more than one. */
645 static int prev_breakpoint_count;
646
647 /* Number of last tracepoint made. */
648
649 static int tracepoint_count;
650
651 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_set_cmdlist;
652 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_show_cmdlist;
653 struct cmd_list_element *save_cmdlist;
654
655 /* See declaration at breakpoint.h. */
656
657 struct breakpoint *
658 breakpoint_find_if (int (*func) (struct breakpoint *b, void *d),
659 void *user_data)
660 {
661 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
662
663 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
664 {
665 if (func (b, user_data) != 0)
666 break;
667 }
668
669 return b;
670 }
671
672 /* Return whether a breakpoint is an active enabled breakpoint. */
673 static int
674 breakpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *b)
675 {
676 return (b->enable_state == bp_enabled);
677 }
678
679 /* Set breakpoint count to NUM. */
680
681 static void
682 set_breakpoint_count (int num)
683 {
684 prev_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count;
685 breakpoint_count = num;
686 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("bpnum"), num);
687 }
688
689 /* Used by `start_rbreak_breakpoints' below, to record the current
690 breakpoint count before "rbreak" creates any breakpoint. */
691 static int rbreak_start_breakpoint_count;
692
693 /* Called at the start an "rbreak" command to record the first
694 breakpoint made. */
695
696 void
697 start_rbreak_breakpoints (void)
698 {
699 rbreak_start_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count;
700 }
701
702 /* Called at the end of an "rbreak" command to record the last
703 breakpoint made. */
704
705 void
706 end_rbreak_breakpoints (void)
707 {
708 prev_breakpoint_count = rbreak_start_breakpoint_count;
709 }
710
711 /* Used in run_command to zero the hit count when a new run starts. */
712
713 void
714 clear_breakpoint_hit_counts (void)
715 {
716 struct breakpoint *b;
717
718 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
719 b->hit_count = 0;
720 }
721
722 /* Allocate a new counted_command_line with reference count of 1.
723 The new structure owns COMMANDS. */
724
725 static struct counted_command_line *
726 alloc_counted_command_line (struct command_line *commands)
727 {
728 struct counted_command_line *result = XNEW (struct counted_command_line);
729
730 result->refc = 1;
731 result->commands = commands;
732
733 return result;
734 }
735
736 /* Increment reference count. This does nothing if CMD is NULL. */
737
738 static void
739 incref_counted_command_line (struct counted_command_line *cmd)
740 {
741 if (cmd)
742 ++cmd->refc;
743 }
744
745 /* Decrement reference count. If the reference count reaches 0,
746 destroy the counted_command_line. Sets *CMDP to NULL. This does
747 nothing if *CMDP is NULL. */
748
749 static void
750 decref_counted_command_line (struct counted_command_line **cmdp)
751 {
752 if (*cmdp)
753 {
754 if (--(*cmdp)->refc == 0)
755 {
756 free_command_lines (&(*cmdp)->commands);
757 xfree (*cmdp);
758 }
759 *cmdp = NULL;
760 }
761 }
762
763 /* A cleanup function that calls decref_counted_command_line. */
764
765 static void
766 do_cleanup_counted_command_line (void *arg)
767 {
768 decref_counted_command_line (arg);
769 }
770
771 /* Create a cleanup that calls decref_counted_command_line on the
772 argument. */
773
774 static struct cleanup *
775 make_cleanup_decref_counted_command_line (struct counted_command_line **cmdp)
776 {
777 return make_cleanup (do_cleanup_counted_command_line, cmdp);
778 }
779
780 \f
781 /* Return the breakpoint with the specified number, or NULL
782 if the number does not refer to an existing breakpoint. */
783
784 struct breakpoint *
785 get_breakpoint (int num)
786 {
787 struct breakpoint *b;
788
789 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
790 if (b->number == num)
791 return b;
792
793 return NULL;
794 }
795
796 \f
797
798 /* Mark locations as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports
799 evaluating conditions on its side. */
800
801 static void
802 mark_breakpoint_modified (struct breakpoint *b)
803 {
804 struct bp_location *loc;
805
806 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
807 evaluating conditions and if the user has
808 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
809 side. */
810 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
811 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
812 return;
813
814 if (!is_breakpoint (b))
815 return;
816
817 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
818 loc->condition_changed = condition_modified;
819 }
820
821 /* Mark location as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports
822 evaluating conditions on its side. */
823
824 static void
825 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (struct bp_location *loc)
826 {
827 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
828 evaluating conditions and if the user has
829 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
830 side. */
831 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
832 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
833
834 return;
835
836 if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner))
837 return;
838
839 loc->condition_changed = condition_modified;
840 }
841
842 /* Sets the condition-evaluation mode using the static global
843 condition_evaluation_mode. */
844
845 static void
846 set_condition_evaluation_mode (char *args, int from_tty,
847 struct cmd_list_element *c)
848 {
849 const char *old_mode, *new_mode;
850
851 if ((condition_evaluation_mode_1 == condition_evaluation_target)
852 && !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
853 {
854 condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_mode;
855 warning (_("Target does not support breakpoint condition evaluation.\n"
856 "Using host evaluation mode instead."));
857 return;
858 }
859
860 new_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode_1);
861 old_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode);
862
863 /* Flip the switch. Flip it even if OLD_MODE == NEW_MODE as one of the
864 settings was "auto". */
865 condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_mode_1;
866
867 /* Only update the mode if the user picked a different one. */
868 if (new_mode != old_mode)
869 {
870 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_tmp;
871 /* If the user switched to a different evaluation mode, we
872 need to synch the changes with the target as follows:
873
874 "host" -> "target": Send all (valid) conditions to the target.
875 "target" -> "host": Remove all the conditions from the target.
876 */
877
878 if (new_mode == condition_evaluation_target)
879 {
880 /* Mark everything modified and synch conditions with the
881 target. */
882 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
883 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
884 }
885 else
886 {
887 /* Manually mark non-duplicate locations to synch conditions
888 with the target. We do this to remove all the conditions the
889 target knows about. */
890 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
891 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->inserted)
892 loc->needs_update = 1;
893 }
894
895 /* Do the update. */
896 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
897 }
898
899 return;
900 }
901
902 /* Shows the current mode of breakpoint condition evaluation. Explicitly shows
903 what "auto" is translating to. */
904
905 static void
906 show_condition_evaluation_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
907 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
908 {
909 if (condition_evaluation_mode == condition_evaluation_auto)
910 fprintf_filtered (file,
911 _("Breakpoint condition evaluation "
912 "mode is %s (currently %s).\n"),
913 value,
914 breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ());
915 else
916 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Breakpoint condition evaluation mode is %s.\n"),
917 value);
918 }
919
920 /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP that is used by
921 bsearch. This comparison function only cares about addresses, unlike
922 the more general bp_location_compare function. */
923
924 static int
925 bp_location_compare_addrs (const void *ap, const void *bp)
926 {
927 struct bp_location *a = *(void **) ap;
928 struct bp_location *b = *(void **) bp;
929
930 if (a->address == b->address)
931 return 0;
932 else
933 return ((a->address > b->address) - (a->address < b->address));
934 }
935
936 /* Helper function to skip all bp_locations with addresses
937 less than ADDRESS. It returns the first bp_location that
938 is greater than or equal to ADDRESS. If none is found, just
939 return NULL. */
940
941 static struct bp_location **
942 get_first_locp_gte_addr (CORE_ADDR address)
943 {
944 struct bp_location dummy_loc;
945 struct bp_location *dummy_locp = &dummy_loc;
946 struct bp_location **locp_found = NULL;
947
948 /* Initialize the dummy location's address field. */
949 memset (&dummy_loc, 0, sizeof (struct bp_location));
950 dummy_loc.address = address;
951
952 /* Find a close match to the first location at ADDRESS. */
953 locp_found = bsearch (&dummy_locp, bp_location, bp_location_count,
954 sizeof (struct bp_location **),
955 bp_location_compare_addrs);
956
957 /* Nothing was found, nothing left to do. */
958 if (locp_found == NULL)
959 return NULL;
960
961 /* We may have found a location that is at ADDRESS but is not the first in the
962 location's list. Go backwards (if possible) and locate the first one. */
963 while ((locp_found - 1) >= bp_location
964 && (*(locp_found - 1))->address == address)
965 locp_found--;
966
967 return locp_found;
968 }
969
970 void
971 set_breakpoint_condition (struct breakpoint *b, const char *exp,
972 int from_tty)
973 {
974 xfree (b->cond_string);
975 b->cond_string = NULL;
976
977 if (is_watchpoint (b))
978 {
979 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
980
981 xfree (w->cond_exp);
982 w->cond_exp = NULL;
983 }
984 else
985 {
986 struct bp_location *loc;
987
988 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
989 {
990 xfree (loc->cond);
991 loc->cond = NULL;
992
993 /* No need to free the condition agent expression
994 bytecode (if we have one). We will handle this
995 when we go through update_global_location_list. */
996 }
997 }
998
999 if (*exp == 0)
1000 {
1001 if (from_tty)
1002 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint %d now unconditional.\n"), b->number);
1003 }
1004 else
1005 {
1006 const char *arg = exp;
1007
1008 /* I don't know if it matters whether this is the string the user
1009 typed in or the decompiled expression. */
1010 b->cond_string = xstrdup (arg);
1011 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
1012
1013 if (is_watchpoint (b))
1014 {
1015 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
1016
1017 innermost_block = NULL;
1018 arg = exp;
1019 w->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0);
1020 if (*arg)
1021 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
1022 w->cond_exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
1023 }
1024 else
1025 {
1026 struct bp_location *loc;
1027
1028 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1029 {
1030 arg = exp;
1031 loc->cond =
1032 parse_exp_1 (&arg, loc->address,
1033 block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
1034 if (*arg)
1035 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
1036 }
1037 }
1038 }
1039 mark_breakpoint_modified (b);
1040
1041 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1042 }
1043
1044 /* Completion for the "condition" command. */
1045
1046 static VEC (char_ptr) *
1047 condition_completer (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
1048 const char *text, const char *word)
1049 {
1050 const char *space;
1051
1052 text = skip_spaces_const (text);
1053 space = skip_to_space_const (text);
1054 if (*space == '\0')
1055 {
1056 int len;
1057 struct breakpoint *b;
1058 VEC (char_ptr) *result = NULL;
1059
1060 if (text[0] == '$')
1061 {
1062 /* We don't support completion of history indices. */
1063 if (isdigit (text[1]))
1064 return NULL;
1065 return complete_internalvar (&text[1]);
1066 }
1067
1068 /* We're completing the breakpoint number. */
1069 len = strlen (text);
1070
1071 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
1072 {
1073 char number[50];
1074
1075 xsnprintf (number, sizeof (number), "%d", b->number);
1076
1077 if (strncmp (number, text, len) == 0)
1078 VEC_safe_push (char_ptr, result, xstrdup (number));
1079 }
1080
1081 return result;
1082 }
1083
1084 /* We're completing the expression part. */
1085 text = skip_spaces_const (space);
1086 return expression_completer (cmd, text, word);
1087 }
1088
1089 /* condition N EXP -- set break condition of breakpoint N to EXP. */
1090
1091 static void
1092 condition_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
1093 {
1094 struct breakpoint *b;
1095 char *p;
1096 int bnum;
1097
1098 if (arg == 0)
1099 error_no_arg (_("breakpoint number"));
1100
1101 p = arg;
1102 bnum = get_number (&p);
1103 if (bnum == 0)
1104 error (_("Bad breakpoint argument: '%s'"), arg);
1105
1106 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
1107 if (b->number == bnum)
1108 {
1109 /* Check if this breakpoint has a "stop" method implemented in an
1110 extension language. This method and conditions entered into GDB
1111 from the CLI are mutually exclusive. */
1112 const struct extension_language_defn *extlang
1113 = get_breakpoint_cond_ext_lang (b, EXT_LANG_NONE);
1114
1115 if (extlang != NULL)
1116 {
1117 error (_("Only one stop condition allowed. There is currently"
1118 " a %s stop condition defined for this breakpoint."),
1119 ext_lang_capitalized_name (extlang));
1120 }
1121 set_breakpoint_condition (b, p, from_tty);
1122
1123 if (is_breakpoint (b))
1124 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
1125
1126 return;
1127 }
1128
1129 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
1130 }
1131
1132 /* Check that COMMAND do not contain commands that are suitable
1133 only for tracepoints and not suitable for ordinary breakpoints.
1134 Throw if any such commands is found. */
1135
1136 static void
1137 check_no_tracepoint_commands (struct command_line *commands)
1138 {
1139 struct command_line *c;
1140
1141 for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
1142 {
1143 int i;
1144
1145 if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1146 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command can "
1147 "only be used for tracepoints"));
1148
1149 for (i = 0; i < c->body_count; ++i)
1150 check_no_tracepoint_commands ((c->body_list)[i]);
1151
1152 /* Not that command parsing removes leading whitespace and comment
1153 lines and also empty lines. So, we only need to check for
1154 command directly. */
1155 if (strstr (c->line, "collect ") == c->line)
1156 error (_("The 'collect' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
1157
1158 if (strstr (c->line, "teval ") == c->line)
1159 error (_("The 'teval' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
1160 }
1161 }
1162
1163 /* Encapsulate tests for different types of tracepoints. */
1164
1165 static int
1166 is_tracepoint_type (enum bptype type)
1167 {
1168 return (type == bp_tracepoint
1169 || type == bp_fast_tracepoint
1170 || type == bp_static_tracepoint);
1171 }
1172
1173 int
1174 is_tracepoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
1175 {
1176 return is_tracepoint_type (b->type);
1177 }
1178
1179 /* A helper function that validates that COMMANDS are valid for a
1180 breakpoint. This function will throw an exception if a problem is
1181 found. */
1182
1183 static void
1184 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
1185 struct command_line *commands)
1186 {
1187 if (is_tracepoint (b))
1188 {
1189 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
1190 struct command_line *c;
1191 struct command_line *while_stepping = 0;
1192
1193 /* Reset the while-stepping step count. The previous commands
1194 might have included a while-stepping action, while the new
1195 ones might not. */
1196 t->step_count = 0;
1197
1198 /* We need to verify that each top-level element of commands is
1199 valid for tracepoints, that there's at most one
1200 while-stepping element, and that the while-stepping's body
1201 has valid tracing commands excluding nested while-stepping.
1202 We also need to validate the tracepoint action line in the
1203 context of the tracepoint --- validate_actionline actually
1204 has side effects, like setting the tracepoint's
1205 while-stepping STEP_COUNT, in addition to checking if the
1206 collect/teval actions parse and make sense in the
1207 tracepoint's context. */
1208 for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
1209 {
1210 if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1211 {
1212 if (b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint)
1213 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1214 "cannot be used for fast tracepoint"));
1215 else if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
1216 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1217 "cannot be used for static tracepoint"));
1218
1219 if (while_stepping)
1220 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1221 "can be used only once"));
1222 else
1223 while_stepping = c;
1224 }
1225
1226 validate_actionline (c->line, b);
1227 }
1228 if (while_stepping)
1229 {
1230 struct command_line *c2;
1231
1232 gdb_assert (while_stepping->body_count == 1);
1233 c2 = while_stepping->body_list[0];
1234 for (; c2; c2 = c2->next)
1235 {
1236 if (c2->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1237 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command cannot be nested"));
1238 }
1239 }
1240 }
1241 else
1242 {
1243 check_no_tracepoint_commands (commands);
1244 }
1245 }
1246
1247 /* Return a vector of all the static tracepoints set at ADDR. The
1248 caller is responsible for releasing the vector. */
1249
1250 VEC(breakpoint_p) *
1251 static_tracepoints_here (CORE_ADDR addr)
1252 {
1253 struct breakpoint *b;
1254 VEC(breakpoint_p) *found = 0;
1255 struct bp_location *loc;
1256
1257 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
1258 if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
1259 {
1260 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1261 if (loc->address == addr)
1262 VEC_safe_push(breakpoint_p, found, b);
1263 }
1264
1265 return found;
1266 }
1267
1268 /* Set the command list of B to COMMANDS. If breakpoint is tracepoint,
1269 validate that only allowed commands are included. */
1270
1271 void
1272 breakpoint_set_commands (struct breakpoint *b,
1273 struct command_line *commands)
1274 {
1275 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, commands);
1276
1277 decref_counted_command_line (&b->commands);
1278 b->commands = alloc_counted_command_line (commands);
1279 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1280 }
1281
1282 /* Set the internal `silent' flag on the breakpoint. Note that this
1283 is not the same as the "silent" that may appear in the breakpoint's
1284 commands. */
1285
1286 void
1287 breakpoint_set_silent (struct breakpoint *b, int silent)
1288 {
1289 int old_silent = b->silent;
1290
1291 b->silent = silent;
1292 if (old_silent != silent)
1293 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1294 }
1295
1296 /* Set the thread for this breakpoint. If THREAD is -1, make the
1297 breakpoint work for any thread. */
1298
1299 void
1300 breakpoint_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b, int thread)
1301 {
1302 int old_thread = b->thread;
1303
1304 b->thread = thread;
1305 if (old_thread != thread)
1306 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1307 }
1308
1309 /* Set the task for this breakpoint. If TASK is 0, make the
1310 breakpoint work for any task. */
1311
1312 void
1313 breakpoint_set_task (struct breakpoint *b, int task)
1314 {
1315 int old_task = b->task;
1316
1317 b->task = task;
1318 if (old_task != task)
1319 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1320 }
1321
1322 void
1323 check_tracepoint_command (char *line, void *closure)
1324 {
1325 struct breakpoint *b = closure;
1326
1327 validate_actionline (line, b);
1328 }
1329
1330 /* A structure used to pass information through
1331 map_breakpoint_numbers. */
1332
1333 struct commands_info
1334 {
1335 /* True if the command was typed at a tty. */
1336 int from_tty;
1337
1338 /* The breakpoint range spec. */
1339 char *arg;
1340
1341 /* Non-NULL if the body of the commands are being read from this
1342 already-parsed command. */
1343 struct command_line *control;
1344
1345 /* The command lines read from the user, or NULL if they have not
1346 yet been read. */
1347 struct counted_command_line *cmd;
1348 };
1349
1350 /* A callback for map_breakpoint_numbers that sets the commands for
1351 commands_command. */
1352
1353 static void
1354 do_map_commands_command (struct breakpoint *b, void *data)
1355 {
1356 struct commands_info *info = data;
1357
1358 if (info->cmd == NULL)
1359 {
1360 struct command_line *l;
1361
1362 if (info->control != NULL)
1363 l = copy_command_lines (info->control->body_list[0]);
1364 else
1365 {
1366 struct cleanup *old_chain;
1367 char *str;
1368
1369 str = xstrprintf (_("Type commands for breakpoint(s) "
1370 "%s, one per line."),
1371 info->arg);
1372
1373 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, str);
1374
1375 l = read_command_lines (str,
1376 info->from_tty, 1,
1377 (is_tracepoint (b)
1378 ? check_tracepoint_command : 0),
1379 b);
1380
1381 do_cleanups (old_chain);
1382 }
1383
1384 info->cmd = alloc_counted_command_line (l);
1385 }
1386
1387 /* If a breakpoint was on the list more than once, we don't need to
1388 do anything. */
1389 if (b->commands != info->cmd)
1390 {
1391 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, info->cmd->commands);
1392 incref_counted_command_line (info->cmd);
1393 decref_counted_command_line (&b->commands);
1394 b->commands = info->cmd;
1395 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1396 }
1397 }
1398
1399 static void
1400 commands_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
1401 struct command_line *control)
1402 {
1403 struct cleanup *cleanups;
1404 struct commands_info info;
1405
1406 info.from_tty = from_tty;
1407 info.control = control;
1408 info.cmd = NULL;
1409 /* If we read command lines from the user, then `info' will hold an
1410 extra reference to the commands that we must clean up. */
1411 cleanups = make_cleanup_decref_counted_command_line (&info.cmd);
1412
1413 if (arg == NULL || !*arg)
1414 {
1415 if (breakpoint_count - prev_breakpoint_count > 1)
1416 arg = xstrprintf ("%d-%d", prev_breakpoint_count + 1,
1417 breakpoint_count);
1418 else if (breakpoint_count > 0)
1419 arg = xstrprintf ("%d", breakpoint_count);
1420 else
1421 {
1422 /* So that we don't try to free the incoming non-NULL
1423 argument in the cleanup below. Mapping breakpoint
1424 numbers will fail in this case. */
1425 arg = NULL;
1426 }
1427 }
1428 else
1429 /* The command loop has some static state, so we need to preserve
1430 our argument. */
1431 arg = xstrdup (arg);
1432
1433 if (arg != NULL)
1434 make_cleanup (xfree, arg);
1435
1436 info.arg = arg;
1437
1438 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, do_map_commands_command, &info);
1439
1440 if (info.cmd == NULL)
1441 error (_("No breakpoints specified."));
1442
1443 do_cleanups (cleanups);
1444 }
1445
1446 static void
1447 commands_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
1448 {
1449 commands_command_1 (arg, from_tty, NULL);
1450 }
1451
1452 /* Like commands_command, but instead of reading the commands from
1453 input stream, takes them from an already parsed command structure.
1454
1455 This is used by cli-script.c to DTRT with breakpoint commands
1456 that are part of if and while bodies. */
1457 enum command_control_type
1458 commands_from_control_command (char *arg, struct command_line *cmd)
1459 {
1460 commands_command_1 (arg, 0, cmd);
1461 return simple_control;
1462 }
1463
1464 /* Return non-zero if BL->TARGET_INFO contains valid information. */
1465
1466 static int
1467 bp_location_has_shadow (struct bp_location *bl)
1468 {
1469 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
1470 return 0;
1471 if (!bl->inserted)
1472 return 0;
1473 if (bl->target_info.shadow_len == 0)
1474 /* BL isn't valid, or doesn't shadow memory. */
1475 return 0;
1476 return 1;
1477 }
1478
1479 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address
1480 MEMADDR, by replacing a memory breakpoint with its shadowed
1481 contents.
1482
1483 If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with the of
1484 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffer. Otherwise, a
1485 failed assertion internal error will be raised. */
1486
1487 static void
1488 one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte *readbuf, gdb_byte *writebuf,
1489 const gdb_byte *writebuf_org,
1490 ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len,
1491 struct bp_target_info *target_info,
1492 struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
1493 {
1494 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
1495 CORE_ADDR bp_addr = 0;
1496 int bp_size = 0;
1497 int bptoffset = 0;
1498
1499 if (!breakpoint_address_match (target_info->placed_address_space, 0,
1500 current_program_space->aspace, 0))
1501 {
1502 /* The breakpoint is inserted in a different address space. */
1503 return;
1504 }
1505
1506 /* Addresses and length of the part of the breakpoint that
1507 we need to copy. */
1508 bp_addr = target_info->placed_address;
1509 bp_size = target_info->shadow_len;
1510
1511 if (bp_addr + bp_size <= memaddr)
1512 {
1513 /* The breakpoint is entirely before the chunk of memory we are
1514 reading. */
1515 return;
1516 }
1517
1518 if (bp_addr >= memaddr + len)
1519 {
1520 /* The breakpoint is entirely after the chunk of memory we are
1521 reading. */
1522 return;
1523 }
1524
1525 /* Offset within shadow_contents. */
1526 if (bp_addr < memaddr)
1527 {
1528 /* Only copy the second part of the breakpoint. */
1529 bp_size -= memaddr - bp_addr;
1530 bptoffset = memaddr - bp_addr;
1531 bp_addr = memaddr;
1532 }
1533
1534 if (bp_addr + bp_size > memaddr + len)
1535 {
1536 /* Only copy the first part of the breakpoint. */
1537 bp_size -= (bp_addr + bp_size) - (memaddr + len);
1538 }
1539
1540 if (readbuf != NULL)
1541 {
1542 /* Verify that the readbuf buffer does not overlap with the
1543 shadow_contents buffer. */
1544 gdb_assert (target_info->shadow_contents >= readbuf + len
1545 || readbuf >= (target_info->shadow_contents
1546 + target_info->shadow_len));
1547
1548 /* Update the read buffer with this inserted breakpoint's
1549 shadow. */
1550 memcpy (readbuf + bp_addr - memaddr,
1551 target_info->shadow_contents + bptoffset, bp_size);
1552 }
1553 else
1554 {
1555 const unsigned char *bp;
1556 CORE_ADDR addr = target_info->reqstd_address;
1557 int placed_size;
1558
1559 /* Update the shadow with what we want to write to memory. */
1560 memcpy (target_info->shadow_contents + bptoffset,
1561 writebuf_org + bp_addr - memaddr, bp_size);
1562
1563 /* Determine appropriate breakpoint contents and size for this
1564 address. */
1565 bp = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (gdbarch, &addr, &placed_size);
1566
1567 /* Update the final write buffer with this inserted
1568 breakpoint's INSN. */
1569 memcpy (writebuf + bp_addr - memaddr, bp + bptoffset, bp_size);
1570 }
1571 }
1572
1573 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address MEMADDR,
1574 by replacing any memory breakpoints with their shadowed contents.
1575
1576 If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with any of
1577 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffers. Otherwise,
1578 a failed assertion internal error will be raised.
1579
1580 The range of shadowed area by each bp_location is:
1581 bl->address - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
1582 up to bl->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max
1583 The range we were requested to resolve shadows for is:
1584 memaddr ... memaddr + len
1585 Thus the safe cutoff boundaries for performance optimization are
1586 memaddr + len <= (bl->address
1587 - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max)
1588 and:
1589 bl->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr */
1590
1591 void
1592 breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte *readbuf, gdb_byte *writebuf,
1593 const gdb_byte *writebuf_org,
1594 ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len)
1595 {
1596 /* Left boundary, right boundary and median element of our binary
1597 search. */
1598 unsigned bc_l, bc_r, bc;
1599 size_t i;
1600
1601 /* Find BC_L which is a leftmost element which may affect BUF
1602 content. It is safe to report lower value but a failure to
1603 report higher one. */
1604
1605 bc_l = 0;
1606 bc_r = bp_location_count;
1607 while (bc_l + 1 < bc_r)
1608 {
1609 struct bp_location *bl;
1610
1611 bc = (bc_l + bc_r) / 2;
1612 bl = bp_location[bc];
1613
1614 /* Check first BL->ADDRESS will not overflow due to the added
1615 constant. Then advance the left boundary only if we are sure
1616 the BC element can in no way affect the BUF content (MEMADDR
1617 to MEMADDR + LEN range).
1618
1619 Use the BP_LOCATION_SHADOW_LEN_AFTER_ADDRESS_MAX safety
1620 offset so that we cannot miss a breakpoint with its shadow
1621 range tail still reaching MEMADDR. */
1622
1623 if ((bl->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max
1624 >= bl->address)
1625 && (bl->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max
1626 <= memaddr))
1627 bc_l = bc;
1628 else
1629 bc_r = bc;
1630 }
1631
1632 /* Due to the binary search above, we need to make sure we pick the
1633 first location that's at BC_L's address. E.g., if there are
1634 multiple locations at the same address, BC_L may end up pointing
1635 at a duplicate location, and miss the "master"/"inserted"
1636 location. Say, given locations L1, L2 and L3 at addresses A and
1637 B:
1638
1639 L1@A, L2@A, L3@B, ...
1640
1641 BC_L could end up pointing at location L2, while the "master"
1642 location could be L1. Since the `loc->inserted' flag is only set
1643 on "master" locations, we'd forget to restore the shadow of L1
1644 and L2. */
1645 while (bc_l > 0
1646 && bp_location[bc_l]->address == bp_location[bc_l - 1]->address)
1647 bc_l--;
1648
1649 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
1650
1651 for (bc = bc_l; bc < bp_location_count; bc++)
1652 {
1653 struct bp_location *bl = bp_location[bc];
1654 CORE_ADDR bp_addr = 0;
1655 int bp_size = 0;
1656 int bptoffset = 0;
1657
1658 /* bp_location array has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
1659 if (bl->owner->type == bp_none)
1660 warning (_("reading through apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
1661 bl->owner->number);
1662
1663 /* Performance optimization: any further element can no longer affect BUF
1664 content. */
1665
1666 if (bl->address >= bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
1667 && memaddr + len <= (bl->address
1668 - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max))
1669 break;
1670
1671 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
1672 continue;
1673
1674 one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (readbuf, writebuf, writebuf_org,
1675 memaddr, len, &bl->target_info, bl->gdbarch);
1676 }
1677 }
1678
1679 \f
1680
1681 /* Return true if BPT is either a software breakpoint or a hardware
1682 breakpoint. */
1683
1684 int
1685 is_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1686 {
1687 return (bpt->type == bp_breakpoint
1688 || bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
1689 || bpt->type == bp_dprintf);
1690 }
1691
1692 /* Return true if BPT is of any hardware watchpoint kind. */
1693
1694 static int
1695 is_hardware_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1696 {
1697 return (bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
1698 || bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint
1699 || bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint);
1700 }
1701
1702 /* Return true if BPT is of any watchpoint kind, hardware or
1703 software. */
1704
1705 int
1706 is_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1707 {
1708 return (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt)
1709 || bpt->type == bp_watchpoint);
1710 }
1711
1712 /* Returns true if the current thread and its running state are safe
1713 to evaluate or update watchpoint B. Watchpoints on local
1714 expressions need to be evaluated in the context of the thread that
1715 was current when the watchpoint was created, and, that thread needs
1716 to be stopped to be able to select the correct frame context.
1717 Watchpoints on global expressions can be evaluated on any thread,
1718 and in any state. It is presently left to the target allowing
1719 memory accesses when threads are running. */
1720
1721 static int
1722 watchpoint_in_thread_scope (struct watchpoint *b)
1723 {
1724 return (b->base.pspace == current_program_space
1725 && (ptid_equal (b->watchpoint_thread, null_ptid)
1726 || (ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, b->watchpoint_thread)
1727 && !is_executing (inferior_ptid))));
1728 }
1729
1730 /* Set watchpoint B to disp_del_at_next_stop, even including its possible
1731 associated bp_watchpoint_scope breakpoint. */
1732
1733 static void
1734 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (struct watchpoint *w)
1735 {
1736 struct breakpoint *b = &w->base;
1737
1738 if (b->related_breakpoint != b)
1739 {
1740 gdb_assert (b->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope);
1741 gdb_assert (b->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint == b);
1742 b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1743 b->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = b->related_breakpoint;
1744 b->related_breakpoint = b;
1745 }
1746 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1747 }
1748
1749 /* Extract a bitfield value from value VAL using the bit parameters contained in
1750 watchpoint W. */
1751
1752 static struct value *
1753 extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (struct watchpoint *w, struct value *val)
1754 {
1755 struct value *bit_val;
1756
1757 if (val == NULL)
1758 return NULL;
1759
1760 bit_val = allocate_value (value_type (val));
1761
1762 unpack_value_bitfield (bit_val,
1763 w->val_bitpos,
1764 w->val_bitsize,
1765 value_contents_for_printing (val),
1766 value_offset (val),
1767 val);
1768
1769 return bit_val;
1770 }
1771
1772 /* Assuming that B is a watchpoint:
1773 - Reparse watchpoint expression, if REPARSE is non-zero
1774 - Evaluate expression and store the result in B->val
1775 - Evaluate the condition if there is one, and store the result
1776 in b->loc->cond.
1777 - Update the list of values that must be watched in B->loc.
1778
1779 If the watchpoint disposition is disp_del_at_next_stop, then do
1780 nothing. If this is local watchpoint that is out of scope, delete
1781 it.
1782
1783 Even with `set breakpoint always-inserted on' the watchpoints are
1784 removed + inserted on each stop here. Normal breakpoints must
1785 never be removed because they might be missed by a running thread
1786 when debugging in non-stop mode. On the other hand, hardware
1787 watchpoints (is_hardware_watchpoint; processed here) are specific
1788 to each LWP since they are stored in each LWP's hardware debug
1789 registers. Therefore, such LWP must be stopped first in order to
1790 be able to modify its hardware watchpoints.
1791
1792 Hardware watchpoints must be reset exactly once after being
1793 presented to the user. It cannot be done sooner, because it would
1794 reset the data used to present the watchpoint hit to the user. And
1795 it must not be done later because it could display the same single
1796 watchpoint hit during multiple GDB stops. Note that the latter is
1797 relevant only to the hardware watchpoint types bp_read_watchpoint
1798 and bp_access_watchpoint. False hit by bp_hardware_watchpoint is
1799 not user-visible - its hit is suppressed if the memory content has
1800 not changed.
1801
1802 The following constraints influence the location where we can reset
1803 hardware watchpoints:
1804
1805 * target_stopped_by_watchpoint and target_stopped_data_address are
1806 called several times when GDB stops.
1807
1808 [linux]
1809 * Multiple hardware watchpoints can be hit at the same time,
1810 causing GDB to stop. GDB only presents one hardware watchpoint
1811 hit at a time as the reason for stopping, and all the other hits
1812 are presented later, one after the other, each time the user
1813 requests the execution to be resumed. Execution is not resumed
1814 for the threads still having pending hit event stored in
1815 LWP_INFO->STATUS. While the watchpoint is already removed from
1816 the inferior on the first stop the thread hit event is kept being
1817 reported from its cached value by linux_nat_stopped_data_address
1818 until the real thread resume happens after the watchpoint gets
1819 presented and thus its LWP_INFO->STATUS gets reset.
1820
1821 Therefore the hardware watchpoint hit can get safely reset on the
1822 watchpoint removal from inferior. */
1823
1824 static void
1825 update_watchpoint (struct watchpoint *b, int reparse)
1826 {
1827 int within_current_scope;
1828 struct frame_id saved_frame_id;
1829 int frame_saved;
1830
1831 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
1832 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
1833 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
1834 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
1835 return;
1836
1837 if (b->base.disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1838 return;
1839
1840 frame_saved = 0;
1841
1842 /* Determine if the watchpoint is within scope. */
1843 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
1844 within_current_scope = 1;
1845 else
1846 {
1847 struct frame_info *fi = get_current_frame ();
1848 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (fi);
1849 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (fi);
1850
1851 /* If we're at a point where the stack has been destroyed
1852 (e.g. in a function epilogue), unwinding may not work
1853 properly. Do not attempt to recreate locations at this
1854 point. See similar comments in watchpoint_check. */
1855 if (gdbarch_stack_frame_destroyed_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
1856 return;
1857
1858 /* Save the current frame's ID so we can restore it after
1859 evaluating the watchpoint expression on its own frame. */
1860 /* FIXME drow/2003-09-09: It would be nice if evaluate_expression
1861 took a frame parameter, so that we didn't have to change the
1862 selected frame. */
1863 frame_saved = 1;
1864 saved_frame_id = get_frame_id (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1865
1866 fi = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
1867 within_current_scope = (fi != NULL);
1868 if (within_current_scope)
1869 select_frame (fi);
1870 }
1871
1872 /* We don't free locations. They are stored in the bp_location array
1873 and update_global_location_list will eventually delete them and
1874 remove breakpoints if needed. */
1875 b->base.loc = NULL;
1876
1877 if (within_current_scope && reparse)
1878 {
1879 const char *s;
1880
1881 if (b->exp)
1882 {
1883 xfree (b->exp);
1884 b->exp = NULL;
1885 }
1886 s = b->exp_string_reparse ? b->exp_string_reparse : b->exp_string;
1887 b->exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->exp_valid_block, 0);
1888 /* If the meaning of expression itself changed, the old value is
1889 no longer relevant. We don't want to report a watchpoint hit
1890 to the user when the old value and the new value may actually
1891 be completely different objects. */
1892 value_free (b->val);
1893 b->val = NULL;
1894 b->val_valid = 0;
1895
1896 /* Note that unlike with breakpoints, the watchpoint's condition
1897 expression is stored in the breakpoint object, not in the
1898 locations (re)created below. */
1899 if (b->base.cond_string != NULL)
1900 {
1901 if (b->cond_exp != NULL)
1902 {
1903 xfree (b->cond_exp);
1904 b->cond_exp = NULL;
1905 }
1906
1907 s = b->base.cond_string;
1908 b->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->cond_exp_valid_block, 0);
1909 }
1910 }
1911
1912 /* If we failed to parse the expression, for example because
1913 it refers to a global variable in a not-yet-loaded shared library,
1914 don't try to insert watchpoint. We don't automatically delete
1915 such watchpoint, though, since failure to parse expression
1916 is different from out-of-scope watchpoint. */
1917 if (!target_has_execution)
1918 {
1919 /* Without execution, memory can't change. No use to try and
1920 set watchpoint locations. The watchpoint will be reset when
1921 the target gains execution, through breakpoint_re_set. */
1922 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
1923 {
1924 if (b->base.ops->works_in_software_mode (&b->base))
1925 b->base.type = bp_watchpoint;
1926 else
1927 error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when "
1928 "hardware watchpoints are disabled."));
1929 }
1930 }
1931 else if (within_current_scope && b->exp)
1932 {
1933 int pc = 0;
1934 struct value *val_chain, *v, *result, *next;
1935 struct program_space *frame_pspace;
1936
1937 fetch_subexp_value (b->exp, &pc, &v, &result, &val_chain, 0);
1938
1939 /* Avoid setting b->val if it's already set. The meaning of
1940 b->val is 'the last value' user saw, and we should update
1941 it only if we reported that last value to user. As it
1942 happens, the code that reports it updates b->val directly.
1943 We don't keep track of the memory value for masked
1944 watchpoints. */
1945 if (!b->val_valid && !is_masked_watchpoint (&b->base))
1946 {
1947 if (b->val_bitsize != 0)
1948 {
1949 v = extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (b, v);
1950 if (v != NULL)
1951 release_value (v);
1952 }
1953 b->val = v;
1954 b->val_valid = 1;
1955 }
1956
1957 frame_pspace = get_frame_program_space (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1958
1959 /* Look at each value on the value chain. */
1960 for (v = val_chain; v; v = value_next (v))
1961 {
1962 /* If it's a memory location, and GDB actually needed
1963 its contents to evaluate the expression, then we
1964 must watch it. If the first value returned is
1965 still lazy, that means an error occurred reading it;
1966 watch it anyway in case it becomes readable. */
1967 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory
1968 && (v == val_chain || ! value_lazy (v)))
1969 {
1970 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
1971
1972 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked
1973 for it explicitly, never if they just happen to
1974 appear in the middle of some value chain. */
1975 if (v == result
1976 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1977 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
1978 {
1979 CORE_ADDR addr;
1980 enum target_hw_bp_type type;
1981 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
1982 int bitpos = 0, bitsize = 0;
1983
1984 if (value_bitsize (v) != 0)
1985 {
1986 /* Extract the bit parameters out from the bitfield
1987 sub-expression. */
1988 bitpos = value_bitpos (v);
1989 bitsize = value_bitsize (v);
1990 }
1991 else if (v == result && b->val_bitsize != 0)
1992 {
1993 /* If VAL_BITSIZE != 0 then RESULT is actually a bitfield
1994 lvalue whose bit parameters are saved in the fields
1995 VAL_BITPOS and VAL_BITSIZE. */
1996 bitpos = b->val_bitpos;
1997 bitsize = b->val_bitsize;
1998 }
1999
2000 addr = value_address (v);
2001 if (bitsize != 0)
2002 {
2003 /* Skip the bytes that don't contain the bitfield. */
2004 addr += bitpos / 8;
2005 }
2006
2007 type = hw_write;
2008 if (b->base.type == bp_read_watchpoint)
2009 type = hw_read;
2010 else if (b->base.type == bp_access_watchpoint)
2011 type = hw_access;
2012
2013 loc = allocate_bp_location (&b->base);
2014 for (tmp = &(b->base.loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
2015 ;
2016 *tmp = loc;
2017 loc->gdbarch = get_type_arch (value_type (v));
2018
2019 loc->pspace = frame_pspace;
2020 loc->address = addr;
2021
2022 if (bitsize != 0)
2023 {
2024 /* Just cover the bytes that make up the bitfield. */
2025 loc->length = ((bitpos % 8) + bitsize + 7) / 8;
2026 }
2027 else
2028 loc->length = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
2029
2030 loc->watchpoint_type = type;
2031 }
2032 }
2033 }
2034
2035 /* Change the type of breakpoint between hardware assisted or
2036 an ordinary watchpoint depending on the hardware support
2037 and free hardware slots. REPARSE is set when the inferior
2038 is started. */
2039 if (reparse)
2040 {
2041 int reg_cnt;
2042 enum bp_loc_type loc_type;
2043 struct bp_location *bl;
2044
2045 reg_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val_chain);
2046
2047 if (reg_cnt)
2048 {
2049 int i, target_resources_ok, other_type_used;
2050 enum bptype type;
2051
2052 /* Use an exact watchpoint when there's only one memory region to be
2053 watched, and only one debug register is needed to watch it. */
2054 b->exact = target_exact_watchpoints && reg_cnt == 1;
2055
2056 /* We need to determine how many resources are already
2057 used for all other hardware watchpoints plus this one
2058 to see if we still have enough resources to also fit
2059 this watchpoint in as well. */
2060
2061 /* If this is a software watchpoint, we try to turn it
2062 to a hardware one -- count resources as if B was of
2063 hardware watchpoint type. */
2064 type = b->base.type;
2065 if (type == bp_watchpoint)
2066 type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
2067
2068 /* This watchpoint may or may not have been placed on
2069 the list yet at this point (it won't be in the list
2070 if we're trying to create it for the first time,
2071 through watch_command), so always account for it
2072 manually. */
2073
2074 /* Count resources used by all watchpoints except B. */
2075 i = hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (&b->base, type, &other_type_used);
2076
2077 /* Add in the resources needed for B. */
2078 i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (&b->base);
2079
2080 target_resources_ok
2081 = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (type, i, other_type_used);
2082 if (target_resources_ok <= 0)
2083 {
2084 int sw_mode = b->base.ops->works_in_software_mode (&b->base);
2085
2086 if (target_resources_ok == 0 && !sw_mode)
2087 error (_("Target does not support this type of "
2088 "hardware watchpoint."));
2089 else if (target_resources_ok < 0 && !sw_mode)
2090 error (_("There are not enough available hardware "
2091 "resources for this watchpoint."));
2092
2093 /* Downgrade to software watchpoint. */
2094 b->base.type = bp_watchpoint;
2095 }
2096 else
2097 {
2098 /* If this was a software watchpoint, we've just
2099 found we have enough resources to turn it to a
2100 hardware watchpoint. Otherwise, this is a
2101 nop. */
2102 b->base.type = type;
2103 }
2104 }
2105 else if (!b->base.ops->works_in_software_mode (&b->base))
2106 {
2107 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
2108 error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when "
2109 "hardware watchpoints are disabled."));
2110 else
2111 error (_("Expression cannot be implemented with "
2112 "read/access watchpoint."));
2113 }
2114 else
2115 b->base.type = bp_watchpoint;
2116
2117 loc_type = (b->base.type == bp_watchpoint? bp_loc_other
2118 : bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint);
2119 for (bl = b->base.loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
2120 bl->loc_type = loc_type;
2121 }
2122
2123 for (v = val_chain; v; v = next)
2124 {
2125 next = value_next (v);
2126 if (v != b->val)
2127 value_free (v);
2128 }
2129
2130 /* If a software watchpoint is not watching any memory, then the
2131 above left it without any location set up. But,
2132 bpstat_stop_status requires a location to be able to report
2133 stops, so make sure there's at least a dummy one. */
2134 if (b->base.type == bp_watchpoint && b->base.loc == NULL)
2135 {
2136 struct breakpoint *base = &b->base;
2137 base->loc = allocate_bp_location (base);
2138 base->loc->pspace = frame_pspace;
2139 base->loc->address = -1;
2140 base->loc->length = -1;
2141 base->loc->watchpoint_type = -1;
2142 }
2143 }
2144 else if (!within_current_scope)
2145 {
2146 printf_filtered (_("\
2147 Watchpoint %d deleted because the program has left the block\n\
2148 in which its expression is valid.\n"),
2149 b->base.number);
2150 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
2151 }
2152
2153 /* Restore the selected frame. */
2154 if (frame_saved)
2155 select_frame (frame_find_by_id (saved_frame_id));
2156 }
2157
2158
2159 /* Returns 1 iff breakpoint location should be
2160 inserted in the inferior. We don't differentiate the type of BL's owner
2161 (breakpoint vs. tracepoint), although insert_location in tracepoint's
2162 breakpoint_ops is not defined, because in insert_bp_location,
2163 tracepoint's insert_location will not be called. */
2164 static int
2165 should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl)
2166 {
2167 if (bl->owner == NULL || !breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner))
2168 return 0;
2169
2170 if (bl->owner->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
2171 return 0;
2172
2173 if (!bl->enabled || bl->shlib_disabled || bl->duplicate)
2174 return 0;
2175
2176 if (user_breakpoint_p (bl->owner) && bl->pspace->executing_startup)
2177 return 0;
2178
2179 /* This is set for example, when we're attached to the parent of a
2180 vfork, and have detached from the child. The child is running
2181 free, and we expect it to do an exec or exit, at which point the
2182 OS makes the parent schedulable again (and the target reports
2183 that the vfork is done). Until the child is done with the shared
2184 memory region, do not insert breakpoints in the parent, otherwise
2185 the child could still trip on the parent's breakpoints. Since
2186 the parent is blocked anyway, it won't miss any breakpoint. */
2187 if (bl->pspace->breakpoints_not_allowed)
2188 return 0;
2189
2190 /* Don't insert a breakpoint if we're trying to step past its
2191 location. */
2192 if ((bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2193 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2194 && stepping_past_instruction_at (bl->pspace->aspace,
2195 bl->address))
2196 {
2197 if (debug_infrun)
2198 {
2199 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog,
2200 "infrun: skipping breakpoint: "
2201 "stepping past insn at: %s\n",
2202 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address));
2203 }
2204 return 0;
2205 }
2206
2207 /* Don't insert watchpoints if we're trying to step past the
2208 instruction that triggered one. */
2209 if ((bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
2210 && stepping_past_nonsteppable_watchpoint ())
2211 {
2212 if (debug_infrun)
2213 {
2214 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog,
2215 "infrun: stepping past non-steppable watchpoint. "
2216 "skipping watchpoint at %s:%d\n",
2217 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address),
2218 bl->length);
2219 }
2220 return 0;
2221 }
2222
2223 return 1;
2224 }
2225
2226 /* Same as should_be_inserted but does the check assuming
2227 that the location is not duplicated. */
2228
2229 static int
2230 unduplicated_should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl)
2231 {
2232 int result;
2233 const int save_duplicate = bl->duplicate;
2234
2235 bl->duplicate = 0;
2236 result = should_be_inserted (bl);
2237 bl->duplicate = save_duplicate;
2238 return result;
2239 }
2240
2241 /* Parses a conditional described by an expression COND into an
2242 agent expression bytecode suitable for evaluation
2243 by the bytecode interpreter. Return NULL if there was
2244 any error during parsing. */
2245
2246 static struct agent_expr *
2247 parse_cond_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope, struct expression *cond)
2248 {
2249 struct agent_expr *aexpr = NULL;
2250
2251 if (!cond)
2252 return NULL;
2253
2254 /* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors
2255 that may show up. */
2256 TRY
2257 {
2258 aexpr = gen_eval_for_expr (scope, cond);
2259 }
2260
2261 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
2262 {
2263 /* If we got here, it means the condition could not be parsed to a valid
2264 bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side.
2265 It's no use iterating through the conditions. */
2266 return NULL;
2267 }
2268 END_CATCH
2269
2270 /* We have a valid agent expression. */
2271 return aexpr;
2272 }
2273
2274 /* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint conditions to be
2275 passed on to the target. If we have duplicated locations with different
2276 conditions, we will add such conditions to the list. The idea is that the
2277 target will evaluate the list of conditions and will only notify GDB when
2278 one of them is true. */
2279
2280 static void
2281 build_target_condition_list (struct bp_location *bl)
2282 {
2283 struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
2284 int null_condition_or_parse_error = 0;
2285 int modified = bl->needs_update;
2286 struct bp_location *loc;
2287
2288 /* Release conditions left over from a previous insert. */
2289 VEC_free (agent_expr_p, bl->target_info.conditions);
2290
2291 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
2292 evaluating conditions and if the user has
2293 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
2294 side. */
2295 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
2296 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
2297 return;
2298
2299 /* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned
2300 conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent expression
2301 bytecode. If any of these happen, then it's no use to send conditions
2302 to the target since this location will always trigger and generate a
2303 response back to GDB. */
2304 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2305 {
2306 loc = (*loc2p);
2307 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2308 {
2309 if (modified)
2310 {
2311 struct agent_expr *aexpr;
2312
2313 /* Re-parse the conditions since something changed. In that
2314 case we already freed the condition bytecodes (see
2315 force_breakpoint_reinsertion). We just
2316 need to parse the condition to bytecodes again. */
2317 aexpr = parse_cond_to_aexpr (bl->address, loc->cond);
2318 loc->cond_bytecode = aexpr;
2319
2320 /* Check if we managed to parse the conditional expression
2321 correctly. If not, we will not send this condition
2322 to the target. */
2323 if (aexpr)
2324 continue;
2325 }
2326
2327 /* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something
2328 went wrong or we have a null condition expression. */
2329 if (!loc->cond_bytecode)
2330 {
2331 null_condition_or_parse_error = 1;
2332 break;
2333 }
2334 }
2335 }
2336
2337 /* If any of these happened, it means we will have to evaluate the conditions
2338 for the location's address on gdb's side. It is no use keeping bytecodes
2339 for all the other duplicate locations, thus we free all of them here.
2340
2341 This is so we have a finer control over which locations' conditions are
2342 being evaluated by GDB or the remote stub. */
2343 if (null_condition_or_parse_error)
2344 {
2345 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2346 {
2347 loc = (*loc2p);
2348 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2349 {
2350 /* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is
2351 located. */
2352 if (!loc->cond_bytecode)
2353 return;
2354
2355 free_agent_expr (loc->cond_bytecode);
2356 loc->cond_bytecode = NULL;
2357 }
2358 }
2359 }
2360
2361 /* No NULL conditions or failed bytecode generation. Build a condition list
2362 for this location's address. */
2363 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2364 {
2365 loc = (*loc2p);
2366 if (loc->cond
2367 && is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2368 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2369 && loc->owner->enable_state == bp_enabled
2370 && loc->enabled)
2371 /* Add the condition to the vector. This will be used later to send the
2372 conditions to the target. */
2373 VEC_safe_push (agent_expr_p, bl->target_info.conditions,
2374 loc->cond_bytecode);
2375 }
2376
2377 return;
2378 }
2379
2380 /* Parses a command described by string CMD into an agent expression
2381 bytecode suitable for evaluation by the bytecode interpreter.
2382 Return NULL if there was any error during parsing. */
2383
2384 static struct agent_expr *
2385 parse_cmd_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope, char *cmd)
2386 {
2387 struct cleanup *old_cleanups = 0;
2388 struct expression *expr, **argvec;
2389 struct agent_expr *aexpr = NULL;
2390 const char *cmdrest;
2391 const char *format_start, *format_end;
2392 struct format_piece *fpieces;
2393 int nargs;
2394 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
2395
2396 if (!cmd)
2397 return NULL;
2398
2399 cmdrest = cmd;
2400
2401 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2402 ++cmdrest;
2403 cmdrest = skip_spaces_const (cmdrest);
2404
2405 if (*cmdrest++ != '"')
2406 error (_("No format string following the location"));
2407
2408 format_start = cmdrest;
2409
2410 fpieces = parse_format_string (&cmdrest);
2411
2412 old_cleanups = make_cleanup (free_format_pieces_cleanup, &fpieces);
2413
2414 format_end = cmdrest;
2415
2416 if (*cmdrest++ != '"')
2417 error (_("Bad format string, non-terminated '\"'."));
2418
2419 cmdrest = skip_spaces_const (cmdrest);
2420
2421 if (!(*cmdrest == ',' || *cmdrest == '\0'))
2422 error (_("Invalid argument syntax"));
2423
2424 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2425 cmdrest++;
2426 cmdrest = skip_spaces_const (cmdrest);
2427
2428 /* For each argument, make an expression. */
2429
2430 argvec = (struct expression **) alloca (strlen (cmd)
2431 * sizeof (struct expression *));
2432
2433 nargs = 0;
2434 while (*cmdrest != '\0')
2435 {
2436 const char *cmd1;
2437
2438 cmd1 = cmdrest;
2439 expr = parse_exp_1 (&cmd1, scope, block_for_pc (scope), 1);
2440 argvec[nargs++] = expr;
2441 cmdrest = cmd1;
2442 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2443 ++cmdrest;
2444 }
2445
2446 /* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors
2447 that may show up. */
2448 TRY
2449 {
2450 aexpr = gen_printf (scope, gdbarch, 0, 0,
2451 format_start, format_end - format_start,
2452 fpieces, nargs, argvec);
2453 }
2454 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
2455 {
2456 /* If we got here, it means the command could not be parsed to a valid
2457 bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side.
2458 It's no use iterating through the other commands. */
2459 aexpr = NULL;
2460 }
2461 END_CATCH
2462
2463 do_cleanups (old_cleanups);
2464
2465 /* We have a valid agent expression, return it. */
2466 return aexpr;
2467 }
2468
2469 /* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint commands to be
2470 passed on to the target. If we have duplicated locations with
2471 different commands, we will add any such to the list. */
2472
2473 static void
2474 build_target_command_list (struct bp_location *bl)
2475 {
2476 struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
2477 int null_command_or_parse_error = 0;
2478 int modified = bl->needs_update;
2479 struct bp_location *loc;
2480
2481 /* Release commands left over from a previous insert. */
2482 VEC_free (agent_expr_p, bl->target_info.tcommands);
2483
2484 if (!target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
2485 return;
2486
2487 /* For now, limit to agent-style dprintf breakpoints. */
2488 if (dprintf_style != dprintf_style_agent)
2489 return;
2490
2491 /* For now, if we have any duplicate location that isn't a dprintf,
2492 don't install the target-side commands, as that would make the
2493 breakpoint not be reported to the core, and we'd lose
2494 control. */
2495 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2496 {
2497 loc = (*loc2p);
2498 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2499 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2500 && loc->owner->type != bp_dprintf)
2501 return;
2502 }
2503
2504 /* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned
2505 conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent expression
2506 bytecode. If any of these happen, then it's no use to send conditions
2507 to the target since this location will always trigger and generate a
2508 response back to GDB. */
2509 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2510 {
2511 loc = (*loc2p);
2512 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2513 {
2514 if (modified)
2515 {
2516 struct agent_expr *aexpr;
2517
2518 /* Re-parse the commands since something changed. In that
2519 case we already freed the command bytecodes (see
2520 force_breakpoint_reinsertion). We just
2521 need to parse the command to bytecodes again. */
2522 aexpr = parse_cmd_to_aexpr (bl->address,
2523 loc->owner->extra_string);
2524 loc->cmd_bytecode = aexpr;
2525
2526 if (!aexpr)
2527 continue;
2528 }
2529
2530 /* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something
2531 went wrong or we have a null command expression. */
2532 if (!loc->cmd_bytecode)
2533 {
2534 null_command_or_parse_error = 1;
2535 break;
2536 }
2537 }
2538 }
2539
2540 /* If anything failed, then we're not doing target-side commands,
2541 and so clean up. */
2542 if (null_command_or_parse_error)
2543 {
2544 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2545 {
2546 loc = (*loc2p);
2547 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2548 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2549 {
2550 /* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is
2551 located. */
2552 if (loc->cmd_bytecode == NULL)
2553 return;
2554
2555 free_agent_expr (loc->cmd_bytecode);
2556 loc->cmd_bytecode = NULL;
2557 }
2558 }
2559 }
2560
2561 /* No NULL commands or failed bytecode generation. Build a command list
2562 for this location's address. */
2563 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2564 {
2565 loc = (*loc2p);
2566 if (loc->owner->extra_string
2567 && is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2568 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2569 && loc->owner->enable_state == bp_enabled
2570 && loc->enabled)
2571 /* Add the command to the vector. This will be used later
2572 to send the commands to the target. */
2573 VEC_safe_push (agent_expr_p, bl->target_info.tcommands,
2574 loc->cmd_bytecode);
2575 }
2576
2577 bl->target_info.persist = 0;
2578 /* Maybe flag this location as persistent. */
2579 if (bl->owner->type == bp_dprintf && disconnected_dprintf)
2580 bl->target_info.persist = 1;
2581 }
2582
2583 /* Insert a low-level "breakpoint" of some type. BL is the breakpoint
2584 location. Any error messages are printed to TMP_ERROR_STREAM; and
2585 DISABLED_BREAKS, and HW_BREAKPOINT_ERROR are used to report problems.
2586 Returns 0 for success, 1 if the bp_location type is not supported or
2587 -1 for failure.
2588
2589 NOTE drow/2003-09-09: This routine could be broken down to an
2590 object-style method for each breakpoint or catchpoint type. */
2591 static int
2592 insert_bp_location (struct bp_location *bl,
2593 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream,
2594 int *disabled_breaks,
2595 int *hw_breakpoint_error,
2596 int *hw_bp_error_explained_already)
2597 {
2598 enum errors bp_err = GDB_NO_ERROR;
2599 const char *bp_err_message = NULL;
2600
2601 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
2602 return 0;
2603
2604 /* Note we don't initialize bl->target_info, as that wipes out
2605 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents if the breakpoint
2606 is still inserted at that location. This in turn breaks
2607 target_read_memory which depends on these buffers when
2608 a memory read is requested at the breakpoint location:
2609 Once the target_info has been wiped, we fail to see that
2610 we have a breakpoint inserted at that address and thus
2611 read the breakpoint instead of returning the data saved in
2612 the breakpoint location's shadow contents. */
2613 bl->target_info.reqstd_address = bl->address;
2614 bl->target_info.placed_address_space = bl->pspace->aspace;
2615 bl->target_info.length = bl->length;
2616
2617 /* When working with target-side conditions, we must pass all the conditions
2618 for the same breakpoint address down to the target since GDB will not
2619 insert those locations. With a list of breakpoint conditions, the target
2620 can decide when to stop and notify GDB. */
2621
2622 if (is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
2623 {
2624 build_target_condition_list (bl);
2625 build_target_command_list (bl);
2626 /* Reset the modification marker. */
2627 bl->needs_update = 0;
2628 }
2629
2630 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2631 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2632 {
2633 if (bl->owner->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
2634 {
2635 /* If the explicitly specified breakpoint type
2636 is not hardware breakpoint, check the memory map to see
2637 if the breakpoint address is in read only memory or not.
2638
2639 Two important cases are:
2640 - location type is not hardware breakpoint, memory
2641 is readonly. We change the type of the location to
2642 hardware breakpoint.
2643 - location type is hardware breakpoint, memory is
2644 read-write. This means we've previously made the
2645 location hardware one, but then the memory map changed,
2646 so we undo.
2647
2648 When breakpoints are removed, remove_breakpoints will use
2649 location types we've just set here, the only possible
2650 problem is that memory map has changed during running
2651 program, but it's not going to work anyway with current
2652 gdb. */
2653 struct mem_region *mr
2654 = lookup_mem_region (bl->target_info.reqstd_address);
2655
2656 if (mr)
2657 {
2658 if (automatic_hardware_breakpoints)
2659 {
2660 enum bp_loc_type new_type;
2661
2662 if (mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
2663 new_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
2664 else
2665 new_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
2666
2667 if (new_type != bl->loc_type)
2668 {
2669 static int said = 0;
2670
2671 bl->loc_type = new_type;
2672 if (!said)
2673 {
2674 fprintf_filtered (gdb_stdout,
2675 _("Note: automatically using "
2676 "hardware breakpoints for "
2677 "read-only addresses.\n"));
2678 said = 1;
2679 }
2680 }
2681 }
2682 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2683 && mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
2684 {
2685 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2686 _("Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n"
2687 "Cannot set software breakpoint "
2688 "at read-only address %s\n"),
2689 bl->owner->number,
2690 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address));
2691 return 1;
2692 }
2693 }
2694 }
2695
2696 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
2697 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
2698 || bl->section == NULL
2699 || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section)))
2700 {
2701 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
2702 TRY
2703 {
2704 int val;
2705
2706 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2707 if (val)
2708 bp_err = GENERIC_ERROR;
2709 }
2710 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
2711 {
2712 bp_err = e.error;
2713 bp_err_message = e.message;
2714 }
2715 END_CATCH
2716 }
2717 else
2718 {
2719 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
2720 Shall we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
2721 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
2722 {
2723 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active,
2724 so we must try to set a breakpoint at the LMA.
2725 This will not work for a hardware breakpoint. */
2726 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2727 warning (_("hardware breakpoint %d not supported in overlay!"),
2728 bl->owner->number);
2729 else
2730 {
2731 CORE_ADDR addr = overlay_unmapped_address (bl->address,
2732 bl->section);
2733 /* Set a software (trap) breakpoint at the LMA. */
2734 bl->overlay_target_info = bl->target_info;
2735 bl->overlay_target_info.reqstd_address = addr;
2736
2737 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
2738 TRY
2739 {
2740 int val;
2741
2742 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
2743 &bl->overlay_target_info);
2744 if (val)
2745 bp_err = GENERIC_ERROR;
2746 }
2747 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
2748 {
2749 bp_err = e.error;
2750 bp_err_message = e.message;
2751 }
2752 END_CATCH
2753
2754 if (bp_err != GDB_NO_ERROR)
2755 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2756 "Overlay breakpoint %d "
2757 "failed: in ROM?\n",
2758 bl->owner->number);
2759 }
2760 }
2761 /* Shall we set a breakpoint at the VMA? */
2762 if (section_is_mapped (bl->section))
2763 {
2764 /* Yes. This overlay section is mapped into memory. */
2765 TRY
2766 {
2767 int val;
2768
2769 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2770 if (val)
2771 bp_err = GENERIC_ERROR;
2772 }
2773 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
2774 {
2775 bp_err = e.error;
2776 bp_err_message = e.message;
2777 }
2778 END_CATCH
2779 }
2780 else
2781 {
2782 /* No. This breakpoint will not be inserted.
2783 No error, but do not mark the bp as 'inserted'. */
2784 return 0;
2785 }
2786 }
2787
2788 if (bp_err != GDB_NO_ERROR)
2789 {
2790 /* Can't set the breakpoint. */
2791
2792 /* In some cases, we might not be able to insert a
2793 breakpoint in a shared library that has already been
2794 removed, but we have not yet processed the shlib unload
2795 event. Unfortunately, some targets that implement
2796 breakpoint insertion themselves can't tell why the
2797 breakpoint insertion failed (e.g., the remote target
2798 doesn't define error codes), so we must treat generic
2799 errors as memory errors. */
2800 if ((bp_err == GENERIC_ERROR || bp_err == MEMORY_ERROR)
2801 && bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2802 && (solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address)
2803 || shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl->pspace,
2804 bl->address)))
2805 {
2806 /* See also: disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs. */
2807 bl->shlib_disabled = 1;
2808 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bl->owner);
2809 if (!*disabled_breaks)
2810 {
2811 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2812 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
2813 bl->owner->number);
2814 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2815 "Temporarily disabling shared "
2816 "library breakpoints:\n");
2817 }
2818 *disabled_breaks = 1;
2819 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2820 "breakpoint #%d\n", bl->owner->number);
2821 return 0;
2822 }
2823 else
2824 {
2825 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2826 {
2827 *hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
2828 *hw_bp_error_explained_already = bp_err_message != NULL;
2829 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2830 "Cannot insert hardware breakpoint %d%s",
2831 bl->owner->number, bp_err_message ? ":" : ".\n");
2832 if (bp_err_message != NULL)
2833 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "%s.\n", bp_err_message);
2834 }
2835 else
2836 {
2837 if (bp_err_message == NULL)
2838 {
2839 char *message
2840 = memory_error_message (TARGET_XFER_E_IO,
2841 bl->gdbarch, bl->address);
2842 struct cleanup *old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
2843
2844 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2845 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n"
2846 "%s\n",
2847 bl->owner->number, message);
2848 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2849 }
2850 else
2851 {
2852 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2853 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d: %s\n",
2854 bl->owner->number,
2855 bp_err_message);
2856 }
2857 }
2858 return 1;
2859
2860 }
2861 }
2862 else
2863 bl->inserted = 1;
2864
2865 return 0;
2866 }
2867
2868 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
2869 /* NOTE drow/2003-09-08: This state only exists for removing
2870 watchpoints. It's not clear that it's necessary... */
2871 && bl->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
2872 {
2873 int val;
2874
2875 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
2876 && bl->owner->ops->insert_location != NULL);
2877
2878 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2879
2880 /* If trying to set a read-watchpoint, and it turns out it's not
2881 supported, try emulating one with an access watchpoint. */
2882 if (val == 1 && bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
2883 {
2884 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
2885
2886 /* But don't try to insert it, if there's already another
2887 hw_access location that would be considered a duplicate
2888 of this one. */
2889 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
2890 if (loc != bl
2891 && loc->watchpoint_type == hw_access
2892 && watchpoint_locations_match (bl, loc))
2893 {
2894 bl->duplicate = 1;
2895 bl->inserted = 1;
2896 bl->target_info = loc->target_info;
2897 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
2898 val = 0;
2899 break;
2900 }
2901
2902 if (val == 1)
2903 {
2904 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
2905 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2906
2907 if (val)
2908 /* Back to the original value. */
2909 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_read;
2910 }
2911 }
2912
2913 bl->inserted = (val == 0);
2914 }
2915
2916 else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint)
2917 {
2918 int val;
2919
2920 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
2921 && bl->owner->ops->insert_location != NULL);
2922
2923 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2924 if (val)
2925 {
2926 bl->owner->enable_state = bp_disabled;
2927
2928 if (val == 1)
2929 warning (_("\
2930 Error inserting catchpoint %d: Your system does not support this type\n\
2931 of catchpoint."), bl->owner->number);
2932 else
2933 warning (_("Error inserting catchpoint %d."), bl->owner->number);
2934 }
2935
2936 bl->inserted = (val == 0);
2937
2938 /* We've already printed an error message if there was a problem
2939 inserting this catchpoint, and we've disabled the catchpoint,
2940 so just return success. */
2941 return 0;
2942 }
2943
2944 return 0;
2945 }
2946
2947 /* This function is called when program space PSPACE is about to be
2948 deleted. It takes care of updating breakpoints to not reference
2949 PSPACE anymore. */
2950
2951 void
2952 breakpoint_program_space_exit (struct program_space *pspace)
2953 {
2954 struct breakpoint *b, *b_temp;
2955 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
2956
2957 /* Remove any breakpoint that was set through this program space. */
2958 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_temp)
2959 {
2960 if (b->pspace == pspace)
2961 delete_breakpoint (b);
2962 }
2963
2964 /* Breakpoints set through other program spaces could have locations
2965 bound to PSPACE as well. Remove those. */
2966 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
2967 {
2968 struct bp_location *tmp;
2969
2970 if (loc->pspace == pspace)
2971 {
2972 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
2973 if (loc->owner->loc == loc)
2974 loc->owner->loc = loc->next;
2975 else
2976 for (tmp = loc->owner->loc; tmp->next != NULL; tmp = tmp->next)
2977 if (tmp->next == loc)
2978 {
2979 tmp->next = loc->next;
2980 break;
2981 }
2982 }
2983 }
2984
2985 /* Now update the global location list to permanently delete the
2986 removed locations above. */
2987 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
2988 }
2989
2990 /* Make sure all breakpoints are inserted in inferior.
2991 Throws exception on any error.
2992 A breakpoint that is already inserted won't be inserted
2993 again, so calling this function twice is safe. */
2994 void
2995 insert_breakpoints (void)
2996 {
2997 struct breakpoint *bpt;
2998
2999 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
3000 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
3001 {
3002 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
3003
3004 update_watchpoint (w, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
3005 }
3006
3007 /* Updating watchpoints creates new locations, so update the global
3008 location list. Explicitly tell ugll to insert locations and
3009 ignore breakpoints_always_inserted_mode. */
3010 update_global_location_list (UGLL_INSERT);
3011 }
3012
3013 /* Invoke CALLBACK for each of bp_location. */
3014
3015 void
3016 iterate_over_bp_locations (walk_bp_location_callback callback)
3017 {
3018 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_tmp;
3019
3020 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
3021 {
3022 callback (loc, NULL);
3023 }
3024 }
3025
3026 /* This is used when we need to synch breakpoint conditions between GDB and the
3027 target. It is the case with deleting and disabling of breakpoints when using
3028 always-inserted mode. */
3029
3030 static void
3031 update_inserted_breakpoint_locations (void)
3032 {
3033 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3034 int error_flag = 0;
3035 int val = 0;
3036 int disabled_breaks = 0;
3037 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
3038 int hw_bp_details_reported = 0;
3039
3040 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
3041 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
3042
3043 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
3044 there was an error. */
3045 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "Warning:\n");
3046
3047 save_current_space_and_thread ();
3048
3049 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3050 {
3051 /* We only want to update software breakpoints and hardware
3052 breakpoints. */
3053 if (!is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
3054 continue;
3055
3056 /* We only want to update locations that are already inserted
3057 and need updating. This is to avoid unwanted insertion during
3058 deletion of breakpoints. */
3059 if (!bl->inserted || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
3060 continue;
3061
3062 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
3063
3064 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
3065 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
3066 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
3067 insert breakpoints. */
3068 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
3069 && ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
3070 continue;
3071
3072 val = insert_bp_location (bl, tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks,
3073 &hw_breakpoint_error, &hw_bp_details_reported);
3074 if (val)
3075 error_flag = val;
3076 }
3077
3078 if (error_flag)
3079 {
3080 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
3081 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
3082 }
3083
3084 do_cleanups (cleanups);
3085 }
3086
3087 /* Used when starting or continuing the program. */
3088
3089 static void
3090 insert_breakpoint_locations (void)
3091 {
3092 struct breakpoint *bpt;
3093 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3094 int error_flag = 0;
3095 int val = 0;
3096 int disabled_breaks = 0;
3097 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
3098 int hw_bp_error_explained_already = 0;
3099
3100 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
3101 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
3102
3103 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
3104 there was an error. */
3105 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "Warning:\n");
3106
3107 save_current_space_and_thread ();
3108
3109 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3110 {
3111 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
3112 continue;
3113
3114 /* There is no point inserting thread-specific breakpoints if
3115 the thread no longer exists. ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location
3116 has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
3117 if (bl->owner->thread != -1
3118 && !valid_thread_id (bl->owner->thread))
3119 continue;
3120
3121 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
3122
3123 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
3124 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
3125 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
3126 insert breakpoints. */
3127 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
3128 && ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
3129 continue;
3130
3131 val = insert_bp_location (bl, tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks,
3132 &hw_breakpoint_error, &hw_bp_error_explained_already);
3133 if (val)
3134 error_flag = val;
3135 }
3136
3137 /* If we failed to insert all locations of a watchpoint, remove
3138 them, as half-inserted watchpoint is of limited use. */
3139 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
3140 {
3141 int some_failed = 0;
3142 struct bp_location *loc;
3143
3144 if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
3145 continue;
3146
3147 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
3148 continue;
3149
3150 if (bpt->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
3151 continue;
3152
3153 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
3154 if (!loc->inserted && should_be_inserted (loc))
3155 {
3156 some_failed = 1;
3157 break;
3158 }
3159 if (some_failed)
3160 {
3161 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
3162 if (loc->inserted)
3163 remove_breakpoint (loc, mark_uninserted);
3164
3165 hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
3166 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
3167 "Could not insert hardware watchpoint %d.\n",
3168 bpt->number);
3169 error_flag = -1;
3170 }
3171 }
3172
3173 if (error_flag)
3174 {
3175 /* If a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint was inserted, add a
3176 message about possibly exhausted resources. */
3177 if (hw_breakpoint_error && !hw_bp_error_explained_already)
3178 {
3179 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
3180 "Could not insert hardware breakpoints:\n\
3181 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints/watchpoints.\n");
3182 }
3183 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
3184 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
3185 }
3186
3187 do_cleanups (cleanups);
3188 }
3189
3190 /* Used when the program stops.
3191 Returns zero if successful, or non-zero if there was a problem
3192 removing a breakpoint location. */
3193
3194 int
3195 remove_breakpoints (void)
3196 {
3197 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3198 int val = 0;
3199
3200 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3201 {
3202 if (bl->inserted && !is_tracepoint (bl->owner))
3203 val |= remove_breakpoint (bl, mark_uninserted);
3204 }
3205 return val;
3206 }
3207
3208 /* When a thread exits, remove breakpoints that are related to
3209 that thread. */
3210
3211 static void
3212 remove_threaded_breakpoints (struct thread_info *tp, int silent)
3213 {
3214 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
3215
3216 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
3217 {
3218 if (b->thread == tp->num && user_breakpoint_p (b))
3219 {
3220 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3221
3222 printf_filtered (_("\
3223 Thread-specific breakpoint %d deleted - thread %d no longer in the thread list.\n"),
3224 b->number, tp->num);
3225
3226 /* Hide it from the user. */
3227 b->number = 0;
3228 }
3229 }
3230 }
3231
3232 /* Remove breakpoints of process PID. */
3233
3234 int
3235 remove_breakpoints_pid (int pid)
3236 {
3237 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3238 int val;
3239 struct inferior *inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
3240
3241 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3242 {
3243 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
3244 continue;
3245
3246 if (bl->inserted && !bl->target_info.persist)
3247 {
3248 val = remove_breakpoint (bl, mark_uninserted);
3249 if (val != 0)
3250 return val;
3251 }
3252 }
3253 return 0;
3254 }
3255
3256 int
3257 reattach_breakpoints (int pid)
3258 {
3259 struct cleanup *old_chain;
3260 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3261 int val;
3262 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream;
3263 int dummy1 = 0, dummy2 = 0, dummy3 = 0;
3264 struct inferior *inf;
3265 struct thread_info *tp;
3266
3267 tp = any_live_thread_of_process (pid);
3268 if (tp == NULL)
3269 return 1;
3270
3271 inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
3272 old_chain = save_inferior_ptid ();
3273
3274 inferior_ptid = tp->ptid;
3275
3276 tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
3277 make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
3278
3279 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3280 {
3281 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
3282 continue;
3283
3284 if (bl->inserted)
3285 {
3286 bl->inserted = 0;
3287 val = insert_bp_location (bl, tmp_error_stream, &dummy1, &dummy2, &dummy3);
3288 if (val != 0)
3289 {
3290 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3291 return val;
3292 }
3293 }
3294 }
3295 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3296 return 0;
3297 }
3298
3299 static int internal_breakpoint_number = -1;
3300
3301 /* Set the breakpoint number of B, depending on the value of INTERNAL.
3302 If INTERNAL is non-zero, the breakpoint number will be populated
3303 from internal_breakpoint_number and that variable decremented.
3304 Otherwise the breakpoint number will be populated from
3305 breakpoint_count and that value incremented. Internal breakpoints
3306 do not set the internal var bpnum. */
3307 static void
3308 set_breakpoint_number (int internal, struct breakpoint *b)
3309 {
3310 if (internal)
3311 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
3312 else
3313 {
3314 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
3315 b->number = breakpoint_count;
3316 }
3317 }
3318
3319 static struct breakpoint *
3320 create_internal_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
3321 CORE_ADDR address, enum bptype type,
3322 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
3323 {
3324 struct symtab_and_line sal;
3325 struct breakpoint *b;
3326
3327 init_sal (&sal); /* Initialize to zeroes. */
3328
3329 sal.pc = address;
3330 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
3331 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
3332
3333 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type, ops);
3334 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
3335 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
3336
3337 return b;
3338 }
3339
3340 static const char *const longjmp_names[] =
3341 {
3342 "longjmp", "_longjmp", "siglongjmp", "_siglongjmp"
3343 };
3344 #define NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES ARRAY_SIZE(longjmp_names)
3345
3346 /* Per-objfile data private to breakpoint.c. */
3347 struct breakpoint_objfile_data
3348 {
3349 /* Minimal symbol for "_ovly_debug_event" (if any). */
3350 struct bound_minimal_symbol overlay_msym;
3351
3352 /* Minimal symbol(s) for "longjmp", "siglongjmp", etc. (if any). */
3353 struct bound_minimal_symbol longjmp_msym[NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES];
3354
3355 /* True if we have looked for longjmp probes. */
3356 int longjmp_searched;
3357
3358 /* SystemTap probe points for longjmp (if any). */
3359 VEC (probe_p) *longjmp_probes;
3360
3361 /* Minimal symbol for "std::terminate()" (if any). */
3362 struct bound_minimal_symbol terminate_msym;
3363
3364 /* Minimal symbol for "_Unwind_DebugHook" (if any). */
3365 struct bound_minimal_symbol exception_msym;
3366
3367 /* True if we have looked for exception probes. */
3368 int exception_searched;
3369
3370 /* SystemTap probe points for unwinding (if any). */
3371 VEC (probe_p) *exception_probes;
3372 };
3373
3374 static const struct objfile_data *breakpoint_objfile_key;
3375
3376 /* Minimal symbol not found sentinel. */
3377 static struct minimal_symbol msym_not_found;
3378
3379 /* Returns TRUE if MSYM point to the "not found" sentinel. */
3380
3381 static int
3382 msym_not_found_p (const struct minimal_symbol *msym)
3383 {
3384 return msym == &msym_not_found;
3385 }
3386
3387 /* Return per-objfile data needed by breakpoint.c.
3388 Allocate the data if necessary. */
3389
3390 static struct breakpoint_objfile_data *
3391 get_breakpoint_objfile_data (struct objfile *objfile)
3392 {
3393 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3394
3395 bp_objfile_data = objfile_data (objfile, breakpoint_objfile_key);
3396 if (bp_objfile_data == NULL)
3397 {
3398 bp_objfile_data =
3399 XOBNEW (&objfile->objfile_obstack, struct breakpoint_objfile_data);
3400
3401 memset (bp_objfile_data, 0, sizeof (*bp_objfile_data));
3402 set_objfile_data (objfile, breakpoint_objfile_key, bp_objfile_data);
3403 }
3404 return bp_objfile_data;
3405 }
3406
3407 static void
3408 free_breakpoint_probes (struct objfile *obj, void *data)
3409 {
3410 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data = data;
3411
3412 VEC_free (probe_p, bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes);
3413 VEC_free (probe_p, bp_objfile_data->exception_probes);
3414 }
3415
3416 static void
3417 create_overlay_event_breakpoint (void)
3418 {
3419 struct objfile *objfile;
3420 const char *const func_name = "_ovly_debug_event";
3421
3422 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3423 {
3424 struct breakpoint *b;
3425 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3426 CORE_ADDR addr;
3427 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3428
3429 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3430
3431 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym))
3432 continue;
3433
3434 if (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym == NULL)
3435 {
3436 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3437
3438 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
3439 if (m.minsym == NULL)
3440 {
3441 /* Avoid future lookups in this objfile. */
3442 bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3443 continue;
3444 }
3445 bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym = m;
3446 }
3447
3448 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym);
3449 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile), addr,
3450 bp_overlay_event,
3451 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3452 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3453 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3454 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3455
3456 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_auto)
3457 {
3458 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
3459 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
3460 }
3461 else
3462 {
3463 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3464 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
3465 }
3466 }
3467 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
3468 }
3469
3470 static void
3471 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint (void)
3472 {
3473 struct program_space *pspace;
3474 struct cleanup *old_chain;
3475
3476 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
3477
3478 ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
3479 {
3480 struct objfile *objfile;
3481
3482 set_current_program_space (pspace);
3483
3484 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3485 {
3486 int i;
3487 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
3488 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3489
3490 gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3491
3492 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3493
3494 if (!bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched)
3495 {
3496 VEC (probe_p) *ret;
3497
3498 ret = find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libc", "longjmp");
3499 if (ret != NULL)
3500 {
3501 /* We are only interested in checking one element. */
3502 struct probe *p = VEC_index (probe_p, ret, 0);
3503
3504 if (!can_evaluate_probe_arguments (p))
3505 {
3506 /* We cannot use the probe interface here, because it does
3507 not know how to evaluate arguments. */
3508 VEC_free (probe_p, ret);
3509 ret = NULL;
3510 }
3511 }
3512 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes = ret;
3513 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched = 1;
3514 }
3515
3516 if (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes != NULL)
3517 {
3518 int i;
3519 struct probe *probe;
3520 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3521
3522 for (i = 0;
3523 VEC_iterate (probe_p,
3524 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes,
3525 i, probe);
3526 ++i)
3527 {
3528 struct breakpoint *b;
3529
3530 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch,
3531 get_probe_address (probe,
3532 objfile),
3533 bp_longjmp_master,
3534 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3535 b->location
3536 = new_probe_location ("-probe-stap libc:longjmp");
3537 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3538 }
3539
3540 continue;
3541 }
3542
3543 if (!gdbarch_get_longjmp_target_p (gdbarch))
3544 continue;
3545
3546 for (i = 0; i < NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES; i++)
3547 {
3548 struct breakpoint *b;
3549 const char *func_name;
3550 CORE_ADDR addr;
3551 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3552
3553 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym))
3554 continue;
3555
3556 func_name = longjmp_names[i];
3557 if (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym == NULL)
3558 {
3559 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3560
3561 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
3562 if (m.minsym == NULL)
3563 {
3564 /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */
3565 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym = &msym_not_found;
3566 continue;
3567 }
3568 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i] = m;
3569 }
3570
3571 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i]);
3572 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_longjmp_master,
3573 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3574 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3575 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3576 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3577 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3578 }
3579 }
3580 }
3581 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
3582
3583 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3584 }
3585
3586 /* Create a master std::terminate breakpoint. */
3587 static void
3588 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint (void)
3589 {
3590 struct program_space *pspace;
3591 struct cleanup *old_chain;
3592 const char *const func_name = "std::terminate()";
3593
3594 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
3595
3596 ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
3597 {
3598 struct objfile *objfile;
3599 CORE_ADDR addr;
3600
3601 set_current_program_space (pspace);
3602
3603 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3604 {
3605 struct breakpoint *b;
3606 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3607 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3608
3609 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3610
3611 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym))
3612 continue;
3613
3614 if (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym == NULL)
3615 {
3616 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3617
3618 m = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile);
3619 if (m.minsym == NULL || (MSYMBOL_TYPE (m.minsym) != mst_text
3620 && MSYMBOL_TYPE (m.minsym) != mst_file_text))
3621 {
3622 /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */
3623 bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3624 continue;
3625 }
3626 bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym = m;
3627 }
3628
3629 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym);
3630 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile), addr,
3631 bp_std_terminate_master,
3632 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3633 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3634 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3635 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3636 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3637 }
3638 }
3639
3640 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
3641
3642 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3643 }
3644
3645 /* Install a master breakpoint on the unwinder's debug hook. */
3646
3647 static void
3648 create_exception_master_breakpoint (void)
3649 {
3650 struct objfile *objfile;
3651 const char *const func_name = "_Unwind_DebugHook";
3652
3653 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3654 {
3655 struct breakpoint *b;
3656 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
3657 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3658 CORE_ADDR addr;
3659 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3660
3661 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3662
3663 /* We prefer the SystemTap probe point if it exists. */
3664 if (!bp_objfile_data->exception_searched)
3665 {
3666 VEC (probe_p) *ret;
3667
3668 ret = find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libgcc", "unwind");
3669
3670 if (ret != NULL)
3671 {
3672 /* We are only interested in checking one element. */
3673 struct probe *p = VEC_index (probe_p, ret, 0);
3674
3675 if (!can_evaluate_probe_arguments (p))
3676 {
3677 /* We cannot use the probe interface here, because it does
3678 not know how to evaluate arguments. */
3679 VEC_free (probe_p, ret);
3680 ret = NULL;
3681 }
3682 }
3683 bp_objfile_data->exception_probes = ret;
3684 bp_objfile_data->exception_searched = 1;
3685 }
3686
3687 if (bp_objfile_data->exception_probes != NULL)
3688 {
3689 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3690 int i;
3691 struct probe *probe;
3692
3693 for (i = 0;
3694 VEC_iterate (probe_p,
3695 bp_objfile_data->exception_probes,
3696 i, probe);
3697 ++i)
3698 {
3699 struct breakpoint *b;
3700
3701 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch,
3702 get_probe_address (probe,
3703 objfile),
3704 bp_exception_master,
3705 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3706 b->location
3707 = new_probe_location ("-probe-stap libgcc:unwind");
3708 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3709 }
3710
3711 continue;
3712 }
3713
3714 /* Otherwise, try the hook function. */
3715
3716 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym))
3717 continue;
3718
3719 gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3720
3721 if (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym == NULL)
3722 {
3723 struct bound_minimal_symbol debug_hook;
3724
3725 debug_hook = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile);
3726 if (debug_hook.minsym == NULL)
3727 {
3728 bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3729 continue;
3730 }
3731
3732 bp_objfile_data->exception_msym = debug_hook;
3733 }
3734
3735 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym);
3736 addr = gdbarch_convert_from_func_ptr_addr (gdbarch, addr,
3737 &current_target);
3738 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_exception_master,
3739 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3740 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3741 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3742 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3743 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3744 }
3745
3746 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
3747 }
3748
3749 void
3750 update_breakpoints_after_exec (void)
3751 {
3752 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
3753 struct bp_location *bploc, **bplocp_tmp;
3754
3755 /* We're about to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists. If the
3756 INSERTED flag is true, GDB will try to lift the breakpoints by
3757 writing the breakpoints' "shadow contents" back into memory. The
3758 "shadow contents" are NOT valid after an exec, so GDB should not
3759 do that. Instead, the target is responsible from marking
3760 breakpoints out as soon as it detects an exec. We don't do that
3761 here instead, because there may be other attempts to delete
3762 breakpoints after detecting an exec and before reaching here. */
3763 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bploc, bplocp_tmp)
3764 if (bploc->pspace == current_program_space)
3765 gdb_assert (!bploc->inserted);
3766
3767 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
3768 {
3769 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
3770 continue;
3771
3772 /* Solib breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
3773 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
3774 {
3775 delete_breakpoint (b);
3776 continue;
3777 }
3778
3779 /* JIT breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
3780 if (b->type == bp_jit_event)
3781 {
3782 delete_breakpoint (b);
3783 continue;
3784 }
3785
3786 /* Thread event breakpoints must be set anew after an exec(),
3787 as must overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints. */
3788 if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event
3789 || b->type == bp_longjmp_master || b->type == bp_std_terminate_master
3790 || b->type == bp_exception_master)
3791 {
3792 delete_breakpoint (b);
3793 continue;
3794 }
3795
3796 /* Step-resume breakpoints are meaningless after an exec(). */
3797 if (b->type == bp_step_resume || b->type == bp_hp_step_resume)
3798 {
3799 delete_breakpoint (b);
3800 continue;
3801 }
3802
3803 /* Just like single-step breakpoints. */
3804 if (b->type == bp_single_step)
3805 {
3806 delete_breakpoint (b);
3807 continue;
3808 }
3809
3810 /* Longjmp and longjmp-resume breakpoints are also meaningless
3811 after an exec. */
3812 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_longjmp_resume
3813 || b->type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy
3814 || b->type == bp_exception || b->type == bp_exception_resume)
3815 {
3816 delete_breakpoint (b);
3817 continue;
3818 }
3819
3820 if (b->type == bp_catchpoint)
3821 {
3822 /* For now, none of the bp_catchpoint breakpoints need to
3823 do anything at this point. In the future, if some of
3824 the catchpoints need to something, we will need to add
3825 a new method, and call this method from here. */
3826 continue;
3827 }
3828
3829 /* bp_finish is a special case. The only way we ought to be able
3830 to see one of these when an exec() has happened, is if the user
3831 caught a vfork, and then said "finish". Ordinarily a finish just
3832 carries them to the call-site of the current callee, by setting
3833 a temporary bp there and resuming. But in this case, the finish
3834 will carry them entirely through the vfork & exec.
3835
3836 We don't want to allow a bp_finish to remain inserted now. But
3837 we can't safely delete it, 'cause finish_command has a handle to
3838 the bp on a bpstat, and will later want to delete it. There's a
3839 chance (and I've seen it happen) that if we delete the bp_finish
3840 here, that its storage will get reused by the time finish_command
3841 gets 'round to deleting the "use to be a bp_finish" breakpoint.
3842 We really must allow finish_command to delete a bp_finish.
3843
3844 In the absence of a general solution for the "how do we know
3845 it's safe to delete something others may have handles to?"
3846 problem, what we'll do here is just uninsert the bp_finish, and
3847 let finish_command delete it.
3848
3849 (We know the bp_finish is "doomed" in the sense that it's
3850 momentary, and will be deleted as soon as finish_command sees
3851 the inferior stopped. So it doesn't matter that the bp's
3852 address is probably bogus in the new a.out, unlike e.g., the
3853 solib breakpoints.) */
3854
3855 if (b->type == bp_finish)
3856 {
3857 continue;
3858 }
3859
3860 /* Without a symbolic address, we have little hope of the
3861 pre-exec() address meaning the same thing in the post-exec()
3862 a.out. */
3863 if (event_location_empty_p (b->location))
3864 {
3865 delete_breakpoint (b);
3866 continue;
3867 }
3868 }
3869 }
3870
3871 int
3872 detach_breakpoints (ptid_t ptid)
3873 {
3874 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3875 int val = 0;
3876 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_inferior_ptid ();
3877 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
3878
3879 if (ptid_get_pid (ptid) == ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid))
3880 error (_("Cannot detach breakpoints of inferior_ptid"));
3881
3882 /* Set inferior_ptid; remove_breakpoint_1 uses this global. */
3883 inferior_ptid = ptid;
3884 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3885 {
3886 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
3887 continue;
3888
3889 /* This function must physically remove breakpoints locations
3890 from the specified ptid, without modifying the breakpoint
3891 package's state. Locations of type bp_loc_other are only
3892 maintained at GDB side. So, there is no need to remove
3893 these bp_loc_other locations. Moreover, removing these
3894 would modify the breakpoint package's state. */
3895 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_other)
3896 continue;
3897
3898 if (bl->inserted)
3899 val |= remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, mark_inserted);
3900 }
3901
3902 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3903 return val;
3904 }
3905
3906 /* Remove the breakpoint location BL from the current address space.
3907 Note that this is used to detach breakpoints from a child fork.
3908 When we get here, the child isn't in the inferior list, and neither
3909 do we have objects to represent its address space --- we should
3910 *not* look at bl->pspace->aspace here. */
3911
3912 static int
3913 remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *bl, insertion_state_t is)
3914 {
3915 int val;
3916
3917 /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
3918 gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL);
3919
3920 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
3921 This should not ever happen. */
3922 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none);
3923
3924 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3925 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3926 {
3927 /* "Normal" instruction breakpoint: either the standard
3928 trap-instruction bp (bp_breakpoint), or a
3929 bp_hardware_breakpoint. */
3930
3931 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
3932 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
3933 || bl->section == NULL
3934 || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section)))
3935 {
3936 /* No overlay handling: just remove the breakpoint. */
3937
3938 /* If we're trying to uninsert a memory breakpoint that we
3939 know is set in a dynamic object that is marked
3940 shlib_disabled, then either the dynamic object was
3941 removed with "remove-symbol-file" or with
3942 "nosharedlibrary". In the former case, we don't know
3943 whether another dynamic object might have loaded over the
3944 breakpoint's address -- the user might well let us know
3945 about it next with add-symbol-file (the whole point of
3946 add-symbol-file is letting the user manually maintain a
3947 list of dynamically loaded objects). If we have the
3948 breakpoint's shadow memory, that is, this is a software
3949 breakpoint managed by GDB, check whether the breakpoint
3950 is still inserted in memory, to avoid overwriting wrong
3951 code with stale saved shadow contents. Note that HW
3952 breakpoints don't have shadow memory, as they're
3953 implemented using a mechanism that is not dependent on
3954 being able to modify the target's memory, and as such
3955 they should always be removed. */
3956 if (bl->shlib_disabled
3957 && bl->target_info.shadow_len != 0
3958 && !memory_validate_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info))
3959 val = 0;
3960 else
3961 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl);
3962 }
3963 else
3964 {
3965 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
3966 Did we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
3967 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
3968 {
3969 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active, so we
3970 should have set a breakpoint at the LMA. Remove it.
3971 */
3972 /* Ignore any failures: if the LMA is in ROM, we will
3973 have already warned when we failed to insert it. */
3974 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3975 target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
3976 &bl->overlay_target_info);
3977 else
3978 target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
3979 &bl->overlay_target_info);
3980 }
3981 /* Did we set a breakpoint at the VMA?
3982 If so, we will have marked the breakpoint 'inserted'. */
3983 if (bl->inserted)
3984 {
3985 /* Yes -- remove it. Previously we did not bother to
3986 remove the breakpoint if the section had been
3987 unmapped, but let's not rely on that being safe. We
3988 don't know what the overlay manager might do. */
3989
3990 /* However, we should remove *software* breakpoints only
3991 if the section is still mapped, or else we overwrite
3992 wrong code with the saved shadow contents. */
3993 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
3994 || section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3995 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl);
3996 else
3997 val = 0;
3998 }
3999 else
4000 {
4001 /* No -- not inserted, so no need to remove. No error. */
4002 val = 0;
4003 }
4004 }
4005
4006 /* In some cases, we might not be able to remove a breakpoint in
4007 a shared library that has already been removed, but we have
4008 not yet processed the shlib unload event. Similarly for an
4009 unloaded add-symbol-file object - the user might not yet have
4010 had the chance to remove-symbol-file it. shlib_disabled will
4011 be set if the library/object has already been removed, but
4012 the breakpoint hasn't been uninserted yet, e.g., after
4013 "nosharedlibrary" or "remove-symbol-file" with breakpoints
4014 always-inserted mode. */
4015 if (val
4016 && (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
4017 && (bl->shlib_disabled
4018 || solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address)
4019 || shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl->pspace,
4020 bl->address))))
4021 val = 0;
4022
4023 if (val)
4024 return val;
4025 bl->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
4026 }
4027 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
4028 {
4029 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
4030 && bl->owner->ops->remove_location != NULL);
4031
4032 bl->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
4033 bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl);
4034
4035 /* Failure to remove any of the hardware watchpoints comes here. */
4036 if ((is == mark_uninserted) && (bl->inserted))
4037 warning (_("Could not remove hardware watchpoint %d."),
4038 bl->owner->number);
4039 }
4040 else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint
4041 && breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
4042 && !bl->duplicate)
4043 {
4044 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
4045 && bl->owner->ops->remove_location != NULL);
4046
4047 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl);
4048 if (val)
4049 return val;
4050
4051 bl->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
4052 }
4053
4054 return 0;
4055 }
4056
4057 static int
4058 remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *bl, insertion_state_t is)
4059 {
4060 int ret;
4061 struct cleanup *old_chain;
4062
4063 /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
4064 gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL);
4065
4066 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
4067 This should not ever happen. */
4068 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none);
4069
4070 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
4071
4072 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
4073
4074 ret = remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, is);
4075
4076 do_cleanups (old_chain);
4077 return ret;
4078 }
4079
4080 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints. */
4081
4082 void
4083 mark_breakpoints_out (void)
4084 {
4085 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
4086
4087 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
4088 if (bl->pspace == current_program_space)
4089 bl->inserted = 0;
4090 }
4091
4092 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints and delete any
4093 breakpoints which should go away between runs of the program.
4094
4095 Plus other such housekeeping that has to be done for breakpoints
4096 between runs.
4097
4098 Note: this function gets called at the end of a run (by
4099 generic_mourn_inferior) and when a run begins (by
4100 init_wait_for_inferior). */
4101
4102
4103
4104 void
4105 breakpoint_init_inferior (enum inf_context context)
4106 {
4107 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
4108 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
4109 int ix;
4110 struct program_space *pspace = current_program_space;
4111
4112 /* If breakpoint locations are shared across processes, then there's
4113 nothing to do. */
4114 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()))
4115 return;
4116
4117 mark_breakpoints_out ();
4118
4119 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
4120 {
4121 if (b->loc && b->loc->pspace != pspace)
4122 continue;
4123
4124 switch (b->type)
4125 {
4126 case bp_call_dummy:
4127 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
4128
4129 /* If the call dummy breakpoint is at the entry point it will
4130 cause problems when the inferior is rerun, so we better get
4131 rid of it. */
4132
4133 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
4134
4135 /* Also get rid of scope breakpoints. */
4136
4137 case bp_shlib_event:
4138
4139 /* Also remove solib event breakpoints. Their addresses may
4140 have changed since the last time we ran the program.
4141 Actually we may now be debugging against different target;
4142 and so the solib backend that installed this breakpoint may
4143 not be used in by the target. E.g.,
4144
4145 (gdb) file prog-linux
4146 (gdb) run # native linux target
4147 ...
4148 (gdb) kill
4149 (gdb) file prog-win.exe
4150 (gdb) tar rem :9999 # remote Windows gdbserver.
4151 */
4152
4153 case bp_step_resume:
4154
4155 /* Also remove step-resume breakpoints. */
4156
4157 case bp_single_step:
4158
4159 /* Also remove single-step breakpoints. */
4160
4161 delete_breakpoint (b);
4162 break;
4163
4164 case bp_watchpoint:
4165 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
4166 case bp_read_watchpoint:
4167 case bp_access_watchpoint:
4168 {
4169 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4170
4171 /* Likewise for watchpoints on local expressions. */
4172 if (w->exp_valid_block != NULL)
4173 delete_breakpoint (b);
4174 else if (context == inf_starting)
4175 {
4176 /* Reset val field to force reread of starting value in
4177 insert_breakpoints. */
4178 if (w->val)
4179 value_free (w->val);
4180 w->val = NULL;
4181 w->val_valid = 0;
4182 }
4183 }
4184 break;
4185 default:
4186 break;
4187 }
4188 }
4189
4190 /* Get rid of the moribund locations. */
4191 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, bl); ++ix)
4192 decref_bp_location (&bl);
4193 VEC_free (bp_location_p, moribund_locations);
4194 }
4195
4196 /* These functions concern about actual breakpoints inserted in the
4197 target --- to e.g. check if we need to do decr_pc adjustment or if
4198 we need to hop over the bkpt --- so we check for address space
4199 match, not program space. */
4200
4201 /* breakpoint_here_p (PC) returns non-zero if an enabled breakpoint
4202 exists at PC. It returns ordinary_breakpoint_here if it's an
4203 ordinary breakpoint, or permanent_breakpoint_here if it's a
4204 permanent breakpoint.
4205 - When continuing from a location with an ordinary breakpoint, we
4206 actually single step once before calling insert_breakpoints.
4207 - When continuing from a location with a permanent breakpoint, we
4208 need to use the `SKIP_PERMANENT_BREAKPOINT' macro, provided by
4209 the target, to advance the PC past the breakpoint. */
4210
4211 enum breakpoint_here
4212 breakpoint_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4213 {
4214 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
4215 int any_breakpoint_here = 0;
4216
4217 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
4218 {
4219 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
4220 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4221 continue;
4222
4223 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
4224 if ((breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
4225 || bl->permanent)
4226 && breakpoint_location_address_match (bl, aspace, pc))
4227 {
4228 if (overlay_debugging
4229 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
4230 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
4231 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
4232 else if (bl->permanent)
4233 return permanent_breakpoint_here;
4234 else
4235 any_breakpoint_here = 1;
4236 }
4237 }
4238
4239 return any_breakpoint_here ? ordinary_breakpoint_here : no_breakpoint_here;
4240 }
4241
4242 /* Return true if there's a moribund breakpoint at PC. */
4243
4244 int
4245 moribund_breakpoint_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4246 {
4247 struct bp_location *loc;
4248 int ix;
4249
4250 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
4251 if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, pc))
4252 return 1;
4253
4254 return 0;
4255 }
4256
4257 /* Returns non-zero iff BL is inserted at PC, in address space
4258 ASPACE. */
4259
4260 static int
4261 bp_location_inserted_here_p (struct bp_location *bl,
4262 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4263 {
4264 if (bl->inserted
4265 && breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
4266 aspace, pc))
4267 {
4268 if (overlay_debugging
4269 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
4270 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
4271 return 0; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
4272 else
4273 return 1;
4274 }
4275 return 0;
4276 }
4277
4278 /* Returns non-zero iff there's a breakpoint inserted at PC. */
4279
4280 int
4281 breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4282 {
4283 struct bp_location **blp, **blp_tmp = NULL;
4284 struct bp_location *bl;
4285
4286 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (blp, blp_tmp, pc)
4287 {
4288 struct bp_location *bl = *blp;
4289
4290 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
4291 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4292 continue;
4293
4294 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
4295 return 1;
4296 }
4297 return 0;
4298 }
4299
4300 /* This function returns non-zero iff there is a software breakpoint
4301 inserted at PC. */
4302
4303 int
4304 software_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace,
4305 CORE_ADDR pc)
4306 {
4307 struct bp_location **blp, **blp_tmp = NULL;
4308 struct bp_location *bl;
4309
4310 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (blp, blp_tmp, pc)
4311 {
4312 struct bp_location *bl = *blp;
4313
4314 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
4315 continue;
4316
4317 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
4318 return 1;
4319 }
4320
4321 return 0;
4322 }
4323
4324 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4325
4326 int
4327 hardware_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace,
4328 CORE_ADDR pc)
4329 {
4330 struct bp_location **blp, **blp_tmp = NULL;
4331 struct bp_location *bl;
4332
4333 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (blp, blp_tmp, pc)
4334 {
4335 struct bp_location *bl = *blp;
4336
4337 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4338 continue;
4339
4340 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
4341 return 1;
4342 }
4343
4344 return 0;
4345 }
4346
4347 int
4348 hardware_watchpoint_inserted_in_range (struct address_space *aspace,
4349 CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
4350 {
4351 struct breakpoint *bpt;
4352
4353 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
4354 {
4355 struct bp_location *loc;
4356
4357 if (bpt->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
4358 && bpt->type != bp_access_watchpoint)
4359 continue;
4360
4361 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
4362 continue;
4363
4364 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
4365 if (loc->pspace->aspace == aspace && loc->inserted)
4366 {
4367 CORE_ADDR l, h;
4368
4369 /* Check for intersection. */
4370 l = max (loc->address, addr);
4371 h = min (loc->address + loc->length, addr + len);
4372 if (l < h)
4373 return 1;
4374 }
4375 }
4376 return 0;
4377 }
4378 \f
4379
4380 /* bpstat stuff. External routines' interfaces are documented
4381 in breakpoint.h. */
4382
4383 int
4384 is_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *ep)
4385 {
4386 return (ep->type == bp_catchpoint);
4387 }
4388
4389 /* Frees any storage that is part of a bpstat. Does not walk the
4390 'next' chain. */
4391
4392 static void
4393 bpstat_free (bpstat bs)
4394 {
4395 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
4396 value_free (bs->old_val);
4397 decref_counted_command_line (&bs->commands);
4398 decref_bp_location (&bs->bp_location_at);
4399 xfree (bs);
4400 }
4401
4402 /* Clear a bpstat so that it says we are not at any breakpoint.
4403 Also free any storage that is part of a bpstat. */
4404
4405 void
4406 bpstat_clear (bpstat *bsp)
4407 {
4408 bpstat p;
4409 bpstat q;
4410
4411 if (bsp == 0)
4412 return;
4413 p = *bsp;
4414 while (p != NULL)
4415 {
4416 q = p->next;
4417 bpstat_free (p);
4418 p = q;
4419 }
4420 *bsp = NULL;
4421 }
4422
4423 /* Return a copy of a bpstat. Like "bs1 = bs2" but all storage that
4424 is part of the bpstat is copied as well. */
4425
4426 bpstat
4427 bpstat_copy (bpstat bs)
4428 {
4429 bpstat p = NULL;
4430 bpstat tmp;
4431 bpstat retval = NULL;
4432
4433 if (bs == NULL)
4434 return bs;
4435
4436 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4437 {
4438 tmp = (bpstat) xmalloc (sizeof (*tmp));
4439 memcpy (tmp, bs, sizeof (*tmp));
4440 incref_counted_command_line (tmp->commands);
4441 incref_bp_location (tmp->bp_location_at);
4442 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
4443 {
4444 tmp->old_val = value_copy (bs->old_val);
4445 release_value (tmp->old_val);
4446 }
4447
4448 if (p == NULL)
4449 /* This is the first thing in the chain. */
4450 retval = tmp;
4451 else
4452 p->next = tmp;
4453 p = tmp;
4454 }
4455 p->next = NULL;
4456 return retval;
4457 }
4458
4459 /* Find the bpstat associated with this breakpoint. */
4460
4461 bpstat
4462 bpstat_find_breakpoint (bpstat bsp, struct breakpoint *breakpoint)
4463 {
4464 if (bsp == NULL)
4465 return NULL;
4466
4467 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
4468 {
4469 if (bsp->breakpoint_at == breakpoint)
4470 return bsp;
4471 }
4472 return NULL;
4473 }
4474
4475 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4476
4477 int
4478 bpstat_explains_signal (bpstat bsp, enum gdb_signal sig)
4479 {
4480 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
4481 {
4482 if (bsp->breakpoint_at == NULL)
4483 {
4484 /* A moribund location can never explain a signal other than
4485 GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP. */
4486 if (sig == GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
4487 return 1;
4488 }
4489 else
4490 {
4491 if (bsp->breakpoint_at->ops->explains_signal (bsp->breakpoint_at,
4492 sig))
4493 return 1;
4494 }
4495 }
4496
4497 return 0;
4498 }
4499
4500 /* Put in *NUM the breakpoint number of the first breakpoint we are
4501 stopped at. *BSP upon return is a bpstat which points to the
4502 remaining breakpoints stopped at (but which is not guaranteed to be
4503 good for anything but further calls to bpstat_num).
4504
4505 Return 0 if passed a bpstat which does not indicate any breakpoints.
4506 Return -1 if stopped at a breakpoint that has been deleted since
4507 we set it.
4508 Return 1 otherwise. */
4509
4510 int
4511 bpstat_num (bpstat *bsp, int *num)
4512 {
4513 struct breakpoint *b;
4514
4515 if ((*bsp) == NULL)
4516 return 0; /* No more breakpoint values */
4517
4518 /* We assume we'll never have several bpstats that correspond to a
4519 single breakpoint -- otherwise, this function might return the
4520 same number more than once and this will look ugly. */
4521 b = (*bsp)->breakpoint_at;
4522 *bsp = (*bsp)->next;
4523 if (b == NULL)
4524 return -1; /* breakpoint that's been deleted since */
4525
4526 *num = b->number; /* We have its number */
4527 return 1;
4528 }
4529
4530 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4531
4532 void
4533 bpstat_clear_actions (void)
4534 {
4535 struct thread_info *tp;
4536 bpstat bs;
4537
4538 if (ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
4539 return;
4540
4541 tp = find_thread_ptid (inferior_ptid);
4542 if (tp == NULL)
4543 return;
4544
4545 for (bs = tp->control.stop_bpstat; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4546 {
4547 decref_counted_command_line (&bs->commands);
4548
4549 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
4550 {
4551 value_free (bs->old_val);
4552 bs->old_val = NULL;
4553 }
4554 }
4555 }
4556
4557 /* Called when a command is about to proceed the inferior. */
4558
4559 static void
4560 breakpoint_about_to_proceed (void)
4561 {
4562 if (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
4563 {
4564 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
4565
4566 /* Allow inferior function calls in breakpoint commands to not
4567 interrupt the command list. When the call finishes
4568 successfully, the inferior will be standing at the same
4569 breakpoint as if nothing happened. */
4570 if (tp->control.in_infcall)
4571 return;
4572 }
4573
4574 breakpoint_proceeded = 1;
4575 }
4576
4577 /* Stub for cleaning up our state if we error-out of a breakpoint
4578 command. */
4579 static void
4580 cleanup_executing_breakpoints (void *ignore)
4581 {
4582 executing_breakpoint_commands = 0;
4583 }
4584
4585 /* Return non-zero iff CMD as the first line of a command sequence is `silent'
4586 or its equivalent. */
4587
4588 static int
4589 command_line_is_silent (struct command_line *cmd)
4590 {
4591 return cmd && (strcmp ("silent", cmd->line) == 0);
4592 }
4593
4594 /* Execute all the commands associated with all the breakpoints at
4595 this location. Any of these commands could cause the process to
4596 proceed beyond this point, etc. We look out for such changes by
4597 checking the global "breakpoint_proceeded" after each command.
4598
4599 Returns true if a breakpoint command resumed the inferior. In that
4600 case, it is the caller's responsibility to recall it again with the
4601 bpstat of the current thread. */
4602
4603 static int
4604 bpstat_do_actions_1 (bpstat *bsp)
4605 {
4606 bpstat bs;
4607 struct cleanup *old_chain;
4608 int again = 0;
4609
4610 /* Avoid endless recursion if a `source' command is contained
4611 in bs->commands. */
4612 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
4613 return 0;
4614
4615 executing_breakpoint_commands = 1;
4616 old_chain = make_cleanup (cleanup_executing_breakpoints, 0);
4617
4618 prevent_dont_repeat ();
4619
4620 /* This pointer will iterate over the list of bpstat's. */
4621 bs = *bsp;
4622
4623 breakpoint_proceeded = 0;
4624 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4625 {
4626 struct counted_command_line *ccmd;
4627 struct command_line *cmd;
4628 struct cleanup *this_cmd_tree_chain;
4629
4630 /* Take ownership of the BSP's command tree, if it has one.
4631
4632 The command tree could legitimately contain commands like
4633 'step' and 'next', which call clear_proceed_status, which
4634 frees stop_bpstat's command tree. To make sure this doesn't
4635 free the tree we're executing out from under us, we need to
4636 take ownership of the tree ourselves. Since a given bpstat's
4637 commands are only executed once, we don't need to copy it; we
4638 can clear the pointer in the bpstat, and make sure we free
4639 the tree when we're done. */
4640 ccmd = bs->commands;
4641 bs->commands = NULL;
4642 this_cmd_tree_chain = make_cleanup_decref_counted_command_line (&ccmd);
4643 cmd = ccmd ? ccmd->commands : NULL;
4644 if (command_line_is_silent (cmd))
4645 {
4646 /* The action has been already done by bpstat_stop_status. */
4647 cmd = cmd->next;
4648 }
4649
4650 while (cmd != NULL)
4651 {
4652 execute_control_command (cmd);
4653
4654 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
4655 break;
4656 else
4657 cmd = cmd->next;
4658 }
4659
4660 /* We can free this command tree now. */
4661 do_cleanups (this_cmd_tree_chain);
4662
4663 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
4664 {
4665 if (interpreter_async && target_can_async_p ())
4666 /* If we are in async mode, then the target might be still
4667 running, not stopped at any breakpoint, so nothing for
4668 us to do here -- just return to the event loop. */
4669 ;
4670 else
4671 /* In sync mode, when execute_control_command returns
4672 we're already standing on the next breakpoint.
4673 Breakpoint commands for that stop were not run, since
4674 execute_command does not run breakpoint commands --
4675 only command_line_handler does, but that one is not
4676 involved in execution of breakpoint commands. So, we
4677 can now execute breakpoint commands. It should be
4678 noted that making execute_command do bpstat actions is
4679 not an option -- in this case we'll have recursive
4680 invocation of bpstat for each breakpoint with a
4681 command, and can easily blow up GDB stack. Instead, we
4682 return true, which will trigger the caller to recall us
4683 with the new stop_bpstat. */
4684 again = 1;
4685 break;
4686 }
4687 }
4688 do_cleanups (old_chain);
4689 return again;
4690 }
4691
4692 void
4693 bpstat_do_actions (void)
4694 {
4695 struct cleanup *cleanup_if_error = make_bpstat_clear_actions_cleanup ();
4696
4697 /* Do any commands attached to breakpoint we are stopped at. */
4698 while (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid)
4699 && target_has_execution
4700 && !is_exited (inferior_ptid)
4701 && !is_executing (inferior_ptid))
4702 /* Since in sync mode, bpstat_do_actions may resume the inferior,
4703 and only return when it is stopped at the next breakpoint, we
4704 keep doing breakpoint actions until it returns false to
4705 indicate the inferior was not resumed. */
4706 if (!bpstat_do_actions_1 (&inferior_thread ()->control.stop_bpstat))
4707 break;
4708
4709 discard_cleanups (cleanup_if_error);
4710 }
4711
4712 /* Print out the (old or new) value associated with a watchpoint. */
4713
4714 static void
4715 watchpoint_value_print (struct value *val, struct ui_file *stream)
4716 {
4717 if (val == NULL)
4718 fprintf_unfiltered (stream, _("<unreadable>"));
4719 else
4720 {
4721 struct value_print_options opts;
4722 get_user_print_options (&opts);
4723 value_print (val, stream, &opts);
4724 }
4725 }
4726
4727 /* Generic routine for printing messages indicating why we
4728 stopped. The behavior of this function depends on the value
4729 'print_it' in the bpstat structure. Under some circumstances we
4730 may decide not to print anything here and delegate the task to
4731 normal_stop(). */
4732
4733 static enum print_stop_action
4734 print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs)
4735 {
4736 switch (bs->print_it)
4737 {
4738 case print_it_noop:
4739 /* Nothing should be printed for this bpstat entry. */
4740 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4741 break;
4742
4743 case print_it_done:
4744 /* We still want to print the frame, but we already printed the
4745 relevant messages. */
4746 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
4747 break;
4748
4749 case print_it_normal:
4750 {
4751 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
4752
4753 /* bs->breakpoint_at can be NULL if it was a momentary breakpoint
4754 which has since been deleted. */
4755 if (b == NULL)
4756 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4757
4758 /* Normal case. Call the breakpoint's print_it method. */
4759 return b->ops->print_it (bs);
4760 }
4761 break;
4762
4763 default:
4764 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4765 _("print_bp_stop_message: unrecognized enum value"));
4766 break;
4767 }
4768 }
4769
4770 /* A helper function that prints a shared library stopped event. */
4771
4772 static void
4773 print_solib_event (int is_catchpoint)
4774 {
4775 int any_deleted
4776 = !VEC_empty (char_ptr, current_program_space->deleted_solibs);
4777 int any_added
4778 = !VEC_empty (so_list_ptr, current_program_space->added_solibs);
4779
4780 if (!is_catchpoint)
4781 {
4782 if (any_added || any_deleted)
4783 ui_out_text (current_uiout,
4784 _("Stopped due to shared library event:\n"));
4785 else
4786 ui_out_text (current_uiout,
4787 _("Stopped due to shared library event (no "
4788 "libraries added or removed)\n"));
4789 }
4790
4791 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (current_uiout))
4792 ui_out_field_string (current_uiout, "reason",
4793 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_SOLIB_EVENT));
4794
4795 if (any_deleted)
4796 {
4797 struct cleanup *cleanup;
4798 char *name;
4799 int ix;
4800
4801 ui_out_text (current_uiout, _(" Inferior unloaded "));
4802 cleanup = make_cleanup_ui_out_list_begin_end (current_uiout,
4803 "removed");
4804 for (ix = 0;
4805 VEC_iterate (char_ptr, current_program_space->deleted_solibs,
4806 ix, name);
4807 ++ix)
4808 {
4809 if (ix > 0)
4810 ui_out_text (current_uiout, " ");
4811 ui_out_field_string (current_uiout, "library", name);
4812 ui_out_text (current_uiout, "\n");
4813 }
4814
4815 do_cleanups (cleanup);
4816 }
4817
4818 if (any_added)
4819 {
4820 struct so_list *iter;
4821 int ix;
4822 struct cleanup *cleanup;
4823
4824 ui_out_text (current_uiout, _(" Inferior loaded "));
4825 cleanup = make_cleanup_ui_out_list_begin_end (current_uiout,
4826 "added");
4827 for (ix = 0;
4828 VEC_iterate (so_list_ptr, current_program_space->added_solibs,
4829 ix, iter);
4830 ++ix)
4831 {
4832 if (ix > 0)
4833 ui_out_text (current_uiout, " ");
4834 ui_out_field_string (current_uiout, "library", iter->so_name);
4835 ui_out_text (current_uiout, "\n");
4836 }
4837
4838 do_cleanups (cleanup);
4839 }
4840 }
4841
4842 /* Print a message indicating what happened. This is called from
4843 normal_stop(). The input to this routine is the head of the bpstat
4844 list - a list of the eventpoints that caused this stop. KIND is
4845 the target_waitkind for the stopping event. This
4846 routine calls the generic print routine for printing a message
4847 about reasons for stopping. This will print (for example) the
4848 "Breakpoint n," part of the output. The return value of this
4849 routine is one of:
4850
4851 PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing.
4852 PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and expect subsequent
4853 code to print the location. An example is
4854 "Breakpoint 1, " which should be followed by
4855 the location.
4856 PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, but there is no need
4857 to also print the location part of the message.
4858 An example is the catch/throw messages, which
4859 don't require a location appended to the end.
4860 PRINT_NOTHING: We have done some printing and we don't need any
4861 further info to be printed. */
4862
4863 enum print_stop_action
4864 bpstat_print (bpstat bs, int kind)
4865 {
4866 enum print_stop_action val;
4867
4868 /* Maybe another breakpoint in the chain caused us to stop.
4869 (Currently all watchpoints go on the bpstat whether hit or not.
4870 That probably could (should) be changed, provided care is taken
4871 with respect to bpstat_explains_signal). */
4872 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
4873 {
4874 val = print_bp_stop_message (bs);
4875 if (val == PRINT_SRC_ONLY
4876 || val == PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC
4877 || val == PRINT_NOTHING)
4878 return val;
4879 }
4880
4881 /* If we had hit a shared library event breakpoint,
4882 print_bp_stop_message would print out this message. If we hit an
4883 OS-level shared library event, do the same thing. */
4884 if (kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_LOADED)
4885 {
4886 print_solib_event (0);
4887 return PRINT_NOTHING;
4888 }
4889
4890 /* We reached the end of the chain, or we got a null BS to start
4891 with and nothing was printed. */
4892 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4893 }
4894
4895 /* Evaluate the expression EXP and return 1 if value is zero.
4896 This returns the inverse of the condition because it is called
4897 from catch_errors which returns 0 if an exception happened, and if an
4898 exception happens we want execution to stop.
4899 The argument is a "struct expression *" that has been cast to a
4900 "void *" to make it pass through catch_errors. */
4901
4902 static int
4903 breakpoint_cond_eval (void *exp)
4904 {
4905 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
4906 int i = !value_true (evaluate_expression ((struct expression *) exp));
4907
4908 value_free_to_mark (mark);
4909 return i;
4910 }
4911
4912 /* Allocate a new bpstat. Link it to the FIFO list by BS_LINK_POINTER. */
4913
4914 static bpstat
4915 bpstat_alloc (struct bp_location *bl, bpstat **bs_link_pointer)
4916 {
4917 bpstat bs;
4918
4919 bs = (bpstat) xmalloc (sizeof (*bs));
4920 bs->next = NULL;
4921 **bs_link_pointer = bs;
4922 *bs_link_pointer = &bs->next;
4923 bs->breakpoint_at = bl->owner;
4924 bs->bp_location_at = bl;
4925 incref_bp_location (bl);
4926 /* If the condition is false, etc., don't do the commands. */
4927 bs->commands = NULL;
4928 bs->old_val = NULL;
4929 bs->print_it = print_it_normal;
4930 return bs;
4931 }
4932 \f
4933 /* The target has stopped with waitstatus WS. Check if any hardware
4934 watchpoints have triggered, according to the target. */
4935
4936 int
4937 watchpoints_triggered (struct target_waitstatus *ws)
4938 {
4939 int stopped_by_watchpoint = target_stopped_by_watchpoint ();
4940 CORE_ADDR addr;
4941 struct breakpoint *b;
4942
4943 if (!stopped_by_watchpoint)
4944 {
4945 /* We were not stopped by a watchpoint. Mark all watchpoints
4946 as not triggered. */
4947 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4948 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4949 {
4950 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4951
4952 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
4953 }
4954
4955 return 0;
4956 }
4957
4958 if (!target_stopped_data_address (&current_target, &addr))
4959 {
4960 /* We were stopped by a watchpoint, but we don't know where.
4961 Mark all watchpoints as unknown. */
4962 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4963 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4964 {
4965 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4966
4967 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_unknown;
4968 }
4969
4970 return 1;
4971 }
4972
4973 /* The target could report the data address. Mark watchpoints
4974 affected by this data address as triggered, and all others as not
4975 triggered. */
4976
4977 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4978 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4979 {
4980 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4981 struct bp_location *loc;
4982
4983 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
4984 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
4985 {
4986 if (is_masked_watchpoint (b))
4987 {
4988 CORE_ADDR newaddr = addr & w->hw_wp_mask;
4989 CORE_ADDR start = loc->address & w->hw_wp_mask;
4990
4991 if (newaddr == start)
4992 {
4993 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
4994 break;
4995 }
4996 }
4997 /* Exact match not required. Within range is sufficient. */
4998 else if (target_watchpoint_addr_within_range (&current_target,
4999 addr, loc->address,
5000 loc->length))
5001 {
5002 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
5003 break;
5004 }
5005 }
5006 }
5007
5008 return 1;
5009 }
5010
5011 /* Possible return values for watchpoint_check (this can't be an enum
5012 because of check_errors). */
5013 /* The watchpoint has been deleted. */
5014 #define WP_DELETED 1
5015 /* The value has changed. */
5016 #define WP_VALUE_CHANGED 2
5017 /* The value has not changed. */
5018 #define WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED 3
5019 /* Ignore this watchpoint, no matter if the value changed or not. */
5020 #define WP_IGNORE 4
5021
5022 #define BP_TEMPFLAG 1
5023 #define BP_HARDWAREFLAG 2
5024
5025 /* Evaluate watchpoint condition expression and check if its value
5026 changed.
5027
5028 P should be a pointer to struct bpstat, but is defined as a void *
5029 in order for this function to be usable with catch_errors. */
5030
5031 static int
5032 watchpoint_check (void *p)
5033 {
5034 bpstat bs = (bpstat) p;
5035 struct watchpoint *b;
5036 struct frame_info *fr;
5037 int within_current_scope;
5038
5039 /* BS is built from an existing struct breakpoint. */
5040 gdb_assert (bs->breakpoint_at != NULL);
5041 b = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
5042
5043 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
5044 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
5045 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
5046 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
5047 return WP_IGNORE;
5048
5049 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
5050 within_current_scope = 1;
5051 else
5052 {
5053 struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame ();
5054 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (frame);
5055 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (frame);
5056
5057 /* stack_frame_destroyed_p() returns a non-zero value if we're
5058 still in the function but the stack frame has already been
5059 invalidated. Since we can't rely on the values of local
5060 variables after the stack has been destroyed, we are treating
5061 the watchpoint in that state as `not changed' without further
5062 checking. Don't mark watchpoints as changed if the current
5063 frame is in an epilogue - even if they are in some other
5064 frame, our view of the stack is likely to be wrong and
5065 frame_find_by_id could error out. */
5066 if (gdbarch_stack_frame_destroyed_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
5067 return WP_IGNORE;
5068
5069 fr = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
5070 within_current_scope = (fr != NULL);
5071
5072 /* If we've gotten confused in the unwinder, we might have
5073 returned a frame that can't describe this variable. */
5074 if (within_current_scope)
5075 {
5076 struct symbol *function;
5077
5078 function = get_frame_function (fr);
5079 if (function == NULL
5080 || !contained_in (b->exp_valid_block,
5081 SYMBOL_BLOCK_VALUE (function)))
5082 within_current_scope = 0;
5083 }
5084
5085 if (within_current_scope)
5086 /* If we end up stopping, the current frame will get selected
5087 in normal_stop. So this call to select_frame won't affect
5088 the user. */
5089 select_frame (fr);
5090 }
5091
5092 if (within_current_scope)
5093 {
5094 /* We use value_{,free_to_}mark because it could be a *long*
5095 time before we return to the command level and call
5096 free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values because we
5097 might be in the middle of evaluating a function call. */
5098
5099 int pc = 0;
5100 struct value *mark;
5101 struct value *new_val;
5102
5103 if (is_masked_watchpoint (&b->base))
5104 /* Since we don't know the exact trigger address (from
5105 stopped_data_address), just tell the user we've triggered
5106 a mask watchpoint. */
5107 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
5108
5109 mark = value_mark ();
5110 fetch_subexp_value (b->exp, &pc, &new_val, NULL, NULL, 0);
5111
5112 if (b->val_bitsize != 0)
5113 new_val = extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (b, new_val);
5114
5115 /* We use value_equal_contents instead of value_equal because
5116 the latter coerces an array to a pointer, thus comparing just
5117 the address of the array instead of its contents. This is
5118 not what we want. */
5119 if ((b->val != NULL) != (new_val != NULL)
5120 || (b->val != NULL && !value_equal_contents (b->val, new_val)))
5121 {
5122 if (new_val != NULL)
5123 {
5124 release_value (new_val);
5125 value_free_to_mark (mark);
5126 }
5127 bs->old_val = b->val;
5128 b->val = new_val;
5129 b->val_valid = 1;
5130 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
5131 }
5132 else
5133 {
5134 /* Nothing changed. */
5135 value_free_to_mark (mark);
5136 return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
5137 }
5138 }
5139 else
5140 {
5141 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
5142
5143 /* This seems like the only logical thing to do because
5144 if we temporarily ignored the watchpoint, then when
5145 we reenter the block in which it is valid it contains
5146 garbage (in the case of a function, it may have two
5147 garbage values, one before and one after the prologue).
5148 So we can't even detect the first assignment to it and
5149 watch after that (since the garbage may or may not equal
5150 the first value assigned). */
5151 /* We print all the stop information in
5152 breakpoint_ops->print_it, but in this case, by the time we
5153 call breakpoint_ops->print_it this bp will be deleted
5154 already. So we have no choice but print the information
5155 here. */
5156 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
5157 ui_out_field_string
5158 (uiout, "reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_SCOPE));
5159 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nWatchpoint ");
5160 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "wpnum", b->base.number);
5161 ui_out_text (uiout,
5162 " deleted because the program has left the block in\n\
5163 which its expression is valid.\n");
5164
5165 /* Make sure the watchpoint's commands aren't executed. */
5166 decref_counted_command_line (&b->base.commands);
5167 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
5168
5169 return WP_DELETED;
5170 }
5171 }
5172
5173 /* Return true if it looks like target has stopped due to hitting
5174 breakpoint location BL. This function does not check if we should
5175 stop, only if BL explains the stop. */
5176
5177 static int
5178 bpstat_check_location (const struct bp_location *bl,
5179 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
5180 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
5181 {
5182 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
5183
5184 /* BL is from an existing breakpoint. */
5185 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
5186
5187 return b->ops->breakpoint_hit (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws);
5188 }
5189
5190 /* Determine if the watched values have actually changed, and we
5191 should stop. If not, set BS->stop to 0. */
5192
5193 static void
5194 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
5195 {
5196 const struct bp_location *bl;
5197 struct watchpoint *b;
5198
5199 /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
5200 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
5201 gdb_assert (bl != NULL);
5202 b = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
5203 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
5204
5205 {
5206 int must_check_value = 0;
5207
5208 if (b->base.type == bp_watchpoint)
5209 /* For a software watchpoint, we must always check the
5210 watched value. */
5211 must_check_value = 1;
5212 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_yes)
5213 /* We have a hardware watchpoint (read, write, or access)
5214 and the target earlier reported an address watched by
5215 this watchpoint. */
5216 must_check_value = 1;
5217 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_unknown
5218 && b->base.type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
5219 /* We were stopped by a hardware watchpoint, but the target could
5220 not report the data address. We must check the watchpoint's
5221 value. Access and read watchpoints are out of luck; without
5222 a data address, we can't figure it out. */
5223 must_check_value = 1;
5224
5225 if (must_check_value)
5226 {
5227 char *message
5228 = xstrprintf ("Error evaluating expression for watchpoint %d\n",
5229 b->base.number);
5230 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
5231 int e = catch_errors (watchpoint_check, bs, message,
5232 RETURN_MASK_ALL);
5233 do_cleanups (cleanups);
5234 switch (e)
5235 {
5236 case WP_DELETED:
5237 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
5238 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
5239 /* Stop. */
5240 break;
5241 case WP_IGNORE:
5242 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5243 bs->stop = 0;
5244 break;
5245 case WP_VALUE_CHANGED:
5246 if (b->base.type == bp_read_watchpoint)
5247 {
5248 /* There are two cases to consider here:
5249
5250 1. We're watching the triggered memory for reads.
5251 In that case, trust the target, and always report
5252 the watchpoint hit to the user. Even though
5253 reads don't cause value changes, the value may
5254 have changed since the last time it was read, and
5255 since we're not trapping writes, we will not see
5256 those, and as such we should ignore our notion of
5257 old value.
5258
5259 2. We're watching the triggered memory for both
5260 reads and writes. There are two ways this may
5261 happen:
5262
5263 2.1. This is a target that can't break on data
5264 reads only, but can break on accesses (reads or
5265 writes), such as e.g., x86. We detect this case
5266 at the time we try to insert read watchpoints.
5267
5268 2.2. Otherwise, the target supports read
5269 watchpoints, but, the user set an access or write
5270 watchpoint watching the same memory as this read
5271 watchpoint.
5272
5273 If we're watching memory writes as well as reads,
5274 ignore watchpoint hits when we find that the
5275 value hasn't changed, as reads don't cause
5276 changes. This still gives false positives when
5277 the program writes the same value to memory as
5278 what there was already in memory (we will confuse
5279 it for a read), but it's much better than
5280 nothing. */
5281
5282 int other_write_watchpoint = 0;
5283
5284 if (bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
5285 {
5286 struct breakpoint *other_b;
5287
5288 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (other_b)
5289 if (other_b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
5290 || other_b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
5291 {
5292 struct watchpoint *other_w =
5293 (struct watchpoint *) other_b;
5294
5295 if (other_w->watchpoint_triggered
5296 == watch_triggered_yes)
5297 {
5298 other_write_watchpoint = 1;
5299 break;
5300 }
5301 }
5302 }
5303
5304 if (other_write_watchpoint
5305 || bl->watchpoint_type == hw_access)
5306 {
5307 /* We're watching the same memory for writes,
5308 and the value changed since the last time we
5309 updated it, so this trap must be for a write.
5310 Ignore it. */
5311 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5312 bs->stop = 0;
5313 }
5314 }
5315 break;
5316 case WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED:
5317 if (b->base.type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
5318 || b->base.type == bp_watchpoint)
5319 {
5320 /* Don't stop: write watchpoints shouldn't fire if
5321 the value hasn't changed. */
5322 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5323 bs->stop = 0;
5324 }
5325 /* Stop. */
5326 break;
5327 default:
5328 /* Can't happen. */
5329 case 0:
5330 /* Error from catch_errors. */
5331 printf_filtered (_("Watchpoint %d deleted.\n"), b->base.number);
5332 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
5333 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
5334 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
5335 break;
5336 }
5337 }
5338 else /* must_check_value == 0 */
5339 {
5340 /* This is a case where some watchpoint(s) triggered, but
5341 not at the address of this watchpoint, or else no
5342 watchpoint triggered after all. So don't print
5343 anything for this watchpoint. */
5344 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5345 bs->stop = 0;
5346 }
5347 }
5348 }
5349
5350 /* For breakpoints that are currently marked as telling gdb to stop,
5351 check conditions (condition proper, frame, thread and ignore count)
5352 of breakpoint referred to by BS. If we should not stop for this
5353 breakpoint, set BS->stop to 0. */
5354
5355 static void
5356 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bpstat bs, ptid_t ptid)
5357 {
5358 const struct bp_location *bl;
5359 struct breakpoint *b;
5360 int value_is_zero = 0;
5361 struct expression *cond;
5362
5363 gdb_assert (bs->stop);
5364
5365 /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
5366 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
5367 gdb_assert (bl != NULL);
5368 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5369 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
5370
5371 /* Even if the target evaluated the condition on its end and notified GDB, we
5372 need to do so again since GDB does not know if we stopped due to a
5373 breakpoint or a single step breakpoint. */
5374
5375 if (frame_id_p (b->frame_id)
5376 && !frame_id_eq (b->frame_id, get_stack_frame_id (get_current_frame ())))
5377 {
5378 bs->stop = 0;
5379 return;
5380 }
5381
5382 /* If this is a thread/task-specific breakpoint, don't waste cpu
5383 evaluating the condition if this isn't the specified
5384 thread/task. */
5385 if ((b->thread != -1 && b->thread != pid_to_thread_id (ptid))
5386 || (b->task != 0 && b->task != ada_get_task_number (ptid)))
5387
5388 {
5389 bs->stop = 0;
5390 return;
5391 }
5392
5393 /* Evaluate extension language breakpoints that have a "stop" method
5394 implemented. */
5395 bs->stop = breakpoint_ext_lang_cond_says_stop (b);
5396
5397 if (is_watchpoint (b))
5398 {
5399 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
5400
5401 cond = w->cond_exp;
5402 }
5403 else
5404 cond = bl->cond;
5405
5406 if (cond && b->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
5407 {
5408 int within_current_scope = 1;
5409 struct watchpoint * w;
5410
5411 /* We use value_mark and value_free_to_mark because it could
5412 be a long time before we return to the command level and
5413 call free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values
5414 because we might be in the middle of evaluating a
5415 function call. */
5416 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
5417
5418 if (is_watchpoint (b))
5419 w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
5420 else
5421 w = NULL;
5422
5423 /* Need to select the frame, with all that implies so that
5424 the conditions will have the right context. Because we
5425 use the frame, we will not see an inlined function's
5426 variables when we arrive at a breakpoint at the start
5427 of the inlined function; the current frame will be the
5428 call site. */
5429 if (w == NULL || w->cond_exp_valid_block == NULL)
5430 select_frame (get_current_frame ());
5431 else
5432 {
5433 struct frame_info *frame;
5434
5435 /* For local watchpoint expressions, which particular
5436 instance of a local is being watched matters, so we
5437 keep track of the frame to evaluate the expression
5438 in. To evaluate the condition however, it doesn't
5439 really matter which instantiation of the function
5440 where the condition makes sense triggers the
5441 watchpoint. This allows an expression like "watch
5442 global if q > 10" set in `func', catch writes to
5443 global on all threads that call `func', or catch
5444 writes on all recursive calls of `func' by a single
5445 thread. We simply always evaluate the condition in
5446 the innermost frame that's executing where it makes
5447 sense to evaluate the condition. It seems
5448 intuitive. */
5449 frame = block_innermost_frame (w->cond_exp_valid_block);
5450 if (frame != NULL)
5451 select_frame (frame);
5452 else
5453 within_current_scope = 0;
5454 }
5455 if (within_current_scope)
5456 value_is_zero
5457 = catch_errors (breakpoint_cond_eval, cond,
5458 "Error in testing breakpoint condition:\n",
5459 RETURN_MASK_ALL);
5460 else
5461 {
5462 warning (_("Watchpoint condition cannot be tested "
5463 "in the current scope"));
5464 /* If we failed to set the right context for this
5465 watchpoint, unconditionally report it. */
5466 value_is_zero = 0;
5467 }
5468 /* FIXME-someday, should give breakpoint #. */
5469 value_free_to_mark (mark);
5470 }
5471
5472 if (cond && value_is_zero)
5473 {
5474 bs->stop = 0;
5475 }
5476 else if (b->ignore_count > 0)
5477 {
5478 b->ignore_count--;
5479 bs->stop = 0;
5480 /* Increase the hit count even though we don't stop. */
5481 ++(b->hit_count);
5482 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
5483 }
5484 }
5485
5486 /* Returns true if we need to track moribund locations of LOC's type
5487 on the current target. */
5488
5489 static int
5490 need_moribund_for_location_type (struct bp_location *loc)
5491 {
5492 return ((loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
5493 && !target_supports_stopped_by_sw_breakpoint ())
5494 || (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
5495 && !target_supports_stopped_by_hw_breakpoint ()));
5496 }
5497
5498
5499 /* Get a bpstat associated with having just stopped at address
5500 BP_ADDR in thread PTID.
5501
5502 Determine whether we stopped at a breakpoint, etc, or whether we
5503 don't understand this stop. Result is a chain of bpstat's such
5504 that:
5505
5506 if we don't understand the stop, the result is a null pointer.
5507
5508 if we understand why we stopped, the result is not null.
5509
5510 Each element of the chain refers to a particular breakpoint or
5511 watchpoint at which we have stopped. (We may have stopped for
5512 several reasons concurrently.)
5513
5514 Each element of the chain has valid next, breakpoint_at,
5515 commands, FIXME??? fields. */
5516
5517 bpstat
5518 bpstat_stop_status (struct address_space *aspace,
5519 CORE_ADDR bp_addr, ptid_t ptid,
5520 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
5521 {
5522 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
5523 struct bp_location *bl;
5524 struct bp_location *loc;
5525 /* First item of allocated bpstat's. */
5526 bpstat bs_head = NULL, *bs_link = &bs_head;
5527 /* Pointer to the last thing in the chain currently. */
5528 bpstat bs;
5529 int ix;
5530 int need_remove_insert;
5531 int removed_any;
5532
5533 /* First, build the bpstat chain with locations that explain a
5534 target stop, while being careful to not set the target running,
5535 as that may invalidate locations (in particular watchpoint
5536 locations are recreated). Resuming will happen here with
5537 breakpoint conditions or watchpoint expressions that include
5538 inferior function calls. */
5539
5540 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5541 {
5542 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
5543 continue;
5544
5545 for (bl = b->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
5546 {
5547 /* For hardware watchpoints, we look only at the first
5548 location. The watchpoint_check function will work on the
5549 entire expression, not the individual locations. For
5550 read watchpoints, the watchpoints_triggered function has
5551 checked all locations already. */
5552 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint && bl != b->loc)
5553 break;
5554
5555 if (!bl->enabled || bl->shlib_disabled)
5556 continue;
5557
5558 if (!bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws))
5559 continue;
5560
5561 /* Come here if it's a watchpoint, or if the break address
5562 matches. */
5563
5564 bs = bpstat_alloc (bl, &bs_link); /* Alloc a bpstat to
5565 explain stop. */
5566
5567 /* Assume we stop. Should we find a watchpoint that is not
5568 actually triggered, or if the condition of the breakpoint
5569 evaluates as false, we'll reset 'stop' to 0. */
5570 bs->stop = 1;
5571 bs->print = 1;
5572
5573 /* If this is a scope breakpoint, mark the associated
5574 watchpoint as triggered so that we will handle the
5575 out-of-scope event. We'll get to the watchpoint next
5576 iteration. */
5577 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint_scope && b->related_breakpoint != b)
5578 {
5579 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b->related_breakpoint;
5580
5581 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
5582 }
5583 }
5584 }
5585
5586 /* Check if a moribund breakpoint explains the stop. */
5587 if (!target_supports_stopped_by_sw_breakpoint ()
5588 || !target_supports_stopped_by_hw_breakpoint ())
5589 {
5590 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
5591 {
5592 if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, bp_addr)
5593 && need_moribund_for_location_type (loc))
5594 {
5595 bs = bpstat_alloc (loc, &bs_link);
5596 /* For hits of moribund locations, we should just proceed. */
5597 bs->stop = 0;
5598 bs->print = 0;
5599 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5600 }
5601 }
5602 }
5603
5604 /* A bit of special processing for shlib breakpoints. We need to
5605 process solib loading here, so that the lists of loaded and
5606 unloaded libraries are correct before we handle "catch load" and
5607 "catch unload". */
5608 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5609 {
5610 if (bs->breakpoint_at && bs->breakpoint_at->type == bp_shlib_event)
5611 {
5612 handle_solib_event ();
5613 break;
5614 }
5615 }
5616
5617 /* Now go through the locations that caused the target to stop, and
5618 check whether we're interested in reporting this stop to higher
5619 layers, or whether we should resume the target transparently. */
5620
5621 removed_any = 0;
5622
5623 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5624 {
5625 if (!bs->stop)
5626 continue;
5627
5628 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5629 b->ops->check_status (bs);
5630 if (bs->stop)
5631 {
5632 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bs, ptid);
5633
5634 if (bs->stop)
5635 {
5636 ++(b->hit_count);
5637 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
5638
5639 /* We will stop here. */
5640 if (b->disposition == disp_disable)
5641 {
5642 --(b->enable_count);
5643 if (b->enable_count <= 0)
5644 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
5645 removed_any = 1;
5646 }
5647 if (b->silent)
5648 bs->print = 0;
5649 bs->commands = b->commands;
5650 incref_counted_command_line (bs->commands);
5651 if (command_line_is_silent (bs->commands
5652 ? bs->commands->commands : NULL))
5653 bs->print = 0;
5654
5655 b->ops->after_condition_true (bs);
5656 }
5657
5658 }
5659
5660 /* Print nothing for this entry if we don't stop or don't
5661 print. */
5662 if (!bs->stop || !bs->print)
5663 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5664 }
5665
5666 /* If we aren't stopping, the value of some hardware watchpoint may
5667 not have changed, but the intermediate memory locations we are
5668 watching may have. Don't bother if we're stopping; this will get
5669 done later. */
5670 need_remove_insert = 0;
5671 if (! bpstat_causes_stop (bs_head))
5672 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5673 if (!bs->stop
5674 && bs->breakpoint_at
5675 && is_hardware_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at))
5676 {
5677 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
5678
5679 update_watchpoint (w, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
5680 need_remove_insert = 1;
5681 }
5682
5683 if (need_remove_insert)
5684 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
5685 else if (removed_any)
5686 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
5687
5688 return bs_head;
5689 }
5690
5691 static void
5692 handle_jit_event (void)
5693 {
5694 struct frame_info *frame;
5695 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
5696
5697 /* Switch terminal for any messages produced by
5698 breakpoint_re_set. */
5699 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
5700
5701 frame = get_current_frame ();
5702 gdbarch = get_frame_arch (frame);
5703
5704 jit_event_handler (gdbarch);
5705
5706 target_terminal_inferior ();
5707 }
5708
5709 /* Prepare WHAT final decision for infrun. */
5710
5711 /* Decide what infrun needs to do with this bpstat. */
5712
5713 struct bpstat_what
5714 bpstat_what (bpstat bs_head)
5715 {
5716 struct bpstat_what retval;
5717 int jit_event = 0;
5718 bpstat bs;
5719
5720 retval.main_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5721 retval.call_dummy = STOP_NONE;
5722 retval.is_longjmp = 0;
5723
5724 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5725 {
5726 /* Extract this BS's action. After processing each BS, we check
5727 if its action overrides all we've seem so far. */
5728 enum bpstat_what_main_action this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5729 enum bptype bptype;
5730
5731 if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
5732 {
5733 /* I suspect this can happen if it was a momentary
5734 breakpoint which has since been deleted. */
5735 bptype = bp_none;
5736 }
5737 else
5738 bptype = bs->breakpoint_at->type;
5739
5740 switch (bptype)
5741 {
5742 case bp_none:
5743 break;
5744 case bp_breakpoint:
5745 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
5746 case bp_single_step:
5747 case bp_until:
5748 case bp_finish:
5749 case bp_shlib_event:
5750 if (bs->stop)
5751 {
5752 if (bs->print)
5753 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5754 else
5755 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5756 }
5757 else
5758 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5759 break;
5760 case bp_watchpoint:
5761 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
5762 case bp_read_watchpoint:
5763 case bp_access_watchpoint:
5764 if (bs->stop)
5765 {
5766 if (bs->print)
5767 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5768 else
5769 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5770 }
5771 else
5772 {
5773 /* There was a watchpoint, but we're not stopping.
5774 This requires no further action. */
5775 }
5776 break;
5777 case bp_longjmp:
5778 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
5779 case bp_exception:
5780 if (bs->stop)
5781 {
5782 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SET_LONGJMP_RESUME;
5783 retval.is_longjmp = bptype != bp_exception;
5784 }
5785 else
5786 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5787 break;
5788 case bp_longjmp_resume:
5789 case bp_exception_resume:
5790 if (bs->stop)
5791 {
5792 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_CLEAR_LONGJMP_RESUME;
5793 retval.is_longjmp = bptype == bp_longjmp_resume;
5794 }
5795 else
5796 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5797 break;
5798 case bp_step_resume:
5799 if (bs->stop)
5800 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STEP_RESUME;
5801 else
5802 {
5803 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
5804 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5805 }
5806 break;
5807 case bp_hp_step_resume:
5808 if (bs->stop)
5809 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_HP_STEP_RESUME;
5810 else
5811 {
5812 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
5813 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5814 }
5815 break;
5816 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
5817 case bp_thread_event:
5818 case bp_overlay_event:
5819 case bp_longjmp_master:
5820 case bp_std_terminate_master:
5821 case bp_exception_master:
5822 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5823 break;
5824 case bp_catchpoint:
5825 if (bs->stop)
5826 {
5827 if (bs->print)
5828 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5829 else
5830 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5831 }
5832 else
5833 {
5834 /* There was a catchpoint, but we're not stopping.
5835 This requires no further action. */
5836 }
5837 break;
5838 case bp_jit_event:
5839 jit_event = 1;
5840 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5841 break;
5842 case bp_call_dummy:
5843 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
5844 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
5845 retval.call_dummy = STOP_STACK_DUMMY;
5846 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5847 break;
5848 case bp_std_terminate:
5849 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
5850 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
5851 retval.call_dummy = STOP_STD_TERMINATE;
5852 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5853 break;
5854 case bp_tracepoint:
5855 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
5856 case bp_static_tracepoint:
5857 /* Tracepoint hits should not be reported back to GDB, and
5858 if one got through somehow, it should have been filtered
5859 out already. */
5860 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
5861 _("bpstat_what: tracepoint encountered"));
5862 break;
5863 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
5864 /* Step over it (and insert bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return). */
5865 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5866 break;
5867 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
5868 /* The breakpoint will be removed, execution will restart from the
5869 PC of the former breakpoint. */
5870 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5871 break;
5872
5873 case bp_dprintf:
5874 if (bs->stop)
5875 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5876 else
5877 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5878 break;
5879
5880 default:
5881 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
5882 _("bpstat_what: unhandled bptype %d"), (int) bptype);
5883 }
5884
5885 retval.main_action = max (retval.main_action, this_action);
5886 }
5887
5888 /* These operations may affect the bs->breakpoint_at state so they are
5889 delayed after MAIN_ACTION is decided above. */
5890
5891 if (jit_event)
5892 {
5893 if (debug_infrun)
5894 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog, "bpstat_what: bp_jit_event\n");
5895
5896 handle_jit_event ();
5897 }
5898
5899 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5900 {
5901 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5902
5903 if (b == NULL)
5904 continue;
5905 switch (b->type)
5906 {
5907 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
5908 gnu_ifunc_resolver_stop (b);
5909 break;
5910 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
5911 gnu_ifunc_resolver_return_stop (b);
5912 break;
5913 }
5914 }
5915
5916 return retval;
5917 }
5918
5919 /* Nonzero if we should step constantly (e.g. watchpoints on machines
5920 without hardware support). This isn't related to a specific bpstat,
5921 just to things like whether watchpoints are set. */
5922
5923 int
5924 bpstat_should_step (void)
5925 {
5926 struct breakpoint *b;
5927
5928 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5929 if (breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc != NULL)
5930 return 1;
5931 return 0;
5932 }
5933
5934 int
5935 bpstat_causes_stop (bpstat bs)
5936 {
5937 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5938 if (bs->stop)
5939 return 1;
5940
5941 return 0;
5942 }
5943
5944 \f
5945
5946 /* Compute a string of spaces suitable to indent the next line
5947 so it starts at the position corresponding to the table column
5948 named COL_NAME in the currently active table of UIOUT. */
5949
5950 static char *
5951 wrap_indent_at_field (struct ui_out *uiout, const char *col_name)
5952 {
5953 static char wrap_indent[80];
5954 int i, total_width, width, align;
5955 char *text;
5956
5957 total_width = 0;
5958 for (i = 1; ui_out_query_field (uiout, i, &width, &align, &text); i++)
5959 {
5960 if (strcmp (text, col_name) == 0)
5961 {
5962 gdb_assert (total_width < sizeof wrap_indent);
5963 memset (wrap_indent, ' ', total_width);
5964 wrap_indent[total_width] = 0;
5965
5966 return wrap_indent;
5967 }
5968
5969 total_width += width + 1;
5970 }
5971
5972 return NULL;
5973 }
5974
5975 /* Determine if the locations of this breakpoint will have their conditions
5976 evaluated by the target, host or a mix of both. Returns the following:
5977
5978 "host": Host evals condition.
5979 "host or target": Host or Target evals condition.
5980 "target": Target evals condition.
5981 */
5982
5983 static const char *
5984 bp_condition_evaluator (struct breakpoint *b)
5985 {
5986 struct bp_location *bl;
5987 char host_evals = 0;
5988 char target_evals = 0;
5989
5990 if (!b)
5991 return NULL;
5992
5993 if (!is_breakpoint (b))
5994 return NULL;
5995
5996 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
5997 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
5998 return condition_evaluation_host;
5999
6000 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
6001 {
6002 if (bl->cond_bytecode)
6003 target_evals++;
6004 else
6005 host_evals++;
6006 }
6007
6008 if (host_evals && target_evals)
6009 return condition_evaluation_both;
6010 else if (target_evals)
6011 return condition_evaluation_target;
6012 else
6013 return condition_evaluation_host;
6014 }
6015
6016 /* Determine the breakpoint location's condition evaluator. This is
6017 similar to bp_condition_evaluator, but for locations. */
6018
6019 static const char *
6020 bp_location_condition_evaluator (struct bp_location *bl)
6021 {
6022 if (bl && !is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
6023 return NULL;
6024
6025 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
6026 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
6027 return condition_evaluation_host;
6028
6029 if (bl && bl->cond_bytecode)
6030 return condition_evaluation_target;
6031 else
6032 return condition_evaluation_host;
6033 }
6034
6035 /* Print the LOC location out of the list of B->LOC locations. */
6036
6037 static void
6038 print_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
6039 struct bp_location *loc)
6040 {
6041 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6042 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
6043
6044 if (loc != NULL && loc->shlib_disabled)
6045 loc = NULL;
6046
6047 if (loc != NULL)
6048 set_current_program_space (loc->pspace);
6049
6050 if (b->display_canonical)
6051 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what",
6052 event_location_to_string (b->location));
6053 else if (loc && loc->symtab)
6054 {
6055 struct symbol *sym
6056 = find_pc_sect_function (loc->address, loc->section);
6057 if (sym)
6058 {
6059 ui_out_text (uiout, "in ");
6060 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "func",
6061 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym));
6062 ui_out_text (uiout, " ");
6063 ui_out_wrap_hint (uiout, wrap_indent_at_field (uiout, "what"));
6064 ui_out_text (uiout, "at ");
6065 }
6066 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "file",
6067 symtab_to_filename_for_display (loc->symtab));
6068 ui_out_text (uiout, ":");
6069
6070 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6071 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "fullname",
6072 symtab_to_fullname (loc->symtab));
6073
6074 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "line", loc->line_number);
6075 }
6076 else if (loc)
6077 {
6078 struct ui_file *stb = mem_fileopen ();
6079 struct cleanup *stb_chain = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (stb);
6080
6081 print_address_symbolic (loc->gdbarch, loc->address, stb,
6082 demangle, "");
6083 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "at", stb);
6084
6085 do_cleanups (stb_chain);
6086 }
6087 else
6088 {
6089 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "pending",
6090 event_location_to_string (b->location));
6091 /* If extra_string is available, it could be holding a condition
6092 or dprintf arguments. In either case, make sure it is printed,
6093 too, but only for non-MI streams. */
6094 if (!ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout) && b->extra_string != NULL)
6095 {
6096 if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
6097 ui_out_text (uiout, ",");
6098 else
6099 ui_out_text (uiout, " ");
6100 ui_out_text (uiout, b->extra_string);
6101 }
6102 }
6103
6104 if (loc && is_breakpoint (b)
6105 && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode () == condition_evaluation_target
6106 && bp_condition_evaluator (b) == condition_evaluation_both)
6107 {
6108 ui_out_text (uiout, " (");
6109 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "evaluated-by",
6110 bp_location_condition_evaluator (loc));
6111 ui_out_text (uiout, ")");
6112 }
6113
6114 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6115 }
6116
6117 static const char *
6118 bptype_string (enum bptype type)
6119 {
6120 struct ep_type_description
6121 {
6122 enum bptype type;
6123 char *description;
6124 };
6125 static struct ep_type_description bptypes[] =
6126 {
6127 {bp_none, "?deleted?"},
6128 {bp_breakpoint, "breakpoint"},
6129 {bp_hardware_breakpoint, "hw breakpoint"},
6130 {bp_single_step, "sw single-step"},
6131 {bp_until, "until"},
6132 {bp_finish, "finish"},
6133 {bp_watchpoint, "watchpoint"},
6134 {bp_hardware_watchpoint, "hw watchpoint"},
6135 {bp_read_watchpoint, "read watchpoint"},
6136 {bp_access_watchpoint, "acc watchpoint"},
6137 {bp_longjmp, "longjmp"},
6138 {bp_longjmp_resume, "longjmp resume"},
6139 {bp_longjmp_call_dummy, "longjmp for call dummy"},
6140 {bp_exception, "exception"},
6141 {bp_exception_resume, "exception resume"},
6142 {bp_step_resume, "step resume"},
6143 {bp_hp_step_resume, "high-priority step resume"},
6144 {bp_watchpoint_scope, "watchpoint scope"},
6145 {bp_call_dummy, "call dummy"},
6146 {bp_std_terminate, "std::terminate"},
6147 {bp_shlib_event, "shlib events"},
6148 {bp_thread_event, "thread events"},
6149 {bp_overlay_event, "overlay events"},
6150 {bp_longjmp_master, "longjmp master"},
6151 {bp_std_terminate_master, "std::terminate master"},
6152 {bp_exception_master, "exception master"},
6153 {bp_catchpoint, "catchpoint"},
6154 {bp_tracepoint, "tracepoint"},
6155 {bp_fast_tracepoint, "fast tracepoint"},
6156 {bp_static_tracepoint, "static tracepoint"},
6157 {bp_dprintf, "dprintf"},
6158 {bp_jit_event, "jit events"},
6159 {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver"},
6160 {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver return"},
6161 };
6162
6163 if (((int) type >= (sizeof (bptypes) / sizeof (bptypes[0])))
6164 || ((int) type != bptypes[(int) type].type))
6165 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
6166 _("bptypes table does not describe type #%d."),
6167 (int) type);
6168
6169 return bptypes[(int) type].description;
6170 }
6171
6172 /* For MI, output a field named 'thread-groups' with a list as the value.
6173 For CLI, prefix the list with the string 'inf'. */
6174
6175 static void
6176 output_thread_groups (struct ui_out *uiout,
6177 const char *field_name,
6178 VEC(int) *inf_num,
6179 int mi_only)
6180 {
6181 struct cleanup *back_to;
6182 int is_mi = ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout);
6183 int inf;
6184 int i;
6185
6186 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless
6187 there are several. Always display them for MI. */
6188 if (!is_mi && mi_only)
6189 return;
6190
6191 back_to = make_cleanup_ui_out_list_begin_end (uiout, field_name);
6192
6193 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (int, inf_num, i, inf); ++i)
6194 {
6195 if (is_mi)
6196 {
6197 char mi_group[10];
6198
6199 xsnprintf (mi_group, sizeof (mi_group), "i%d", inf);
6200 ui_out_field_string (uiout, NULL, mi_group);
6201 }
6202 else
6203 {
6204 if (i == 0)
6205 ui_out_text (uiout, " inf ");
6206 else
6207 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
6208
6209 ui_out_text (uiout, plongest (inf));
6210 }
6211 }
6212
6213 do_cleanups (back_to);
6214 }
6215
6216 /* Print B to gdb_stdout. */
6217
6218 static void
6219 print_one_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
6220 struct bp_location *loc,
6221 int loc_number,
6222 struct bp_location **last_loc,
6223 int allflag)
6224 {
6225 struct command_line *l;
6226 static char bpenables[] = "nynny";
6227
6228 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6229 int header_of_multiple = 0;
6230 int part_of_multiple = (loc != NULL);
6231 struct value_print_options opts;
6232
6233 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6234
6235 gdb_assert (!loc || loc_number != 0);
6236 /* See comment in print_one_breakpoint concerning treatment of
6237 breakpoints with single disabled location. */
6238 if (loc == NULL
6239 && (b->loc != NULL
6240 && (b->loc->next != NULL || !b->loc->enabled)))
6241 header_of_multiple = 1;
6242 if (loc == NULL)
6243 loc = b->loc;
6244
6245 annotate_record ();
6246
6247 /* 1 */
6248 annotate_field (0);
6249 if (part_of_multiple)
6250 {
6251 char *formatted;
6252 formatted = xstrprintf ("%d.%d", b->number, loc_number);
6253 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "number", formatted);
6254 xfree (formatted);
6255 }
6256 else
6257 {
6258 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6259 }
6260
6261 /* 2 */
6262 annotate_field (1);
6263 if (part_of_multiple)
6264 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "type");
6265 else
6266 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "type", bptype_string (b->type));
6267
6268 /* 3 */
6269 annotate_field (2);
6270 if (part_of_multiple)
6271 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "disp");
6272 else
6273 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
6274
6275
6276 /* 4 */
6277 annotate_field (3);
6278 if (part_of_multiple)
6279 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "enabled", loc->enabled ? "y" : "n");
6280 else
6281 ui_out_field_fmt (uiout, "enabled", "%c",
6282 bpenables[(int) b->enable_state]);
6283 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 2);
6284
6285
6286 /* 5 and 6 */
6287 if (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_one != NULL)
6288 {
6289 /* Although the print_one can possibly print all locations,
6290 calling it here is not likely to get any nice result. So,
6291 make sure there's just one location. */
6292 gdb_assert (b->loc == NULL || b->loc->next == NULL);
6293 b->ops->print_one (b, last_loc);
6294 }
6295 else
6296 switch (b->type)
6297 {
6298 case bp_none:
6299 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
6300 _("print_one_breakpoint: bp_none encountered\n"));
6301 break;
6302
6303 case bp_watchpoint:
6304 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
6305 case bp_read_watchpoint:
6306 case bp_access_watchpoint:
6307 {
6308 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
6309
6310 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
6311 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
6312 is relatively readable). */
6313 if (opts.addressprint)
6314 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
6315 annotate_field (5);
6316 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", w->exp_string);
6317 }
6318 break;
6319
6320 case bp_breakpoint:
6321 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
6322 case bp_single_step:
6323 case bp_until:
6324 case bp_finish:
6325 case bp_longjmp:
6326 case bp_longjmp_resume:
6327 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
6328 case bp_exception:
6329 case bp_exception_resume:
6330 case bp_step_resume:
6331 case bp_hp_step_resume:
6332 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
6333 case bp_call_dummy:
6334 case bp_std_terminate:
6335 case bp_shlib_event:
6336 case bp_thread_event:
6337 case bp_overlay_event:
6338 case bp_longjmp_master:
6339 case bp_std_terminate_master:
6340 case bp_exception_master:
6341 case bp_tracepoint:
6342 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
6343 case bp_static_tracepoint:
6344 case bp_dprintf:
6345 case bp_jit_event:
6346 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
6347 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
6348 if (opts.addressprint)
6349 {
6350 annotate_field (4);
6351 if (header_of_multiple)
6352 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<MULTIPLE>");
6353 else if (b->loc == NULL || loc->shlib_disabled)
6354 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<PENDING>");
6355 else
6356 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "addr",
6357 loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
6358 }
6359 annotate_field (5);
6360 if (!header_of_multiple)
6361 print_breakpoint_location (b, loc);
6362 if (b->loc)
6363 *last_loc = b->loc;
6364 break;
6365 }
6366
6367
6368 if (loc != NULL && !header_of_multiple)
6369 {
6370 struct inferior *inf;
6371 VEC(int) *inf_num = NULL;
6372 int mi_only = 1;
6373
6374 ALL_INFERIORS (inf)
6375 {
6376 if (inf->pspace == loc->pspace)
6377 VEC_safe_push (int, inf_num, inf->num);
6378 }
6379
6380 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless
6381 there are several. Always display for MI. */
6382 if (allflag
6383 || (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6384 && (number_of_program_spaces () > 1
6385 || number_of_inferiors () > 1)
6386 /* LOC is for existing B, it cannot be in
6387 moribund_locations and thus having NULL OWNER. */
6388 && loc->owner->type != bp_catchpoint))
6389 mi_only = 0;
6390 output_thread_groups (uiout, "thread-groups", inf_num, mi_only);
6391 VEC_free (int, inf_num);
6392 }
6393
6394 if (!part_of_multiple)
6395 {
6396 if (b->thread != -1)
6397 {
6398 /* FIXME: This seems to be redundant and lost here; see the
6399 "stop only in" line a little further down. */
6400 ui_out_text (uiout, " thread ");
6401 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "thread", b->thread);
6402 }
6403 else if (b->task != 0)
6404 {
6405 ui_out_text (uiout, " task ");
6406 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "task", b->task);
6407 }
6408 }
6409
6410 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
6411
6412 if (!part_of_multiple)
6413 b->ops->print_one_detail (b, uiout);
6414
6415 if (part_of_multiple && frame_id_p (b->frame_id))
6416 {
6417 annotate_field (6);
6418 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only in stack frame at ");
6419 /* FIXME: cagney/2002-12-01: Shouldn't be poking around inside
6420 the frame ID. */
6421 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "frame",
6422 b->gdbarch, b->frame_id.stack_addr);
6423 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
6424 }
6425
6426 if (!part_of_multiple && b->cond_string)
6427 {
6428 annotate_field (7);
6429 if (is_tracepoint (b))
6430 ui_out_text (uiout, "\ttrace only if ");
6431 else
6432 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only if ");
6433 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "cond", b->cond_string);
6434
6435 /* Print whether the target is doing the breakpoint's condition
6436 evaluation. If GDB is doing the evaluation, don't print anything. */
6437 if (is_breakpoint (b)
6438 && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ()
6439 == condition_evaluation_target)
6440 {
6441 ui_out_text (uiout, " (");
6442 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "evaluated-by",
6443 bp_condition_evaluator (b));
6444 ui_out_text (uiout, " evals)");
6445 }
6446 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
6447 }
6448
6449 if (!part_of_multiple && b->thread != -1)
6450 {
6451 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */
6452 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only in thread ");
6453 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "thread", b->thread);
6454 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
6455 }
6456
6457 if (!part_of_multiple)
6458 {
6459 if (b->hit_count)
6460 {
6461 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */
6462 if (is_catchpoint (b))
6463 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tcatchpoint");
6464 else if (is_tracepoint (b))
6465 ui_out_text (uiout, "\ttracepoint");
6466 else
6467 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tbreakpoint");
6468 ui_out_text (uiout, " already hit ");
6469 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "times", b->hit_count);
6470 if (b->hit_count == 1)
6471 ui_out_text (uiout, " time\n");
6472 else
6473 ui_out_text (uiout, " times\n");
6474 }
6475 else
6476 {
6477 /* Output the count also if it is zero, but only if this is mi. */
6478 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6479 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "times", b->hit_count);
6480 }
6481 }
6482
6483 if (!part_of_multiple && b->ignore_count)
6484 {
6485 annotate_field (8);
6486 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tignore next ");
6487 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "ignore", b->ignore_count);
6488 ui_out_text (uiout, " hits\n");
6489 }
6490
6491 /* Note that an enable count of 1 corresponds to "enable once"
6492 behavior, which is reported by the combination of enablement and
6493 disposition, so we don't need to mention it here. */
6494 if (!part_of_multiple && b->enable_count > 1)
6495 {
6496 annotate_field (8);
6497 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tdisable after ");
6498 /* Tweak the wording to clarify that ignore and enable counts
6499 are distinct, and have additive effect. */
6500 if (b->ignore_count)
6501 ui_out_text (uiout, "additional ");
6502 else
6503 ui_out_text (uiout, "next ");
6504 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "enable", b->enable_count);
6505 ui_out_text (uiout, " hits\n");
6506 }
6507
6508 if (!part_of_multiple && is_tracepoint (b))
6509 {
6510 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
6511
6512 if (tp->traceframe_usage)
6513 {
6514 ui_out_text (uiout, "\ttrace buffer usage ");
6515 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "traceframe-usage", tp->traceframe_usage);
6516 ui_out_text (uiout, " bytes\n");
6517 }
6518 }
6519
6520 l = b->commands ? b->commands->commands : NULL;
6521 if (!part_of_multiple && l)
6522 {
6523 struct cleanup *script_chain;
6524
6525 annotate_field (9);
6526 script_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "script");
6527 print_command_lines (uiout, l, 4);
6528 do_cleanups (script_chain);
6529 }
6530
6531 if (is_tracepoint (b))
6532 {
6533 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
6534
6535 if (!part_of_multiple && t->pass_count)
6536 {
6537 annotate_field (10);
6538 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tpass count ");
6539 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "pass", t->pass_count);
6540 ui_out_text (uiout, " \n");
6541 }
6542
6543 /* Don't display it when tracepoint or tracepoint location is
6544 pending. */
6545 if (!header_of_multiple && loc != NULL && !loc->shlib_disabled)
6546 {
6547 annotate_field (11);
6548
6549 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6550 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "installed",
6551 loc->inserted ? "y" : "n");
6552 else
6553 {
6554 if (loc->inserted)
6555 ui_out_text (uiout, "\t");
6556 else
6557 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tnot ");
6558 ui_out_text (uiout, "installed on target\n");
6559 }
6560 }
6561 }
6562
6563 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout) && !part_of_multiple)
6564 {
6565 if (is_watchpoint (b))
6566 {
6567 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
6568
6569 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "original-location", w->exp_string);
6570 }
6571 else if (b->location != NULL
6572 && event_location_to_string (b->location) != NULL)
6573 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "original-location",
6574 event_location_to_string (b->location));
6575 }
6576 }
6577
6578 static void
6579 print_one_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
6580 struct bp_location **last_loc,
6581 int allflag)
6582 {
6583 struct cleanup *bkpt_chain;
6584 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6585
6586 bkpt_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "bkpt");
6587
6588 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, NULL, 0, last_loc, allflag);
6589 do_cleanups (bkpt_chain);
6590
6591 /* If this breakpoint has custom print function,
6592 it's already printed. Otherwise, print individual
6593 locations, if any. */
6594 if (b->ops == NULL || b->ops->print_one == NULL)
6595 {
6596 /* If breakpoint has a single location that is disabled, we
6597 print it as if it had several locations, since otherwise it's
6598 hard to represent "breakpoint enabled, location disabled"
6599 situation.
6600
6601 Note that while hardware watchpoints have several locations
6602 internally, that's not a property exposed to user. */
6603 if (b->loc
6604 && !is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
6605 && (b->loc->next || !b->loc->enabled))
6606 {
6607 struct bp_location *loc;
6608 int n = 1;
6609
6610 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next, ++n)
6611 {
6612 struct cleanup *inner2 =
6613 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, NULL);
6614 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, loc, n, last_loc, allflag);
6615 do_cleanups (inner2);
6616 }
6617 }
6618 }
6619 }
6620
6621 static int
6622 breakpoint_address_bits (struct breakpoint *b)
6623 {
6624 int print_address_bits = 0;
6625 struct bp_location *loc;
6626
6627 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
6628 {
6629 int addr_bit;
6630
6631 /* Software watchpoints that aren't watching memory don't have
6632 an address to print. */
6633 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && loc->watchpoint_type == -1)
6634 continue;
6635
6636 addr_bit = gdbarch_addr_bit (loc->gdbarch);
6637 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
6638 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
6639 }
6640
6641 return print_address_bits;
6642 }
6643
6644 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args
6645 {
6646 int bnum;
6647 };
6648
6649 static int
6650 do_captured_breakpoint_query (struct ui_out *uiout, void *data)
6651 {
6652 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args *args = data;
6653 struct breakpoint *b;
6654 struct bp_location *dummy_loc = NULL;
6655
6656 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6657 {
6658 if (args->bnum == b->number)
6659 {
6660 print_one_breakpoint (b, &dummy_loc, 0);
6661 return GDB_RC_OK;
6662 }
6663 }
6664 return GDB_RC_NONE;
6665 }
6666
6667 enum gdb_rc
6668 gdb_breakpoint_query (struct ui_out *uiout, int bnum,
6669 char **error_message)
6670 {
6671 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args args;
6672
6673 args.bnum = bnum;
6674 /* For the moment we don't trust print_one_breakpoint() to not throw
6675 an error. */
6676 if (catch_exceptions_with_msg (uiout, do_captured_breakpoint_query, &args,
6677 error_message, RETURN_MASK_ALL) < 0)
6678 return GDB_RC_FAIL;
6679 else
6680 return GDB_RC_OK;
6681 }
6682
6683 /* Return true if this breakpoint was set by the user, false if it is
6684 internal or momentary. */
6685
6686 int
6687 user_breakpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
6688 {
6689 return b->number > 0;
6690 }
6691
6692 /* Print information on user settable breakpoint (watchpoint, etc)
6693 number BNUM. If BNUM is -1 print all user-settable breakpoints.
6694 If ALLFLAG is non-zero, include non-user-settable breakpoints. If
6695 FILTER is non-NULL, call it on each breakpoint and only include the
6696 ones for which it returns non-zero. Return the total number of
6697 breakpoints listed. */
6698
6699 static int
6700 breakpoint_1 (char *args, int allflag,
6701 int (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *))
6702 {
6703 struct breakpoint *b;
6704 struct bp_location *last_loc = NULL;
6705 int nr_printable_breakpoints;
6706 struct cleanup *bkpttbl_chain;
6707 struct value_print_options opts;
6708 int print_address_bits = 0;
6709 int print_type_col_width = 14;
6710 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6711
6712 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6713
6714 /* Compute the number of rows in the table, as well as the size
6715 required for address fields. */
6716 nr_printable_breakpoints = 0;
6717 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6718 {
6719 /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
6720 if (filter && !filter (b))
6721 continue;
6722
6723 /* If we have an "args" string, it is a list of breakpoints to
6724 accept. Skip the others. */
6725 if (args != NULL && *args != '\0')
6726 {
6727 if (allflag && parse_and_eval_long (args) != b->number)
6728 continue;
6729 if (!allflag && !number_is_in_list (args, b->number))
6730 continue;
6731 }
6732
6733 if (allflag || user_breakpoint_p (b))
6734 {
6735 int addr_bit, type_len;
6736
6737 addr_bit = breakpoint_address_bits (b);
6738 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
6739 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
6740
6741 type_len = strlen (bptype_string (b->type));
6742 if (type_len > print_type_col_width)
6743 print_type_col_width = type_len;
6744
6745 nr_printable_breakpoints++;
6746 }
6747 }
6748
6749 if (opts.addressprint)
6750 bkpttbl_chain
6751 = make_cleanup_ui_out_table_begin_end (uiout, 6,
6752 nr_printable_breakpoints,
6753 "BreakpointTable");
6754 else
6755 bkpttbl_chain
6756 = make_cleanup_ui_out_table_begin_end (uiout, 5,
6757 nr_printable_breakpoints,
6758 "BreakpointTable");
6759
6760 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6761 annotate_breakpoints_headers ();
6762 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6763 annotate_field (0);
6764 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 7, ui_left, "number", "Num"); /* 1 */
6765 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6766 annotate_field (1);
6767 ui_out_table_header (uiout, print_type_col_width, ui_left,
6768 "type", "Type"); /* 2 */
6769 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6770 annotate_field (2);
6771 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 4, ui_left, "disp", "Disp"); /* 3 */
6772 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6773 annotate_field (3);
6774 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 3, ui_left, "enabled", "Enb"); /* 4 */
6775 if (opts.addressprint)
6776 {
6777 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6778 annotate_field (4);
6779 if (print_address_bits <= 32)
6780 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 10, ui_left,
6781 "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */
6782 else
6783 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 18, ui_left,
6784 "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */
6785 }
6786 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6787 annotate_field (5);
6788 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 40, ui_noalign, "what", "What"); /* 6 */
6789 ui_out_table_body (uiout);
6790 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6791 annotate_breakpoints_table ();
6792
6793 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6794 {
6795 QUIT;
6796 /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
6797 if (filter && !filter (b))
6798 continue;
6799
6800 /* If we have an "args" string, it is a list of breakpoints to
6801 accept. Skip the others. */
6802
6803 if (args != NULL && *args != '\0')
6804 {
6805 if (allflag) /* maintenance info breakpoint */
6806 {
6807 if (parse_and_eval_long (args) != b->number)
6808 continue;
6809 }
6810 else /* all others */
6811 {
6812 if (!number_is_in_list (args, b->number))
6813 continue;
6814 }
6815 }
6816 /* We only print out user settable breakpoints unless the
6817 allflag is set. */
6818 if (allflag || user_breakpoint_p (b))
6819 print_one_breakpoint (b, &last_loc, allflag);
6820 }
6821
6822 do_cleanups (bkpttbl_chain);
6823
6824 if (nr_printable_breakpoints == 0)
6825 {
6826 /* If there's a filter, let the caller decide how to report
6827 empty list. */
6828 if (!filter)
6829 {
6830 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
6831 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No breakpoints or watchpoints.\n");
6832 else
6833 ui_out_message (uiout, 0,
6834 "No breakpoint or watchpoint matching '%s'.\n",
6835 args);
6836 }
6837 }
6838 else
6839 {
6840 if (last_loc && !server_command)
6841 set_next_address (last_loc->gdbarch, last_loc->address);
6842 }
6843
6844 /* FIXME? Should this be moved up so that it is only called when
6845 there have been breakpoints? */
6846 annotate_breakpoints_table_end ();
6847
6848 return nr_printable_breakpoints;
6849 }
6850
6851 /* Display the value of default-collect in a way that is generally
6852 compatible with the breakpoint list. */
6853
6854 static void
6855 default_collect_info (void)
6856 {
6857 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6858
6859 /* If it has no value (which is frequently the case), say nothing; a
6860 message like "No default-collect." gets in user's face when it's
6861 not wanted. */
6862 if (!*default_collect)
6863 return;
6864
6865 /* The following phrase lines up nicely with per-tracepoint collect
6866 actions. */
6867 ui_out_text (uiout, "default collect ");
6868 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "default-collect", default_collect);
6869 ui_out_text (uiout, " \n");
6870 }
6871
6872 static void
6873 breakpoints_info (char *args, int from_tty)
6874 {
6875 breakpoint_1 (args, 0, NULL);
6876
6877 default_collect_info ();
6878 }
6879
6880 static void
6881 watchpoints_info (char *args, int from_tty)
6882 {
6883 int num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, 0, is_watchpoint);
6884 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6885
6886 if (num_printed == 0)
6887 {
6888 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
6889 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No watchpoints.\n");
6890 else
6891 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No watchpoint matching '%s'.\n", args);
6892 }
6893 }
6894
6895 static void
6896 maintenance_info_breakpoints (char *args, int from_tty)
6897 {
6898 breakpoint_1 (args, 1, NULL);
6899
6900 default_collect_info ();
6901 }
6902
6903 static int
6904 breakpoint_has_pc (struct breakpoint *b,
6905 struct program_space *pspace,
6906 CORE_ADDR pc, struct obj_section *section)
6907 {
6908 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
6909
6910 for (; bl; bl = bl->next)
6911 {
6912 if (bl->pspace == pspace
6913 && bl->address == pc
6914 && (!overlay_debugging || bl->section == section))
6915 return 1;
6916 }
6917 return 0;
6918 }
6919
6920 /* Print a message describing any user-breakpoints set at PC. This
6921 concerns with logical breakpoints, so we match program spaces, not
6922 address spaces. */
6923
6924 static void
6925 describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6926 struct program_space *pspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
6927 struct obj_section *section, int thread)
6928 {
6929 int others = 0;
6930 struct breakpoint *b;
6931
6932 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6933 others += (user_breakpoint_p (b)
6934 && breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section));
6935 if (others > 0)
6936 {
6937 if (others == 1)
6938 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoint "));
6939 else /* if (others == ???) */
6940 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoints "));
6941 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6942 if (user_breakpoint_p (b) && breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section))
6943 {
6944 others--;
6945 printf_filtered ("%d", b->number);
6946 if (b->thread == -1 && thread != -1)
6947 printf_filtered (" (all threads)");
6948 else if (b->thread != -1)
6949 printf_filtered (" (thread %d)", b->thread);
6950 printf_filtered ("%s%s ",
6951 ((b->enable_state == bp_disabled
6952 || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled)
6953 ? " (disabled)"
6954 : ""),
6955 (others > 1) ? ","
6956 : ((others == 1) ? " and" : ""));
6957 }
6958 printf_filtered (_("also set at pc "));
6959 fputs_filtered (paddress (gdbarch, pc), gdb_stdout);
6960 printf_filtered (".\n");
6961 }
6962 }
6963 \f
6964
6965 /* Return true iff it is meaningful to use the address member of
6966 BPT locations. For some breakpoint types, the locations' address members
6967 are irrelevant and it makes no sense to attempt to compare them to other
6968 addresses (or use them for any other purpose either).
6969
6970 More specifically, each of the following breakpoint types will
6971 always have a zero valued location address and we don't want to mark
6972 breakpoints of any of these types to be a duplicate of an actual
6973 breakpoint location at address zero:
6974
6975 bp_watchpoint
6976 bp_catchpoint
6977
6978 */
6979
6980 static int
6981 breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (struct breakpoint *bpt)
6982 {
6983 enum bptype type = bpt->type;
6984
6985 return (type != bp_watchpoint && type != bp_catchpoint);
6986 }
6987
6988 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's owners are hardware watchpoints, returns
6989 true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same watchpoint location. */
6990
6991 static int
6992 watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
6993 struct bp_location *loc2)
6994 {
6995 struct watchpoint *w1 = (struct watchpoint *) loc1->owner;
6996 struct watchpoint *w2 = (struct watchpoint *) loc2->owner;
6997
6998 /* Both of them must exist. */
6999 gdb_assert (w1 != NULL);
7000 gdb_assert (w2 != NULL);
7001
7002 /* If the target can evaluate the condition expression in hardware,
7003 then we we need to insert both watchpoints even if they are at
7004 the same place. Otherwise the watchpoint will only trigger when
7005 the condition of whichever watchpoint was inserted evaluates to
7006 true, not giving a chance for GDB to check the condition of the
7007 other watchpoint. */
7008 if ((w1->cond_exp
7009 && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc1->address,
7010 loc1->length,
7011 loc1->watchpoint_type,
7012 w1->cond_exp))
7013 || (w2->cond_exp
7014 && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc2->address,
7015 loc2->length,
7016 loc2->watchpoint_type,
7017 w2->cond_exp)))
7018 return 0;
7019
7020 /* Note that this checks the owner's type, not the location's. In
7021 case the target does not support read watchpoints, but does
7022 support access watchpoints, we'll have bp_read_watchpoint
7023 watchpoints with hw_access locations. Those should be considered
7024 duplicates of hw_read locations. The hw_read locations will
7025 become hw_access locations later. */
7026 return (loc1->owner->type == loc2->owner->type
7027 && loc1->pspace->aspace == loc2->pspace->aspace
7028 && loc1->address == loc2->address
7029 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
7030 }
7031
7032 /* See breakpoint.h. */
7033
7034 int
7035 breakpoint_address_match (struct address_space *aspace1, CORE_ADDR addr1,
7036 struct address_space *aspace2, CORE_ADDR addr2)
7037 {
7038 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
7039 || aspace1 == aspace2)
7040 && addr1 == addr2);
7041 }
7042
7043 /* Returns true if {ASPACE2,ADDR2} falls within the range determined by
7044 {ASPACE1,ADDR1,LEN1}. In most targets, this can only be true if ASPACE1
7045 matches ASPACE2. On targets that have global breakpoints, the address
7046 space doesn't really matter. */
7047
7048 static int
7049 breakpoint_address_match_range (struct address_space *aspace1, CORE_ADDR addr1,
7050 int len1, struct address_space *aspace2,
7051 CORE_ADDR addr2)
7052 {
7053 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
7054 || aspace1 == aspace2)
7055 && addr2 >= addr1 && addr2 < addr1 + len1);
7056 }
7057
7058 /* Returns true if {ASPACE,ADDR} matches the breakpoint BL. BL may be
7059 a ranged breakpoint. In most targets, a match happens only if ASPACE
7060 matches the breakpoint's address space. On targets that have global
7061 breakpoints, the address space doesn't really matter. */
7062
7063 static int
7064 breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl,
7065 struct address_space *aspace,
7066 CORE_ADDR addr)
7067 {
7068 return (breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
7069 aspace, addr)
7070 || (bl->length
7071 && breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace,
7072 bl->address, bl->length,
7073 aspace, addr)));
7074 }
7075
7076 /* If LOC1 and LOC2's owners are not tracepoints, returns false directly.
7077 Then, if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same tracepoint location, returns
7078 true, otherwise returns false. */
7079
7080 static int
7081 tracepoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
7082 struct bp_location *loc2)
7083 {
7084 if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) && is_tracepoint (loc2->owner))
7085 /* Since tracepoint locations are never duplicated with others', tracepoint
7086 locations at the same address of different tracepoints are regarded as
7087 different locations. */
7088 return (loc1->address == loc2->address && loc1->owner == loc2->owner);
7089 else
7090 return 0;
7091 }
7092
7093 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's types' have meaningful target addresses
7094 (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful), returns true if LOC1 and LOC2
7095 represent the same location. */
7096
7097 static int
7098 breakpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
7099 struct bp_location *loc2)
7100 {
7101 int hw_point1, hw_point2;
7102
7103 /* Both of them must not be in moribund_locations. */
7104 gdb_assert (loc1->owner != NULL);
7105 gdb_assert (loc2->owner != NULL);
7106
7107 hw_point1 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc1->owner);
7108 hw_point2 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner);
7109
7110 if (hw_point1 != hw_point2)
7111 return 0;
7112 else if (hw_point1)
7113 return watchpoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
7114 else if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) || is_tracepoint (loc2->owner))
7115 return tracepoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
7116 else
7117 /* We compare bp_location.length in order to cover ranged breakpoints. */
7118 return (breakpoint_address_match (loc1->pspace->aspace, loc1->address,
7119 loc2->pspace->aspace, loc2->address)
7120 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
7121 }
7122
7123 static void
7124 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR from_addr, CORE_ADDR to_addr,
7125 int bnum, int have_bnum)
7126 {
7127 /* The longest string possibly returned by hex_string_custom
7128 is 50 chars. These must be at least that big for safety. */
7129 char astr1[64];
7130 char astr2[64];
7131
7132 strcpy (astr1, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) from_addr, 8));
7133 strcpy (astr2, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) to_addr, 8));
7134 if (have_bnum)
7135 warning (_("Breakpoint %d address previously adjusted from %s to %s."),
7136 bnum, astr1, astr2);
7137 else
7138 warning (_("Breakpoint address adjusted from %s to %s."), astr1, astr2);
7139 }
7140
7141 /* Adjust a breakpoint's address to account for architectural
7142 constraints on breakpoint placement. Return the adjusted address.
7143 Note: Very few targets require this kind of adjustment. For most
7144 targets, this function is simply the identity function. */
7145
7146 static CORE_ADDR
7147 adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7148 CORE_ADDR bpaddr, enum bptype bptype)
7149 {
7150 if (!gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address_p (gdbarch))
7151 {
7152 /* Very few targets need any kind of breakpoint adjustment. */
7153 return bpaddr;
7154 }
7155 else if (bptype == bp_watchpoint
7156 || bptype == bp_hardware_watchpoint
7157 || bptype == bp_read_watchpoint
7158 || bptype == bp_access_watchpoint
7159 || bptype == bp_catchpoint)
7160 {
7161 /* Watchpoints and the various bp_catch_* eventpoints should not
7162 have their addresses modified. */
7163 return bpaddr;
7164 }
7165 else if (bptype == bp_single_step)
7166 {
7167 /* Single-step breakpoints should not have their addresses
7168 modified. If there's any architectural constrain that
7169 applies to this address, then it should have already been
7170 taken into account when the breakpoint was created in the
7171 first place. If we didn't do this, stepping through e.g.,
7172 Thumb-2 IT blocks would break. */
7173 return bpaddr;
7174 }
7175 else
7176 {
7177 CORE_ADDR adjusted_bpaddr;
7178
7179 /* Some targets have architectural constraints on the placement
7180 of breakpoint instructions. Obtain the adjusted address. */
7181 adjusted_bpaddr = gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address (gdbarch, bpaddr);
7182
7183 /* An adjusted breakpoint address can significantly alter
7184 a user's expectations. Print a warning if an adjustment
7185 is required. */
7186 if (adjusted_bpaddr != bpaddr)
7187 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bpaddr, adjusted_bpaddr, 0, 0);
7188
7189 return adjusted_bpaddr;
7190 }
7191 }
7192
7193 void
7194 init_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc, const struct bp_location_ops *ops,
7195 struct breakpoint *owner)
7196 {
7197 memset (loc, 0, sizeof (*loc));
7198
7199 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
7200
7201 loc->ops = ops;
7202 loc->owner = owner;
7203 loc->cond = NULL;
7204 loc->cond_bytecode = NULL;
7205 loc->shlib_disabled = 0;
7206 loc->enabled = 1;
7207
7208 switch (owner->type)
7209 {
7210 case bp_breakpoint:
7211 case bp_single_step:
7212 case bp_until:
7213 case bp_finish:
7214 case bp_longjmp:
7215 case bp_longjmp_resume:
7216 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
7217 case bp_exception:
7218 case bp_exception_resume:
7219 case bp_step_resume:
7220 case bp_hp_step_resume:
7221 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
7222 case bp_call_dummy:
7223 case bp_std_terminate:
7224 case bp_shlib_event:
7225 case bp_thread_event:
7226 case bp_overlay_event:
7227 case bp_jit_event:
7228 case bp_longjmp_master:
7229 case bp_std_terminate_master:
7230 case bp_exception_master:
7231 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
7232 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
7233 case bp_dprintf:
7234 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
7235 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
7236 break;
7237 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
7238 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
7239 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
7240 break;
7241 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
7242 case bp_read_watchpoint:
7243 case bp_access_watchpoint:
7244 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint;
7245 break;
7246 case bp_watchpoint:
7247 case bp_catchpoint:
7248 case bp_tracepoint:
7249 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
7250 case bp_static_tracepoint:
7251 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_other;
7252 break;
7253 default:
7254 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unknown breakpoint type"));
7255 }
7256
7257 loc->refc = 1;
7258 }
7259
7260 /* Allocate a struct bp_location. */
7261
7262 static struct bp_location *
7263 allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt)
7264 {
7265 return bpt->ops->allocate_location (bpt);
7266 }
7267
7268 static void
7269 free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc)
7270 {
7271 loc->ops->dtor (loc);
7272 xfree (loc);
7273 }
7274
7275 /* Increment reference count. */
7276
7277 static void
7278 incref_bp_location (struct bp_location *bl)
7279 {
7280 ++bl->refc;
7281 }
7282
7283 /* Decrement reference count. If the reference count reaches 0,
7284 destroy the bp_location. Sets *BLP to NULL. */
7285
7286 static void
7287 decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **blp)
7288 {
7289 gdb_assert ((*blp)->refc > 0);
7290
7291 if (--(*blp)->refc == 0)
7292 free_bp_location (*blp);
7293 *blp = NULL;
7294 }
7295
7296 /* Add breakpoint B at the end of the global breakpoint chain. */
7297
7298 static void
7299 add_to_breakpoint_chain (struct breakpoint *b)
7300 {
7301 struct breakpoint *b1;
7302
7303 /* Add this breakpoint to the end of the chain so that a list of
7304 breakpoints will come out in order of increasing numbers. */
7305
7306 b1 = breakpoint_chain;
7307 if (b1 == 0)
7308 breakpoint_chain = b;
7309 else
7310 {
7311 while (b1->next)
7312 b1 = b1->next;
7313 b1->next = b;
7314 }
7315 }
7316
7317 /* Initializes breakpoint B with type BPTYPE and no locations yet. */
7318
7319 static void
7320 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct breakpoint *b,
7321 struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7322 enum bptype bptype,
7323 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7324 {
7325 memset (b, 0, sizeof (*b));
7326
7327 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
7328
7329 b->ops = ops;
7330 b->type = bptype;
7331 b->gdbarch = gdbarch;
7332 b->language = current_language->la_language;
7333 b->input_radix = input_radix;
7334 b->thread = -1;
7335 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7336 b->next = 0;
7337 b->silent = 0;
7338 b->ignore_count = 0;
7339 b->commands = NULL;
7340 b->frame_id = null_frame_id;
7341 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
7342 b->py_bp_object = NULL;
7343 b->related_breakpoint = b;
7344 b->location = NULL;
7345 }
7346
7347 /* Helper to set_raw_breakpoint below. Creates a breakpoint
7348 that has type BPTYPE and has no locations as yet. */
7349
7350 static struct breakpoint *
7351 set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7352 enum bptype bptype,
7353 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7354 {
7355 struct breakpoint *b = XNEW (struct breakpoint);
7356
7357 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, gdbarch, bptype, ops);
7358 add_to_breakpoint_chain (b);
7359 return b;
7360 }
7361
7362 /* Initialize loc->function_name. EXPLICIT_LOC says no indirect function
7363 resolutions should be made as the user specified the location explicitly
7364 enough. */
7365
7366 static void
7367 set_breakpoint_location_function (struct bp_location *loc, int explicit_loc)
7368 {
7369 gdb_assert (loc->owner != NULL);
7370
7371 if (loc->owner->type == bp_breakpoint
7372 || loc->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
7373 || is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
7374 {
7375 int is_gnu_ifunc;
7376 const char *function_name;
7377 CORE_ADDR func_addr;
7378
7379 find_pc_partial_function_gnu_ifunc (loc->address, &function_name,
7380 &func_addr, NULL, &is_gnu_ifunc);
7381
7382 if (is_gnu_ifunc && !explicit_loc)
7383 {
7384 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7385
7386 gdb_assert (loc->pspace == current_program_space);
7387 if (gnu_ifunc_resolve_name (function_name,
7388 &loc->requested_address))
7389 {
7390 /* Recalculate ADDRESS based on new REQUESTED_ADDRESS. */
7391 loc->address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc->gdbarch,
7392 loc->requested_address,
7393 b->type);
7394 }
7395 else if (b->type == bp_breakpoint && b->loc == loc
7396 && loc->next == NULL && b->related_breakpoint == b)
7397 {
7398 /* Create only the whole new breakpoint of this type but do not
7399 mess more complicated breakpoints with multiple locations. */
7400 b->type = bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver;
7401 /* Remember the resolver's address for use by the return
7402 breakpoint. */
7403 loc->related_address = func_addr;
7404 }
7405 }
7406
7407 if (function_name)
7408 loc->function_name = xstrdup (function_name);
7409 }
7410 }
7411
7412 /* Attempt to determine architecture of location identified by SAL. */
7413 struct gdbarch *
7414 get_sal_arch (struct symtab_and_line sal)
7415 {
7416 if (sal.section)
7417 return get_objfile_arch (sal.section->objfile);
7418 if (sal.symtab)
7419 return get_objfile_arch (SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal.symtab));
7420
7421 return NULL;
7422 }
7423
7424 /* Low level routine for partially initializing a breakpoint of type
7425 BPTYPE. The newly created breakpoint's address, section, source
7426 file name, and line number are provided by SAL.
7427
7428 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
7429 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
7430 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. */
7431
7432 static void
7433 init_raw_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7434 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype,
7435 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7436 {
7437 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, gdbarch, bptype, ops);
7438
7439 add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
7440
7441 if (bptype != bp_catchpoint)
7442 gdb_assert (sal.pspace != NULL);
7443
7444 /* Store the program space that was used to set the breakpoint,
7445 except for ordinary breakpoints, which are independent of the
7446 program space. */
7447 if (bptype != bp_breakpoint && bptype != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7448 b->pspace = sal.pspace;
7449 }
7450
7451 /* set_raw_breakpoint is a low level routine for allocating and
7452 partially initializing a breakpoint of type BPTYPE. The newly
7453 created breakpoint's address, section, source file name, and line
7454 number are provided by SAL. The newly created and partially
7455 initialized breakpoint is added to the breakpoint chain and
7456 is also returned as the value of this function.
7457
7458 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
7459 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
7460 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. In
7461 particular, set_raw_breakpoint does NOT set the breakpoint
7462 number! Care should be taken to not allow an error to occur
7463 prior to completing the initialization of the breakpoint. If this
7464 should happen, a bogus breakpoint will be left on the chain. */
7465
7466 struct breakpoint *
7467 set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7468 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype,
7469 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7470 {
7471 struct breakpoint *b = XNEW (struct breakpoint);
7472
7473 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bptype, ops);
7474 add_to_breakpoint_chain (b);
7475 return b;
7476 }
7477
7478 /* Call this routine when stepping and nexting to enable a breakpoint
7479 if we do a longjmp() or 'throw' in TP. FRAME is the frame which
7480 initiated the operation. */
7481
7482 void
7483 set_longjmp_breakpoint (struct thread_info *tp, struct frame_id frame)
7484 {
7485 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7486 int thread = tp->num;
7487
7488 /* To avoid having to rescan all objfile symbols at every step,
7489 we maintain a list of continually-inserted but always disabled
7490 longjmp "master" breakpoints. Here, we simply create momentary
7491 clones of those and enable them for the requested thread. */
7492 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7493 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
7494 && (b->type == bp_longjmp_master
7495 || b->type == bp_exception_master))
7496 {
7497 enum bptype type = b->type == bp_longjmp_master ? bp_longjmp : bp_exception;
7498 struct breakpoint *clone;
7499
7500 /* longjmp_breakpoint_ops ensures INITIATING_FRAME is cleared again
7501 after their removal. */
7502 clone = momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, type,
7503 &longjmp_breakpoint_ops, 1);
7504 clone->thread = thread;
7505 }
7506
7507 tp->initiating_frame = frame;
7508 }
7509
7510 /* Delete all longjmp breakpoints from THREAD. */
7511 void
7512 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread)
7513 {
7514 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7515
7516 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7517 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_exception)
7518 {
7519 if (b->thread == thread)
7520 delete_breakpoint (b);
7521 }
7522 }
7523
7524 void
7525 delete_longjmp_breakpoint_at_next_stop (int thread)
7526 {
7527 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7528
7529 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7530 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_exception)
7531 {
7532 if (b->thread == thread)
7533 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
7534 }
7535 }
7536
7537 /* Place breakpoints of type bp_longjmp_call_dummy to catch longjmp for
7538 INFERIOR_PTID thread. Chain them all by RELATED_BREAKPOINT and return
7539 pointer to any of them. Return NULL if this system cannot place longjmp
7540 breakpoints. */
7541
7542 struct breakpoint *
7543 set_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (void)
7544 {
7545 struct breakpoint *b, *retval = NULL;
7546
7547 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7548 if (b->pspace == current_program_space && b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
7549 {
7550 struct breakpoint *new_b;
7551
7552 new_b = momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, bp_longjmp_call_dummy,
7553 &momentary_breakpoint_ops,
7554 1);
7555 new_b->thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
7556
7557 /* Link NEW_B into the chain of RETVAL breakpoints. */
7558
7559 gdb_assert (new_b->related_breakpoint == new_b);
7560 if (retval == NULL)
7561 retval = new_b;
7562 new_b->related_breakpoint = retval;
7563 while (retval->related_breakpoint != new_b->related_breakpoint)
7564 retval = retval->related_breakpoint;
7565 retval->related_breakpoint = new_b;
7566 }
7567
7568 return retval;
7569 }
7570
7571 /* Verify all existing dummy frames and their associated breakpoints for
7572 TP. Remove those which can no longer be found in the current frame
7573 stack.
7574
7575 You should call this function only at places where it is safe to currently
7576 unwind the whole stack. Failed stack unwind would discard live dummy
7577 frames. */
7578
7579 void
7580 check_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (struct thread_info *tp)
7581 {
7582 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7583
7584 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7585 if (b->type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy && b->thread == tp->num)
7586 {
7587 struct breakpoint *dummy_b = b->related_breakpoint;
7588
7589 while (dummy_b != b && dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy)
7590 dummy_b = dummy_b->related_breakpoint;
7591 if (dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy
7592 || frame_find_by_id (dummy_b->frame_id) != NULL)
7593 continue;
7594
7595 dummy_frame_discard (dummy_b->frame_id, tp->ptid);
7596
7597 while (b->related_breakpoint != b)
7598 {
7599 if (b_tmp == b->related_breakpoint)
7600 b_tmp = b->related_breakpoint->next;
7601 delete_breakpoint (b->related_breakpoint);
7602 }
7603 delete_breakpoint (b);
7604 }
7605 }
7606
7607 void
7608 enable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
7609 {
7610 struct breakpoint *b;
7611
7612 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7613 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
7614 {
7615 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7616 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7617 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
7618 }
7619 }
7620
7621 void
7622 disable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
7623 {
7624 struct breakpoint *b;
7625
7626 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7627 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
7628 {
7629 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
7630 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
7631 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
7632 }
7633 }
7634
7635 /* Set an active std::terminate breakpoint for each std::terminate
7636 master breakpoint. */
7637 void
7638 set_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
7639 {
7640 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7641
7642 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7643 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
7644 && b->type == bp_std_terminate_master)
7645 {
7646 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, bp_std_terminate,
7647 &momentary_breakpoint_ops, 1);
7648 }
7649 }
7650
7651 /* Delete all the std::terminate breakpoints. */
7652 void
7653 delete_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
7654 {
7655 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7656
7657 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7658 if (b->type == bp_std_terminate)
7659 delete_breakpoint (b);
7660 }
7661
7662 struct breakpoint *
7663 create_thread_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7664 {
7665 struct breakpoint *b;
7666
7667 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_thread_event,
7668 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7669
7670 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7671 /* location has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete me. */
7672 b->location = new_address_location (b->loc->address);
7673
7674 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7675
7676 return b;
7677 }
7678
7679 void
7680 remove_thread_event_breakpoints (void)
7681 {
7682 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7683
7684 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7685 if (b->type == bp_thread_event
7686 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7687 delete_breakpoint (b);
7688 }
7689
7690 struct lang_and_radix
7691 {
7692 enum language lang;
7693 int radix;
7694 };
7695
7696 /* Create a breakpoint for JIT code registration and unregistration. */
7697
7698 struct breakpoint *
7699 create_jit_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7700 {
7701 struct breakpoint *b;
7702
7703 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_jit_event,
7704 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7705 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7706 return b;
7707 }
7708
7709 /* Remove JIT code registration and unregistration breakpoint(s). */
7710
7711 void
7712 remove_jit_event_breakpoints (void)
7713 {
7714 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7715
7716 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7717 if (b->type == bp_jit_event
7718 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7719 delete_breakpoint (b);
7720 }
7721
7722 void
7723 remove_solib_event_breakpoints (void)
7724 {
7725 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7726
7727 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7728 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
7729 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7730 delete_breakpoint (b);
7731 }
7732
7733 /* See breakpoint.h. */
7734
7735 void
7736 remove_solib_event_breakpoints_at_next_stop (void)
7737 {
7738 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7739
7740 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7741 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
7742 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7743 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
7744 }
7745
7746 /* Helper for create_solib_event_breakpoint /
7747 create_and_insert_solib_event_breakpoint. Allows specifying which
7748 INSERT_MODE to pass through to update_global_location_list. */
7749
7750 static struct breakpoint *
7751 create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address,
7752 enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
7753 {
7754 struct breakpoint *b;
7755
7756 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_shlib_event,
7757 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7758 update_global_location_list_nothrow (insert_mode);
7759 return b;
7760 }
7761
7762 struct breakpoint *
7763 create_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7764 {
7765 return create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (gdbarch, address, UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7766 }
7767
7768 /* See breakpoint.h. */
7769
7770 struct breakpoint *
7771 create_and_insert_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7772 {
7773 struct breakpoint *b;
7774
7775 /* Explicitly tell update_global_location_list to insert
7776 locations. */
7777 b = create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (gdbarch, address, UGLL_INSERT);
7778 if (!b->loc->inserted)
7779 {
7780 delete_breakpoint (b);
7781 return NULL;
7782 }
7783 return b;
7784 }
7785
7786 /* Disable any breakpoints that are on code in shared libraries. Only
7787 apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7788
7789 void
7790 disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs (void)
7791 {
7792 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
7793
7794 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
7795 {
7796 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
7797 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7798
7799 /* We apply the check to all breakpoints, including disabled for
7800 those with loc->duplicate set. This is so that when breakpoint
7801 becomes enabled, or the duplicate is removed, gdb will try to
7802 insert all breakpoints. If we don't set shlib_disabled here,
7803 we'll try to insert those breakpoints and fail. */
7804 if (((b->type == bp_breakpoint)
7805 || (b->type == bp_jit_event)
7806 || (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7807 || (is_tracepoint (b)))
7808 && loc->pspace == current_program_space
7809 && !loc->shlib_disabled
7810 && solib_name_from_address (loc->pspace, loc->address)
7811 )
7812 {
7813 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7814 }
7815 }
7816 }
7817
7818 /* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints that are in SOLIB upon
7819 notification of unloaded_shlib. Only apply to enabled breakpoints,
7820 disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7821
7822 static void
7823 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib (struct so_list *solib)
7824 {
7825 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
7826 int disabled_shlib_breaks = 0;
7827
7828 /* SunOS a.out shared libraries are always mapped, so do not
7829 disable breakpoints; they will only be reported as unloaded
7830 through clear_solib when GDB discards its shared library
7831 list. See clear_solib for more information. */
7832 if (exec_bfd != NULL
7833 && bfd_get_flavour (exec_bfd) == bfd_target_aout_flavour)
7834 return;
7835
7836 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
7837 {
7838 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
7839 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7840
7841 if (solib->pspace == loc->pspace
7842 && !loc->shlib_disabled
7843 && (((b->type == bp_breakpoint
7844 || b->type == bp_jit_event
7845 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7846 && (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7847 || loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint))
7848 || is_tracepoint (b))
7849 && solib_contains_address_p (solib, loc->address))
7850 {
7851 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7852 /* At this point, we cannot rely on remove_breakpoint
7853 succeeding so we must mark the breakpoint as not inserted
7854 to prevent future errors occurring in remove_breakpoints. */
7855 loc->inserted = 0;
7856
7857 /* This may cause duplicate notifications for the same breakpoint. */
7858 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
7859
7860 if (!disabled_shlib_breaks)
7861 {
7862 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
7863 warning (_("Temporarily disabling breakpoints "
7864 "for unloaded shared library \"%s\""),
7865 solib->so_name);
7866 }
7867 disabled_shlib_breaks = 1;
7868 }
7869 }
7870 }
7871
7872 /* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints in OBJFILE upon
7873 notification of free_objfile. Only apply to enabled breakpoints,
7874 disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7875
7876 static void
7877 disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile (struct objfile *objfile)
7878 {
7879 struct breakpoint *b;
7880
7881 if (objfile == NULL)
7882 return;
7883
7884 /* OBJF_SHARED|OBJF_USERLOADED objfiles are dynamic modules manually
7885 managed by the user with add-symbol-file/remove-symbol-file.
7886 Similarly to how breakpoints in shared libraries are handled in
7887 response to "nosharedlibrary", mark breakpoints in such modules
7888 shlib_disabled so they end up uninserted on the next global
7889 location list update. Shared libraries not loaded by the user
7890 aren't handled here -- they're already handled in
7891 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib, called by solib.c's
7892 solib_unloaded observer. We skip objfiles that are not
7893 OBJF_SHARED as those aren't considered dynamic objects (e.g. the
7894 main objfile). */
7895 if ((objfile->flags & OBJF_SHARED) == 0
7896 || (objfile->flags & OBJF_USERLOADED) == 0)
7897 return;
7898
7899 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7900 {
7901 struct bp_location *loc;
7902 int bp_modified = 0;
7903
7904 if (!is_breakpoint (b) && !is_tracepoint (b))
7905 continue;
7906
7907 for (loc = b->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
7908 {
7909 CORE_ADDR loc_addr = loc->address;
7910
7911 if (loc->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7912 && loc->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
7913 continue;
7914
7915 if (loc->shlib_disabled != 0)
7916 continue;
7917
7918 if (objfile->pspace != loc->pspace)
7919 continue;
7920
7921 if (loc->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7922 && loc->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
7923 continue;
7924
7925 if (is_addr_in_objfile (loc_addr, objfile))
7926 {
7927 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7928 /* At this point, we don't know whether the object was
7929 unmapped from the inferior or not, so leave the
7930 inserted flag alone. We'll handle failure to
7931 uninsert quietly, in case the object was indeed
7932 unmapped. */
7933
7934 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
7935
7936 bp_modified = 1;
7937 }
7938 }
7939
7940 if (bp_modified)
7941 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
7942 }
7943 }
7944
7945 /* FORK & VFORK catchpoints. */
7946
7947 /* An instance of this type is used to represent a fork or vfork
7948 catchpoint. It includes a "struct breakpoint" as a kind of base
7949 class; users downcast to "struct breakpoint *" when needed. A
7950 breakpoint is really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
7951 CATCH_FORK_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
7952
7953 struct fork_catchpoint
7954 {
7955 /* The base class. */
7956 struct breakpoint base;
7957
7958 /* Process id of a child process whose forking triggered this
7959 catchpoint. This field is only valid immediately after this
7960 catchpoint has triggered. */
7961 ptid_t forked_inferior_pid;
7962 };
7963
7964 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7965 catchpoints. */
7966
7967 static int
7968 insert_catch_fork (struct bp_location *bl)
7969 {
7970 return target_insert_fork_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
7971 }
7972
7973 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7974 catchpoints. */
7975
7976 static int
7977 remove_catch_fork (struct bp_location *bl)
7978 {
7979 return target_remove_fork_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
7980 }
7981
7982 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7983 catchpoints. */
7984
7985 static int
7986 breakpoint_hit_catch_fork (const struct bp_location *bl,
7987 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
7988 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
7989 {
7990 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
7991
7992 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_FORKED)
7993 return 0;
7994
7995 c->forked_inferior_pid = ws->value.related_pid;
7996 return 1;
7997 }
7998
7999 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for fork
8000 catchpoints. */
8001
8002 static enum print_stop_action
8003 print_it_catch_fork (bpstat bs)
8004 {
8005 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8006 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
8007 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
8008
8009 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8010 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
8011 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary catchpoint ");
8012 else
8013 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nCatchpoint ");
8014 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8015 {
8016 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
8017 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_FORK));
8018 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8019 }
8020 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
8021 ui_out_text (uiout, " (forked process ");
8022 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "newpid", ptid_get_pid (c->forked_inferior_pid));
8023 ui_out_text (uiout, "), ");
8024 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8025 }
8026
8027 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for fork
8028 catchpoints. */
8029
8030 static void
8031 print_one_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
8032 {
8033 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
8034 struct value_print_options opts;
8035 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8036
8037 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8038
8039 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
8040 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
8041 readable). */
8042 if (opts.addressprint)
8043 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
8044 annotate_field (5);
8045 ui_out_text (uiout, "fork");
8046 if (!ptid_equal (c->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid))
8047 {
8048 ui_out_text (uiout, ", process ");
8049 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "what",
8050 ptid_get_pid (c->forked_inferior_pid));
8051 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 1);
8052 }
8053
8054 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8055 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "catch-type", "fork");
8056 }
8057
8058 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for fork
8059 catchpoints. */
8060
8061 static void
8062 print_mention_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
8063 {
8064 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (fork)"), b->number);
8065 }
8066
8067 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for fork
8068 catchpoints. */
8069
8070 static void
8071 print_recreate_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8072 {
8073 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch fork");
8074 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
8075 }
8076
8077 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in fork catchpoints. */
8078
8079 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_fork_breakpoint_ops;
8080
8081 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
8082 catchpoints. */
8083
8084 static int
8085 insert_catch_vfork (struct bp_location *bl)
8086 {
8087 return target_insert_vfork_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
8088 }
8089
8090 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
8091 catchpoints. */
8092
8093 static int
8094 remove_catch_vfork (struct bp_location *bl)
8095 {
8096 return target_remove_vfork_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
8097 }
8098
8099 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
8100 catchpoints. */
8101
8102 static int
8103 breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork (const struct bp_location *bl,
8104 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
8105 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
8106 {
8107 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
8108
8109 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_VFORKED)
8110 return 0;
8111
8112 c->forked_inferior_pid = ws->value.related_pid;
8113 return 1;
8114 }
8115
8116 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
8117 catchpoints. */
8118
8119 static enum print_stop_action
8120 print_it_catch_vfork (bpstat bs)
8121 {
8122 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8123 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
8124 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
8125
8126 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8127 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
8128 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary catchpoint ");
8129 else
8130 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nCatchpoint ");
8131 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8132 {
8133 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
8134 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_VFORK));
8135 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8136 }
8137 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
8138 ui_out_text (uiout, " (vforked process ");
8139 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "newpid", ptid_get_pid (c->forked_inferior_pid));
8140 ui_out_text (uiout, "), ");
8141 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8142 }
8143
8144 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
8145 catchpoints. */
8146
8147 static void
8148 print_one_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
8149 {
8150 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
8151 struct value_print_options opts;
8152 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8153
8154 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8155 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
8156 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
8157 readable). */
8158 if (opts.addressprint)
8159 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
8160 annotate_field (5);
8161 ui_out_text (uiout, "vfork");
8162 if (!ptid_equal (c->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid))
8163 {
8164 ui_out_text (uiout, ", process ");
8165 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "what",
8166 ptid_get_pid (c->forked_inferior_pid));
8167 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 1);
8168 }
8169
8170 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8171 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "catch-type", "vfork");
8172 }
8173
8174 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
8175 catchpoints. */
8176
8177 static void
8178 print_mention_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
8179 {
8180 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (vfork)"), b->number);
8181 }
8182
8183 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
8184 catchpoints. */
8185
8186 static void
8187 print_recreate_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8188 {
8189 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch vfork");
8190 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
8191 }
8192
8193 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in vfork catchpoints. */
8194
8195 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops;
8196
8197 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an solib catchpoint.
8198 It includes a "struct breakpoint" as a kind of base class; users
8199 downcast to "struct breakpoint *" when needed. A breakpoint is
8200 really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
8201 CATCH_SOLIB_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
8202
8203 struct solib_catchpoint
8204 {
8205 /* The base class. */
8206 struct breakpoint base;
8207
8208 /* True for "catch load", false for "catch unload". */
8209 unsigned char is_load;
8210
8211 /* Regular expression to match, if any. COMPILED is only valid when
8212 REGEX is non-NULL. */
8213 char *regex;
8214 regex_t compiled;
8215 };
8216
8217 static void
8218 dtor_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b)
8219 {
8220 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8221
8222 if (self->regex)
8223 regfree (&self->compiled);
8224 xfree (self->regex);
8225
8226 base_breakpoint_ops.dtor (b);
8227 }
8228
8229 static int
8230 insert_catch_solib (struct bp_location *ignore)
8231 {
8232 return 0;
8233 }
8234
8235 static int
8236 remove_catch_solib (struct bp_location *ignore)
8237 {
8238 return 0;
8239 }
8240
8241 static int
8242 breakpoint_hit_catch_solib (const struct bp_location *bl,
8243 struct address_space *aspace,
8244 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
8245 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
8246 {
8247 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
8248 struct breakpoint *other;
8249
8250 if (ws->kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_LOADED)
8251 return 1;
8252
8253 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (other)
8254 {
8255 struct bp_location *other_bl;
8256
8257 if (other == bl->owner)
8258 continue;
8259
8260 if (other->type != bp_shlib_event)
8261 continue;
8262
8263 if (self->base.pspace != NULL && other->pspace != self->base.pspace)
8264 continue;
8265
8266 for (other_bl = other->loc; other_bl != NULL; other_bl = other_bl->next)
8267 {
8268 if (other->ops->breakpoint_hit (other_bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws))
8269 return 1;
8270 }
8271 }
8272
8273 return 0;
8274 }
8275
8276 static void
8277 check_status_catch_solib (struct bpstats *bs)
8278 {
8279 struct solib_catchpoint *self
8280 = (struct solib_catchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
8281 int ix;
8282
8283 if (self->is_load)
8284 {
8285 struct so_list *iter;
8286
8287 for (ix = 0;
8288 VEC_iterate (so_list_ptr, current_program_space->added_solibs,
8289 ix, iter);
8290 ++ix)
8291 {
8292 if (!self->regex
8293 || regexec (&self->compiled, iter->so_name, 0, NULL, 0) == 0)
8294 return;
8295 }
8296 }
8297 else
8298 {
8299 char *iter;
8300
8301 for (ix = 0;
8302 VEC_iterate (char_ptr, current_program_space->deleted_solibs,
8303 ix, iter);
8304 ++ix)
8305 {
8306 if (!self->regex
8307 || regexec (&self->compiled, iter, 0, NULL, 0) == 0)
8308 return;
8309 }
8310 }
8311
8312 bs->stop = 0;
8313 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
8314 }
8315
8316 static enum print_stop_action
8317 print_it_catch_solib (bpstat bs)
8318 {
8319 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
8320 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8321
8322 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8323 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
8324 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary catchpoint ");
8325 else
8326 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nCatchpoint ");
8327 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
8328 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
8329 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8330 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8331 print_solib_event (1);
8332 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8333 }
8334
8335 static void
8336 print_one_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **locs)
8337 {
8338 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8339 struct value_print_options opts;
8340 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8341 char *msg;
8342
8343 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8344 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
8345 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
8346 readable). */
8347 if (opts.addressprint)
8348 {
8349 annotate_field (4);
8350 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
8351 }
8352
8353 annotate_field (5);
8354 if (self->is_load)
8355 {
8356 if (self->regex)
8357 msg = xstrprintf (_("load of library matching %s"), self->regex);
8358 else
8359 msg = xstrdup (_("load of library"));
8360 }
8361 else
8362 {
8363 if (self->regex)
8364 msg = xstrprintf (_("unload of library matching %s"), self->regex);
8365 else
8366 msg = xstrdup (_("unload of library"));
8367 }
8368 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", msg);
8369 xfree (msg);
8370
8371 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8372 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "catch-type",
8373 self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8374 }
8375
8376 static void
8377 print_mention_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b)
8378 {
8379 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8380
8381 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (%s)"), b->number,
8382 self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8383 }
8384
8385 static void
8386 print_recreate_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8387 {
8388 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8389
8390 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "%s %s",
8391 b->disposition == disp_del ? "tcatch" : "catch",
8392 self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8393 if (self->regex)
8394 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", self->regex);
8395 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "\n");
8396 }
8397
8398 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_solib_breakpoint_ops;
8399
8400 /* Shared helper function (MI and CLI) for creating and installing
8401 a shared object event catchpoint. If IS_LOAD is non-zero then
8402 the events to be caught are load events, otherwise they are
8403 unload events. If IS_TEMP is non-zero the catchpoint is a
8404 temporary one. If ENABLED is non-zero the catchpoint is
8405 created in an enabled state. */
8406
8407 void
8408 add_solib_catchpoint (char *arg, int is_load, int is_temp, int enabled)
8409 {
8410 struct solib_catchpoint *c;
8411 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8412 struct cleanup *cleanup;
8413
8414 if (!arg)
8415 arg = "";
8416 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
8417
8418 c = XCNEW (struct solib_catchpoint);
8419 cleanup = make_cleanup (xfree, c);
8420
8421 if (*arg != '\0')
8422 {
8423 int errcode;
8424
8425 errcode = regcomp (&c->compiled, arg, REG_NOSUB);
8426 if (errcode != 0)
8427 {
8428 char *err = get_regcomp_error (errcode, &c->compiled);
8429
8430 make_cleanup (xfree, err);
8431 error (_("Invalid regexp (%s): %s"), err, arg);
8432 }
8433 c->regex = xstrdup (arg);
8434 }
8435
8436 c->is_load = is_load;
8437 init_catchpoint (&c->base, gdbarch, is_temp, NULL,
8438 &catch_solib_breakpoint_ops);
8439
8440 c->base.enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
8441
8442 discard_cleanups (cleanup);
8443 install_breakpoint (0, &c->base, 1);
8444 }
8445
8446 /* A helper function that does all the work for "catch load" and
8447 "catch unload". */
8448
8449 static void
8450 catch_load_or_unload (char *arg, int from_tty, int is_load,
8451 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8452 {
8453 int tempflag;
8454 const int enabled = 1;
8455
8456 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8457
8458 add_solib_catchpoint (arg, is_load, tempflag, enabled);
8459 }
8460
8461 static void
8462 catch_load_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
8463 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8464 {
8465 catch_load_or_unload (arg, from_tty, 1, command);
8466 }
8467
8468 static void
8469 catch_unload_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
8470 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8471 {
8472 catch_load_or_unload (arg, from_tty, 0, command);
8473 }
8474
8475 /* Initialize a new breakpoint of the bp_catchpoint kind. If TEMPFLAG
8476 is non-zero, then make the breakpoint temporary. If COND_STRING is
8477 not NULL, then store it in the breakpoint. OPS, if not NULL, is
8478 the breakpoint_ops structure associated to the catchpoint. */
8479
8480 void
8481 init_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
8482 struct gdbarch *gdbarch, int tempflag,
8483 char *cond_string,
8484 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
8485 {
8486 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8487
8488 init_sal (&sal);
8489 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
8490
8491 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bp_catchpoint, ops);
8492
8493 b->cond_string = (cond_string == NULL) ? NULL : xstrdup (cond_string);
8494 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
8495 }
8496
8497 void
8498 install_breakpoint (int internal, struct breakpoint *b, int update_gll)
8499 {
8500 add_to_breakpoint_chain (b);
8501 set_breakpoint_number (internal, b);
8502 if (is_tracepoint (b))
8503 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
8504 if (!internal)
8505 mention (b);
8506 observer_notify_breakpoint_created (b);
8507
8508 if (update_gll)
8509 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
8510 }
8511
8512 static void
8513 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8514 int tempflag, char *cond_string,
8515 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
8516 {
8517 struct fork_catchpoint *c = XNEW (struct fork_catchpoint);
8518
8519 init_catchpoint (&c->base, gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, ops);
8520
8521 c->forked_inferior_pid = null_ptid;
8522
8523 install_breakpoint (0, &c->base, 1);
8524 }
8525
8526 /* Exec catchpoints. */
8527
8528 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an exec catchpoint.
8529 It includes a "struct breakpoint" as a kind of base class; users
8530 downcast to "struct breakpoint *" when needed. A breakpoint is
8531 really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
8532 CATCH_EXEC_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
8533
8534 struct exec_catchpoint
8535 {
8536 /* The base class. */
8537 struct breakpoint base;
8538
8539 /* Filename of a program whose exec triggered this catchpoint.
8540 This field is only valid immediately after this catchpoint has
8541 triggered. */
8542 char *exec_pathname;
8543 };
8544
8545 /* Implement the "dtor" breakpoint_ops method for exec
8546 catchpoints. */
8547
8548 static void
8549 dtor_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
8550 {
8551 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b;
8552
8553 xfree (c->exec_pathname);
8554
8555 base_breakpoint_ops.dtor (b);
8556 }
8557
8558 static int
8559 insert_catch_exec (struct bp_location *bl)
8560 {
8561 return target_insert_exec_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
8562 }
8563
8564 static int
8565 remove_catch_exec (struct bp_location *bl)
8566 {
8567 return target_remove_exec_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
8568 }
8569
8570 static int
8571 breakpoint_hit_catch_exec (const struct bp_location *bl,
8572 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
8573 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
8574 {
8575 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
8576
8577 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_EXECD)
8578 return 0;
8579
8580 c->exec_pathname = xstrdup (ws->value.execd_pathname);
8581 return 1;
8582 }
8583
8584 static enum print_stop_action
8585 print_it_catch_exec (bpstat bs)
8586 {
8587 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8588 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
8589 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b;
8590
8591 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8592 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
8593 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary catchpoint ");
8594 else
8595 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nCatchpoint ");
8596 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8597 {
8598 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
8599 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_EXEC));
8600 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8601 }
8602 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
8603 ui_out_text (uiout, " (exec'd ");
8604 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "new-exec", c->exec_pathname);
8605 ui_out_text (uiout, "), ");
8606
8607 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8608 }
8609
8610 static void
8611 print_one_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
8612 {
8613 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b;
8614 struct value_print_options opts;
8615 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8616
8617 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8618
8619 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
8620 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
8621 is relatively readable). */
8622 if (opts.addressprint)
8623 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
8624 annotate_field (5);
8625 ui_out_text (uiout, "exec");
8626 if (c->exec_pathname != NULL)
8627 {
8628 ui_out_text (uiout, ", program \"");
8629 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", c->exec_pathname);
8630 ui_out_text (uiout, "\" ");
8631 }
8632
8633 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8634 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "catch-type", "exec");
8635 }
8636
8637 static void
8638 print_mention_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
8639 {
8640 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (exec)"), b->number);
8641 }
8642
8643 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for exec
8644 catchpoints. */
8645
8646 static void
8647 print_recreate_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8648 {
8649 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch exec");
8650 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
8651 }
8652
8653 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exec_breakpoint_ops;
8654
8655 static int
8656 hw_breakpoint_used_count (void)
8657 {
8658 int i = 0;
8659 struct breakpoint *b;
8660 struct bp_location *bl;
8661
8662 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8663 {
8664 if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint && breakpoint_enabled (b))
8665 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
8666 {
8667 /* Special types of hardware breakpoints may use more than
8668 one register. */
8669 i += b->ops->resources_needed (bl);
8670 }
8671 }
8672
8673 return i;
8674 }
8675
8676 /* Returns the resources B would use if it were a hardware
8677 watchpoint. */
8678
8679 static int
8680 hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *b)
8681 {
8682 int i = 0;
8683 struct bp_location *bl;
8684
8685 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
8686 return 0;
8687
8688 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
8689 {
8690 /* Special types of hardware watchpoints may use more than
8691 one register. */
8692 i += b->ops->resources_needed (bl);
8693 }
8694
8695 return i;
8696 }
8697
8698 /* Returns the sum the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of
8699 type TYPE in the breakpoints list. Also returns in OTHER_TYPE_USED
8700 the sum of the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of other
8701 types _not_ TYPE. */
8702
8703 static int
8704 hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except,
8705 enum bptype type, int *other_type_used)
8706 {
8707 int i = 0;
8708 struct breakpoint *b;
8709
8710 *other_type_used = 0;
8711 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8712 {
8713 if (b == except)
8714 continue;
8715 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
8716 continue;
8717
8718 if (b->type == type)
8719 i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (b);
8720 else if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
8721 *other_type_used = 1;
8722 }
8723
8724 return i;
8725 }
8726
8727 void
8728 disable_watchpoints_before_interactive_call_start (void)
8729 {
8730 struct breakpoint *b;
8731
8732 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8733 {
8734 if (is_watchpoint (b) && breakpoint_enabled (b))
8735 {
8736 b->enable_state = bp_call_disabled;
8737 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
8738 }
8739 }
8740 }
8741
8742 void
8743 enable_watchpoints_after_interactive_call_stop (void)
8744 {
8745 struct breakpoint *b;
8746
8747 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8748 {
8749 if (is_watchpoint (b) && b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled)
8750 {
8751 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8752 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
8753 }
8754 }
8755 }
8756
8757 void
8758 disable_breakpoints_before_startup (void)
8759 {
8760 current_program_space->executing_startup = 1;
8761 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
8762 }
8763
8764 void
8765 enable_breakpoints_after_startup (void)
8766 {
8767 current_program_space->executing_startup = 0;
8768 breakpoint_re_set ();
8769 }
8770
8771 /* Create a new single-step breakpoint for thread THREAD, with no
8772 locations. */
8773
8774 static struct breakpoint *
8775 new_single_step_breakpoint (int thread, struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
8776 {
8777 struct breakpoint *b = XNEW (struct breakpoint);
8778
8779 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, gdbarch, bp_single_step,
8780 &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
8781
8782 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8783 b->frame_id = null_frame_id;
8784
8785 b->thread = thread;
8786 gdb_assert (b->thread != 0);
8787
8788 add_to_breakpoint_chain (b);
8789
8790 return b;
8791 }
8792
8793 /* Set a momentary breakpoint of type TYPE at address specified by
8794 SAL. If FRAME_ID is valid, the breakpoint is restricted to that
8795 frame. */
8796
8797 struct breakpoint *
8798 set_momentary_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, struct symtab_and_line sal,
8799 struct frame_id frame_id, enum bptype type)
8800 {
8801 struct breakpoint *b;
8802
8803 /* If FRAME_ID is valid, it should be a real frame, not an inlined or
8804 tail-called one. */
8805 gdb_assert (!frame_id_artificial_p (frame_id));
8806
8807 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type, &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
8808 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8809 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8810 b->frame_id = frame_id;
8811
8812 /* If we're debugging a multi-threaded program, then we want
8813 momentary breakpoints to be active in only a single thread of
8814 control. */
8815 if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid))
8816 b->thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
8817
8818 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
8819
8820 return b;
8821 }
8822
8823 /* Make a momentary breakpoint based on the master breakpoint ORIG.
8824 The new breakpoint will have type TYPE, use OPS as its
8825 breakpoint_ops, and will set enabled to LOC_ENABLED. */
8826
8827 static struct breakpoint *
8828 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig,
8829 enum bptype type,
8830 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
8831 int loc_enabled)
8832 {
8833 struct breakpoint *copy;
8834
8835 copy = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (orig->gdbarch, type, ops);
8836 copy->loc = allocate_bp_location (copy);
8837 set_breakpoint_location_function (copy->loc, 1);
8838
8839 copy->loc->gdbarch = orig->loc->gdbarch;
8840 copy->loc->requested_address = orig->loc->requested_address;
8841 copy->loc->address = orig->loc->address;
8842 copy->loc->section = orig->loc->section;
8843 copy->loc->pspace = orig->loc->pspace;
8844 copy->loc->probe = orig->loc->probe;
8845 copy->loc->line_number = orig->loc->line_number;
8846 copy->loc->symtab = orig->loc->symtab;
8847 copy->loc->enabled = loc_enabled;
8848 copy->frame_id = orig->frame_id;
8849 copy->thread = orig->thread;
8850 copy->pspace = orig->pspace;
8851
8852 copy->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8853 copy->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8854 copy->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
8855
8856 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
8857 return copy;
8858 }
8859
8860 /* Make a deep copy of momentary breakpoint ORIG. Returns NULL if
8861 ORIG is NULL. */
8862
8863 struct breakpoint *
8864 clone_momentary_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *orig)
8865 {
8866 /* If there's nothing to clone, then return nothing. */
8867 if (orig == NULL)
8868 return NULL;
8869
8870 return momentary_breakpoint_from_master (orig, orig->type, orig->ops, 0);
8871 }
8872
8873 struct breakpoint *
8874 set_momentary_breakpoint_at_pc (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR pc,
8875 enum bptype type)
8876 {
8877 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8878
8879 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
8880 sal.pc = pc;
8881 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
8882 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
8883
8884 return set_momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, null_frame_id, type);
8885 }
8886 \f
8887
8888 /* Tell the user we have just set a breakpoint B. */
8889
8890 static void
8891 mention (struct breakpoint *b)
8892 {
8893 b->ops->print_mention (b);
8894 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (current_uiout))
8895 return;
8896 printf_filtered ("\n");
8897 }
8898 \f
8899
8900 static int bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc);
8901
8902 static struct bp_location *
8903 add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
8904 const struct symtab_and_line *sal)
8905 {
8906 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
8907 CORE_ADDR adjusted_address;
8908 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (*sal);
8909
8910 if (loc_gdbarch == NULL)
8911 loc_gdbarch = b->gdbarch;
8912
8913 /* Adjust the breakpoint's address prior to allocating a location.
8914 Once we call allocate_bp_location(), that mostly uninitialized
8915 location will be placed on the location chain. Adjustment of the
8916 breakpoint may cause target_read_memory() to be called and we do
8917 not want its scan of the location chain to find a breakpoint and
8918 location that's only been partially initialized. */
8919 adjusted_address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc_gdbarch,
8920 sal->pc, b->type);
8921
8922 /* Sort the locations by their ADDRESS. */
8923 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
8924 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL && (*tmp)->address <= adjusted_address;
8925 tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
8926 ;
8927 loc->next = *tmp;
8928 *tmp = loc;
8929
8930 loc->requested_address = sal->pc;
8931 loc->address = adjusted_address;
8932 loc->pspace = sal->pspace;
8933 loc->probe.probe = sal->probe;
8934 loc->probe.objfile = sal->objfile;
8935 gdb_assert (loc->pspace != NULL);
8936 loc->section = sal->section;
8937 loc->gdbarch = loc_gdbarch;
8938 loc->line_number = sal->line;
8939 loc->symtab = sal->symtab;
8940
8941 set_breakpoint_location_function (loc,
8942 sal->explicit_pc || sal->explicit_line);
8943
8944 /* While by definition, permanent breakpoints are already present in the
8945 code, we don't mark the location as inserted. Normally one would expect
8946 that GDB could rely on that breakpoint instruction to stop the program,
8947 thus removing the need to insert its own breakpoint, except that executing
8948 the breakpoint instruction can kill the target instead of reporting a
8949 SIGTRAP. E.g., on SPARC, when interrupts are disabled, executing the
8950 instruction resets the CPU, so QEMU 2.0.0 for SPARC correspondingly dies
8951 with "Trap 0x02 while interrupts disabled, Error state". Letting the
8952 breakpoint be inserted normally results in QEMU knowing about the GDB
8953 breakpoint, and thus trap before the breakpoint instruction is executed.
8954 (If GDB later needs to continue execution past the permanent breakpoint,
8955 it manually increments the PC, thus avoiding executing the breakpoint
8956 instruction.) */
8957 if (bp_loc_is_permanent (loc))
8958 loc->permanent = 1;
8959
8960 return loc;
8961 }
8962 \f
8963
8964 /* See breakpoint.h. */
8965
8966 int
8967 program_breakpoint_here_p (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
8968 {
8969 int len;
8970 CORE_ADDR addr;
8971 const gdb_byte *bpoint;
8972 gdb_byte *target_mem;
8973 struct cleanup *cleanup;
8974 int retval = 0;
8975
8976 addr = address;
8977 bpoint = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (gdbarch, &addr, &len);
8978
8979 /* Software breakpoints unsupported? */
8980 if (bpoint == NULL)
8981 return 0;
8982
8983 target_mem = alloca (len);
8984
8985 /* Enable the automatic memory restoration from breakpoints while
8986 we read the memory. Otherwise we could say about our temporary
8987 breakpoints they are permanent. */
8988 cleanup = make_show_memory_breakpoints_cleanup (0);
8989
8990 if (target_read_memory (address, target_mem, len) == 0
8991 && memcmp (target_mem, bpoint, len) == 0)
8992 retval = 1;
8993
8994 do_cleanups (cleanup);
8995
8996 return retval;
8997 }
8998
8999 /* Return 1 if LOC is pointing to a permanent breakpoint,
9000 return 0 otherwise. */
9001
9002 static int
9003 bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc)
9004 {
9005 struct cleanup *cleanup;
9006 int retval;
9007
9008 gdb_assert (loc != NULL);
9009
9010 /* If we have a catchpoint or a watchpoint, just return 0. We should not
9011 attempt to read from the addresses the locations of these breakpoint types
9012 point to. program_breakpoint_here_p, below, will attempt to read
9013 memory. */
9014 if (!breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (loc->owner))
9015 return 0;
9016
9017 cleanup = save_current_space_and_thread ();
9018 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (loc->pspace);
9019
9020 retval = program_breakpoint_here_p (loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
9021
9022 do_cleanups (cleanup);
9023
9024 return retval;
9025 }
9026
9027 /* Build a command list for the dprintf corresponding to the current
9028 settings of the dprintf style options. */
9029
9030 static void
9031 update_dprintf_command_list (struct breakpoint *b)
9032 {
9033 char *dprintf_args = b->extra_string;
9034 char *printf_line = NULL;
9035
9036 if (!dprintf_args)
9037 return;
9038
9039 dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args);
9040
9041 /* Allow a comma, as it may have terminated a location, but don't
9042 insist on it. */
9043 if (*dprintf_args == ',')
9044 ++dprintf_args;
9045 dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args);
9046
9047 if (*dprintf_args != '"')
9048 error (_("Bad format string, missing '\"'."));
9049
9050 if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_gdb) == 0)
9051 printf_line = xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args);
9052 else if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_call) == 0)
9053 {
9054 if (!dprintf_function)
9055 error (_("No function supplied for dprintf call"));
9056
9057 if (dprintf_channel && strlen (dprintf_channel) > 0)
9058 printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s,%s)",
9059 dprintf_function,
9060 dprintf_channel,
9061 dprintf_args);
9062 else
9063 printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s)",
9064 dprintf_function,
9065 dprintf_args);
9066 }
9067 else if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_agent) == 0)
9068 {
9069 if (target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
9070 printf_line = xstrprintf ("agent-printf %s", dprintf_args);
9071 else
9072 {
9073 warning (_("Target cannot run dprintf commands, falling back to GDB printf"));
9074 printf_line = xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args);
9075 }
9076 }
9077 else
9078 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
9079 _("Invalid dprintf style."));
9080
9081 gdb_assert (printf_line != NULL);
9082 /* Manufacture a printf sequence. */
9083 {
9084 struct command_line *printf_cmd_line = XNEW (struct command_line);
9085
9086 printf_cmd_line->control_type = simple_control;
9087 printf_cmd_line->body_count = 0;
9088 printf_cmd_line->body_list = NULL;
9089 printf_cmd_line->next = NULL;
9090 printf_cmd_line->line = printf_line;
9091
9092 breakpoint_set_commands (b, printf_cmd_line);
9093 }
9094 }
9095
9096 /* Update all dprintf commands, making their command lists reflect
9097 current style settings. */
9098
9099 static void
9100 update_dprintf_commands (char *args, int from_tty,
9101 struct cmd_list_element *c)
9102 {
9103 struct breakpoint *b;
9104
9105 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9106 {
9107 if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
9108 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
9109 }
9110 }
9111
9112 /* Create a breakpoint with SAL as location. Use LOCATION
9113 as a description of the location, and COND_STRING
9114 as condition expression. */
9115
9116 static void
9117 init_breakpoint_sal (struct breakpoint *b, struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9118 struct symtabs_and_lines sals,
9119 struct event_location *location,
9120 char *filter, char *cond_string,
9121 char *extra_string,
9122 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
9123 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
9124 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
9125 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags,
9126 int display_canonical)
9127 {
9128 int i;
9129
9130 if (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
9131 {
9132 int target_resources_ok;
9133
9134 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
9135 target_resources_ok =
9136 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
9137 i + 1, 0);
9138 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
9139 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
9140 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
9141 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
9142 }
9143
9144 gdb_assert (sals.nelts > 0);
9145
9146 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
9147 {
9148 struct symtab_and_line sal = sals.sals[i];
9149 struct bp_location *loc;
9150
9151 if (from_tty)
9152 {
9153 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
9154 if (!loc_gdbarch)
9155 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
9156
9157 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
9158 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, thread);
9159 }
9160
9161 if (i == 0)
9162 {
9163 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, type, ops);
9164 b->thread = thread;
9165 b->task = task;
9166
9167 b->cond_string = cond_string;
9168 b->extra_string = extra_string;
9169 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
9170 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
9171 b->disposition = disposition;
9172
9173 if ((flags & CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED) != 0)
9174 b->loc->inserted = 1;
9175
9176 if (type == bp_static_tracepoint)
9177 {
9178 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
9179 struct static_tracepoint_marker marker;
9180
9181 if (strace_marker_p (b))
9182 {
9183 /* We already know the marker exists, otherwise, we
9184 wouldn't see a sal for it. */
9185 const char *p = &event_location_to_string (b->location)[3];
9186 const char *endp;
9187 char *marker_str;
9188
9189 p = skip_spaces_const (p);
9190
9191 endp = skip_to_space_const (p);
9192
9193 marker_str = savestring (p, endp - p);
9194 t->static_trace_marker_id = marker_str;
9195
9196 printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint "
9197 "marker \"%s\"\n"),
9198 t->static_trace_marker_id);
9199 }
9200 else if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (sal.pc, &marker))
9201 {
9202 t->static_trace_marker_id = xstrdup (marker.str_id);
9203 release_static_tracepoint_marker (&marker);
9204
9205 printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint "
9206 "marker \"%s\"\n"),
9207 t->static_trace_marker_id);
9208 }
9209 else
9210 warning (_("Couldn't determine the static "
9211 "tracepoint marker to probe"));
9212 }
9213
9214 loc = b->loc;
9215 }
9216 else
9217 {
9218 loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
9219 if ((flags & CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED) != 0)
9220 loc->inserted = 1;
9221 }
9222
9223 if (b->cond_string)
9224 {
9225 const char *arg = b->cond_string;
9226
9227 loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&arg, loc->address,
9228 block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
9229 if (*arg)
9230 error (_("Garbage '%s' follows condition"), arg);
9231 }
9232
9233 /* Dynamic printf requires and uses additional arguments on the
9234 command line, otherwise it's an error. */
9235 if (type == bp_dprintf)
9236 {
9237 if (b->extra_string)
9238 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
9239 else
9240 error (_("Format string required"));
9241 }
9242 else if (b->extra_string)
9243 error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of command"), b->extra_string);
9244 }
9245
9246 b->display_canonical = display_canonical;
9247 if (location != NULL)
9248 b->location = location;
9249 else
9250 b->location = new_address_location (b->loc->address);
9251 b->filter = filter;
9252 }
9253
9254 static void
9255 create_breakpoint_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9256 struct symtabs_and_lines sals,
9257 struct event_location *location,
9258 char *filter, char *cond_string,
9259 char *extra_string,
9260 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
9261 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
9262 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
9263 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags,
9264 int display_canonical)
9265 {
9266 struct breakpoint *b;
9267 struct cleanup *old_chain;
9268
9269 if (is_tracepoint_type (type))
9270 {
9271 struct tracepoint *t;
9272
9273 t = XCNEW (struct tracepoint);
9274 b = &t->base;
9275 }
9276 else
9277 b = XNEW (struct breakpoint);
9278
9279 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, b);
9280
9281 init_breakpoint_sal (b, gdbarch,
9282 sals, location,
9283 filter, cond_string, extra_string,
9284 type, disposition,
9285 thread, task, ignore_count,
9286 ops, from_tty,
9287 enabled, internal, flags,
9288 display_canonical);
9289 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
9290
9291 install_breakpoint (internal, b, 0);
9292 }
9293
9294 /* Add SALS.nelts breakpoints to the breakpoint table. For each
9295 SALS.sal[i] breakpoint, include the corresponding ADDR_STRING[i]
9296 value. COND_STRING, if not NULL, specified the condition to be
9297 used for all breakpoints. Essentially the only case where
9298 SALS.nelts is not 1 is when we set a breakpoint on an overloaded
9299 function. In that case, it's still not possible to specify
9300 separate conditions for different overloaded functions, so
9301 we take just a single condition string.
9302
9303 NOTE: If the function succeeds, the caller is expected to cleanup
9304 the arrays ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING, and SALS (but not the
9305 array contents). If the function fails (error() is called), the
9306 caller is expected to cleanups both the ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING,
9307 COND and SALS arrays and each of those arrays contents. */
9308
9309 static void
9310 create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9311 struct linespec_result *canonical,
9312 char *cond_string, char *extra_string,
9313 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
9314 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
9315 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
9316 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags)
9317 {
9318 int i;
9319 struct linespec_sals *lsal;
9320
9321 if (canonical->pre_expanded)
9322 gdb_assert (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical->sals) == 1);
9323
9324 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (linespec_sals, canonical->sals, i, lsal); ++i)
9325 {
9326 /* Note that 'location' can be NULL in the case of a plain
9327 'break', without arguments. */
9328 struct event_location *location
9329 = (canonical->location != NULL
9330 ? copy_event_location (canonical->location) : NULL);
9331 char *filter_string = lsal->canonical ? xstrdup (lsal->canonical) : NULL;
9332 struct cleanup *inner = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (location);
9333
9334 make_cleanup (xfree, filter_string);
9335 create_breakpoint_sal (gdbarch, lsal->sals,
9336 location,
9337 filter_string,
9338 cond_string, extra_string,
9339 type, disposition,
9340 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
9341 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags,
9342 canonical->special_display);
9343 discard_cleanups (inner);
9344 }
9345 }
9346
9347 /* Parse LOCATION which is assumed to be a SAL specification possibly
9348 followed by conditionals. On return, SALS contains an array of SAL
9349 addresses found. LOCATION points to the end of the SAL (for
9350 linespec locations).
9351
9352 The array and the line spec strings are allocated on the heap, it is
9353 the caller's responsibility to free them. */
9354
9355 static void
9356 parse_breakpoint_sals (const struct event_location *location,
9357 struct linespec_result *canonical)
9358 {
9359 struct symtab_and_line cursal;
9360
9361 if (event_location_type (location) == LINESPEC_LOCATION)
9362 {
9363 const char *address = get_linespec_location (location);
9364
9365 if (address == NULL)
9366 {
9367 /* The last displayed codepoint, if it's valid, is our default
9368 breakpoint address. */
9369 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ())
9370 {
9371 struct linespec_sals lsal;
9372 struct symtab_and_line sal;
9373 CORE_ADDR pc;
9374
9375 init_sal (&sal); /* Initialize to zeroes. */
9376 lsal.sals.sals = XNEW (struct symtab_and_line);
9377
9378 /* Set sal's pspace, pc, symtab, and line to the values
9379 corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info.
9380 Be sure to reinitialize LINE with NOTCURRENT == 0
9381 as the breakpoint line number is inappropriate otherwise.
9382 find_pc_line would adjust PC, re-set it back. */
9383 get_last_displayed_sal (&sal);
9384 pc = sal.pc;
9385 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
9386
9387 /* "break" without arguments is equivalent to "break *PC"
9388 where PC is the last displayed codepoint's address. So
9389 make sure to set sal.explicit_pc to prevent GDB from
9390 trying to expand the list of sals to include all other
9391 instances with the same symtab and line. */
9392 sal.pc = pc;
9393 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
9394
9395 lsal.sals.sals[0] = sal;
9396 lsal.sals.nelts = 1;
9397 lsal.canonical = NULL;
9398
9399 VEC_safe_push (linespec_sals, canonical->sals, &lsal);
9400 return;
9401 }
9402 else
9403 error (_("No default breakpoint address now."));
9404 }
9405 }
9406
9407 /* Force almost all breakpoints to be in terms of the
9408 current_source_symtab (which is decode_line_1's default).
9409 This should produce the results we want almost all of the
9410 time while leaving default_breakpoint_* alone.
9411
9412 ObjC: However, don't match an Objective-C method name which
9413 may have a '+' or '-' succeeded by a '['. */
9414 cursal = get_current_source_symtab_and_line ();
9415 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ())
9416 {
9417 const char *address = NULL;
9418
9419 if (event_location_type (location) == LINESPEC_LOCATION)
9420 address = get_linespec_location (location);
9421
9422 if (!cursal.symtab
9423 || (address != NULL
9424 && strchr ("+-", address[0]) != NULL
9425 && address[1] != '['))
9426 {
9427 decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE,
9428 get_last_displayed_symtab (),
9429 get_last_displayed_line (),
9430 canonical, NULL, NULL);
9431 return;
9432 }
9433 }
9434
9435 decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE,
9436 cursal.symtab, cursal.line, canonical, NULL, NULL);
9437 }
9438
9439
9440 /* Convert each SAL into a real PC. Verify that the PC can be
9441 inserted as a breakpoint. If it can't throw an error. */
9442
9443 static void
9444 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
9445 {
9446 int i;
9447
9448 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
9449 resolve_sal_pc (&sals->sals[i]);
9450 }
9451
9452 /* Fast tracepoints may have restrictions on valid locations. For
9453 instance, a fast tracepoint using a jump instead of a trap will
9454 likely have to overwrite more bytes than a trap would, and so can
9455 only be placed where the instruction is longer than the jump, or a
9456 multi-instruction sequence does not have a jump into the middle of
9457 it, etc. */
9458
9459 static void
9460 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9461 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
9462 {
9463 int i, rslt;
9464 struct symtab_and_line *sal;
9465 char *msg;
9466 struct cleanup *old_chain;
9467
9468 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
9469 {
9470 struct gdbarch *sarch;
9471
9472 sal = &sals->sals[i];
9473
9474 sarch = get_sal_arch (*sal);
9475 /* We fall back to GDBARCH if there is no architecture
9476 associated with SAL. */
9477 if (sarch == NULL)
9478 sarch = gdbarch;
9479 rslt = gdbarch_fast_tracepoint_valid_at (sarch, sal->pc, &msg);
9480 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, msg);
9481
9482 if (!rslt)
9483 error (_("May not have a fast tracepoint at 0x%s%s"),
9484 paddress (sarch, sal->pc), (msg ? msg : ""));
9485
9486 do_cleanups (old_chain);
9487 }
9488 }
9489
9490 /* Issue an invalid thread ID error. */
9491
9492 static void ATTRIBUTE_NORETURN
9493 invalid_thread_id_error (int id)
9494 {
9495 error (_("Unknown thread %d."), id);
9496 }
9497
9498 /* Given TOK, a string specification of condition and thread, as
9499 accepted by the 'break' command, extract the condition
9500 string and thread number and set *COND_STRING and *THREAD.
9501 PC identifies the context at which the condition should be parsed.
9502 If no condition is found, *COND_STRING is set to NULL.
9503 If no thread is found, *THREAD is set to -1. */
9504
9505 static void
9506 find_condition_and_thread (const char *tok, CORE_ADDR pc,
9507 char **cond_string, int *thread, int *task,
9508 char **rest)
9509 {
9510 *cond_string = NULL;
9511 *thread = -1;
9512 *task = 0;
9513 *rest = NULL;
9514
9515 while (tok && *tok)
9516 {
9517 const char *end_tok;
9518 int toklen;
9519 const char *cond_start = NULL;
9520 const char *cond_end = NULL;
9521
9522 tok = skip_spaces_const (tok);
9523
9524 if ((*tok == '"' || *tok == ',') && rest)
9525 {
9526 *rest = savestring (tok, strlen (tok));
9527 return;
9528 }
9529
9530 end_tok = skip_to_space_const (tok);
9531
9532 toklen = end_tok - tok;
9533
9534 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
9535 {
9536 struct expression *expr;
9537
9538 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
9539 expr = parse_exp_1 (&tok, pc, block_for_pc (pc), 0);
9540 xfree (expr);
9541 cond_end = tok;
9542 *cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
9543 }
9544 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0)
9545 {
9546 char *tmptok;
9547
9548 tok = end_tok + 1;
9549 *thread = strtol (tok, &tmptok, 0);
9550 if (tok == tmptok)
9551 error (_("Junk after thread keyword."));
9552 if (!valid_thread_id (*thread))
9553 invalid_thread_id_error (*thread);
9554 tok = tmptok;
9555 }
9556 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "task", toklen) == 0)
9557 {
9558 char *tmptok;
9559
9560 tok = end_tok + 1;
9561 *task = strtol (tok, &tmptok, 0);
9562 if (tok == tmptok)
9563 error (_("Junk after task keyword."));
9564 if (!valid_task_id (*task))
9565 error (_("Unknown task %d."), *task);
9566 tok = tmptok;
9567 }
9568 else if (rest)
9569 {
9570 *rest = savestring (tok, strlen (tok));
9571 return;
9572 }
9573 else
9574 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
9575 }
9576 }
9577
9578 /* Decode a static tracepoint marker spec. */
9579
9580 static struct symtabs_and_lines
9581 decode_static_tracepoint_spec (const char **arg_p)
9582 {
9583 VEC(static_tracepoint_marker_p) *markers = NULL;
9584 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
9585 struct cleanup *old_chain;
9586 const char *p = &(*arg_p)[3];
9587 const char *endp;
9588 char *marker_str;
9589 int i;
9590
9591 p = skip_spaces_const (p);
9592
9593 endp = skip_to_space_const (p);
9594
9595 marker_str = savestring (p, endp - p);
9596 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, marker_str);
9597
9598 markers = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid (marker_str);
9599 if (VEC_empty(static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers))
9600 error (_("No known static tracepoint marker named %s"), marker_str);
9601
9602 sals.nelts = VEC_length(static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers);
9603 sals.sals = XNEWVEC (struct symtab_and_line, sals.nelts);
9604
9605 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
9606 {
9607 struct static_tracepoint_marker *marker;
9608
9609 marker = VEC_index (static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers, i);
9610
9611 init_sal (&sals.sals[i]);
9612
9613 sals.sals[i] = find_pc_line (marker->address, 0);
9614 sals.sals[i].pc = marker->address;
9615
9616 release_static_tracepoint_marker (marker);
9617 }
9618
9619 do_cleanups (old_chain);
9620
9621 *arg_p = endp;
9622 return sals;
9623 }
9624
9625 /* See breakpoint.h. */
9626
9627 int
9628 create_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9629 const struct event_location *location, char *cond_string,
9630 int thread, char *extra_string,
9631 int parse_extra,
9632 int tempflag, enum bptype type_wanted,
9633 int ignore_count,
9634 enum auto_boolean pending_break_support,
9635 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
9636 int from_tty, int enabled, int internal,
9637 unsigned flags)
9638 {
9639 struct linespec_result canonical;
9640 struct cleanup *old_chain;
9641 struct cleanup *bkpt_chain = NULL;
9642 int pending = 0;
9643 int task = 0;
9644 int prev_bkpt_count = breakpoint_count;
9645
9646 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
9647
9648 /* If extra_string isn't useful, set it to NULL. */
9649 if (extra_string != NULL && *extra_string == '\0')
9650 extra_string = NULL;
9651
9652 init_linespec_result (&canonical);
9653
9654 TRY
9655 {
9656 ops->create_sals_from_location (location, &canonical, type_wanted);
9657 }
9658 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
9659 {
9660 /* If caller is interested in rc value from parse, set
9661 value. */
9662 if (e.error == NOT_FOUND_ERROR)
9663 {
9664 /* If pending breakpoint support is turned off, throw
9665 error. */
9666
9667 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE)
9668 throw_exception (e);
9669
9670 exception_print (gdb_stderr, e);
9671
9672 /* If pending breakpoint support is auto query and the user
9673 selects no, then simply return the error code. */
9674 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO
9675 && !nquery (_("Make %s pending on future shared library load? "),
9676 bptype_string (type_wanted)))
9677 return 0;
9678
9679 /* At this point, either the user was queried about setting
9680 a pending breakpoint and selected yes, or pending
9681 breakpoint behavior is on and thus a pending breakpoint
9682 is defaulted on behalf of the user. */
9683 pending = 1;
9684 }
9685 else
9686 throw_exception (e);
9687 }
9688 END_CATCH
9689
9690 if (!pending && VEC_empty (linespec_sals, canonical.sals))
9691 return 0;
9692
9693 /* Create a chain of things that always need to be cleaned up. */
9694 old_chain = make_cleanup_destroy_linespec_result (&canonical);
9695
9696 /* ----------------------------- SNIP -----------------------------
9697 Anything added to the cleanup chain beyond this point is assumed
9698 to be part of a breakpoint. If the breakpoint create succeeds
9699 then the memory is not reclaimed. */
9700 bkpt_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, 0);
9701
9702 /* Resolve all line numbers to PC's and verify that the addresses
9703 are ok for the target. */
9704 if (!pending)
9705 {
9706 int ix;
9707 struct linespec_sals *iter;
9708
9709 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (linespec_sals, canonical.sals, ix, iter); ++ix)
9710 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (&iter->sals);
9711 }
9712
9713 /* Fast tracepoints may have additional restrictions on location. */
9714 if (!pending && type_wanted == bp_fast_tracepoint)
9715 {
9716 int ix;
9717 struct linespec_sals *iter;
9718
9719 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (linespec_sals, canonical.sals, ix, iter); ++ix)
9720 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (gdbarch, &iter->sals);
9721 }
9722
9723 /* Verify that condition can be parsed, before setting any
9724 breakpoints. Allocate a separate condition expression for each
9725 breakpoint. */
9726 if (!pending)
9727 {
9728 if (parse_extra)
9729 {
9730 char *rest;
9731 struct linespec_sals *lsal;
9732
9733 lsal = VEC_index (linespec_sals, canonical.sals, 0);
9734
9735 /* Here we only parse 'arg' to separate condition
9736 from thread number, so parsing in context of first
9737 sal is OK. When setting the breakpoint we'll
9738 re-parse it in context of each sal. */
9739
9740 find_condition_and_thread (extra_string, lsal->sals.sals[0].pc,
9741 &cond_string, &thread, &task, &rest);
9742 if (cond_string)
9743 make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
9744 if (rest)
9745 make_cleanup (xfree, rest);
9746 if (rest)
9747 extra_string = rest;
9748 else
9749 extra_string = NULL;
9750 }
9751 else
9752 {
9753 if (type_wanted != bp_dprintf
9754 && extra_string != NULL && *extra_string != '\0')
9755 error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of location"), extra_string);
9756
9757 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
9758 if (cond_string)
9759 {
9760 cond_string = xstrdup (cond_string);
9761 make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
9762 }
9763 /* Create a private copy of any extra string. */
9764 if (extra_string)
9765 {
9766 extra_string = xstrdup (extra_string);
9767 make_cleanup (xfree, extra_string);
9768 }
9769 }
9770
9771 ops->create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, &canonical,
9772 cond_string, extra_string, type_wanted,
9773 tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch,
9774 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
9775 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags);
9776 }
9777 else
9778 {
9779 struct breakpoint *b;
9780
9781 if (is_tracepoint_type (type_wanted))
9782 {
9783 struct tracepoint *t;
9784
9785 t = XCNEW (struct tracepoint);
9786 b = &t->base;
9787 }
9788 else
9789 b = XNEW (struct breakpoint);
9790
9791 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, gdbarch, type_wanted, ops);
9792 b->location = copy_event_location (location);
9793
9794 if (parse_extra)
9795 b->cond_string = NULL;
9796 else
9797 {
9798 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
9799 if (cond_string)
9800 {
9801 cond_string = xstrdup (cond_string);
9802 make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
9803 }
9804 b->cond_string = cond_string;
9805 b->thread = thread;
9806 }
9807
9808 /* Create a private copy of any extra string. */
9809 if (extra_string != NULL)
9810 {
9811 extra_string = xstrdup (extra_string);
9812 make_cleanup (xfree, extra_string);
9813 }
9814 b->extra_string = extra_string;
9815 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
9816 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
9817 b->condition_not_parsed = 1;
9818 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
9819 if ((type_wanted != bp_breakpoint
9820 && type_wanted != bp_hardware_breakpoint) || thread != -1)
9821 b->pspace = current_program_space;
9822
9823 install_breakpoint (internal, b, 0);
9824 }
9825
9826 if (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical.sals) > 1)
9827 {
9828 warning (_("Multiple breakpoints were set.\nUse the "
9829 "\"delete\" command to delete unwanted breakpoints."));
9830 prev_breakpoint_count = prev_bkpt_count;
9831 }
9832
9833 /* That's it. Discard the cleanups for data inserted into the
9834 breakpoint. */
9835 discard_cleanups (bkpt_chain);
9836 /* But cleanup everything else. */
9837 do_cleanups (old_chain);
9838
9839 /* error call may happen here - have BKPT_CHAIN already discarded. */
9840 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
9841
9842 return 1;
9843 }
9844
9845 /* Set a breakpoint.
9846 ARG is a string describing breakpoint address,
9847 condition, and thread.
9848 FLAG specifies if a breakpoint is hardware on,
9849 and if breakpoint is temporary, using BP_HARDWARE_FLAG
9850 and BP_TEMPFLAG. */
9851
9852 static void
9853 break_command_1 (char *arg, int flag, int from_tty)
9854 {
9855 int tempflag = flag & BP_TEMPFLAG;
9856 enum bptype type_wanted = (flag & BP_HARDWAREFLAG
9857 ? bp_hardware_breakpoint
9858 : bp_breakpoint);
9859 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
9860 struct event_location *location;
9861 struct cleanup *cleanup;
9862
9863 location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
9864 cleanup = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (location);
9865
9866 /* Matching breakpoints on probes. */
9867 if (location != NULL
9868 && event_location_type (location) == PROBE_LOCATION)
9869 ops = &bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
9870 else
9871 ops = &bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
9872
9873 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
9874 location,
9875 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
9876 tempflag, type_wanted,
9877 0 /* Ignore count */,
9878 pending_break_support,
9879 ops,
9880 from_tty,
9881 1 /* enabled */,
9882 0 /* internal */,
9883 0);
9884 do_cleanups (cleanup);
9885 }
9886
9887 /* Helper function for break_command_1 and disassemble_command. */
9888
9889 void
9890 resolve_sal_pc (struct symtab_and_line *sal)
9891 {
9892 CORE_ADDR pc;
9893
9894 if (sal->pc == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
9895 {
9896 if (!find_line_pc (sal->symtab, sal->line, &pc))
9897 error (_("No line %d in file \"%s\"."),
9898 sal->line, symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal->symtab));
9899 sal->pc = pc;
9900
9901 /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using a line
9902 number, then skip the function prologue if necessary. */
9903 if (sal->explicit_line)
9904 skip_prologue_sal (sal);
9905 }
9906
9907 if (sal->section == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
9908 {
9909 const struct blockvector *bv;
9910 const struct block *b;
9911 struct symbol *sym;
9912
9913 bv = blockvector_for_pc_sect (sal->pc, 0, &b,
9914 SYMTAB_COMPUNIT (sal->symtab));
9915 if (bv != NULL)
9916 {
9917 sym = block_linkage_function (b);
9918 if (sym != NULL)
9919 {
9920 fixup_symbol_section (sym, SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal->symtab));
9921 sal->section = SYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal->symtab),
9922 sym);
9923 }
9924 else
9925 {
9926 /* It really is worthwhile to have the section, so we'll
9927 just have to look harder. This case can be executed
9928 if we have line numbers but no functions (as can
9929 happen in assembly source). */
9930
9931 struct bound_minimal_symbol msym;
9932 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
9933
9934 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal->pspace);
9935
9936 msym = lookup_minimal_symbol_by_pc (sal->pc);
9937 if (msym.minsym)
9938 sal->section = MSYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (msym.objfile, msym.minsym);
9939
9940 do_cleanups (old_chain);
9941 }
9942 }
9943 }
9944 }
9945
9946 void
9947 break_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9948 {
9949 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
9950 }
9951
9952 void
9953 tbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9954 {
9955 break_command_1 (arg, BP_TEMPFLAG, from_tty);
9956 }
9957
9958 static void
9959 hbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9960 {
9961 break_command_1 (arg, BP_HARDWAREFLAG, from_tty);
9962 }
9963
9964 static void
9965 thbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9966 {
9967 break_command_1 (arg, (BP_TEMPFLAG | BP_HARDWAREFLAG), from_tty);
9968 }
9969
9970 static void
9971 stop_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9972 {
9973 printf_filtered (_("Specify the type of breakpoint to set.\n\
9974 Usage: stop in <function | address>\n\
9975 stop at <line>\n"));
9976 }
9977
9978 static void
9979 stopin_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9980 {
9981 int badInput = 0;
9982
9983 if (arg == (char *) NULL)
9984 badInput = 1;
9985 else if (*arg != '*')
9986 {
9987 char *argptr = arg;
9988 int hasColon = 0;
9989
9990 /* Look for a ':'. If this is a line number specification, then
9991 say it is bad, otherwise, it should be an address or
9992 function/method name. */
9993 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
9994 {
9995 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
9996 argptr++;
9997 }
9998
9999 if (hasColon)
10000 badInput = (*argptr != ':'); /* Not a class::method */
10001 else
10002 badInput = isdigit (*arg); /* a simple line number */
10003 }
10004
10005 if (badInput)
10006 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop in <function | address>\n"));
10007 else
10008 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
10009 }
10010
10011 static void
10012 stopat_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10013 {
10014 int badInput = 0;
10015
10016 if (arg == (char *) NULL || *arg == '*') /* no line number */
10017 badInput = 1;
10018 else
10019 {
10020 char *argptr = arg;
10021 int hasColon = 0;
10022
10023 /* Look for a ':'. If there is a '::' then get out, otherwise
10024 it is probably a line number. */
10025 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
10026 {
10027 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
10028 argptr++;
10029 }
10030
10031 if (hasColon)
10032 badInput = (*argptr == ':'); /* we have class::method */
10033 else
10034 badInput = !isdigit (*arg); /* not a line number */
10035 }
10036
10037 if (badInput)
10038 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop at <line>\n"));
10039 else
10040 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
10041 }
10042
10043 /* The dynamic printf command is mostly like a regular breakpoint, but
10044 with a prewired command list consisting of a single output command,
10045 built from extra arguments supplied on the dprintf command
10046 line. */
10047
10048 static void
10049 dprintf_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10050 {
10051 struct event_location *location;
10052 struct cleanup *cleanup;
10053
10054 location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
10055 cleanup = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (location);
10056
10057 /* If non-NULL, ARG should have been advanced past the location;
10058 the next character must be ','. */
10059 if (arg != NULL)
10060 {
10061 if (arg[0] != ',' || arg[1] == '\0')
10062 error (_("Format string required"));
10063 else
10064 {
10065 /* Skip the comma. */
10066 ++arg;
10067 }
10068 }
10069
10070 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
10071 location,
10072 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
10073 0, bp_dprintf,
10074 0 /* Ignore count */,
10075 pending_break_support,
10076 &dprintf_breakpoint_ops,
10077 from_tty,
10078 1 /* enabled */,
10079 0 /* internal */,
10080 0);
10081 do_cleanups (cleanup);
10082 }
10083
10084 static void
10085 agent_printf_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10086 {
10087 error (_("May only run agent-printf on the target"));
10088 }
10089
10090 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for
10091 ranged breakpoints. */
10092
10093 static int
10094 breakpoint_hit_ranged_breakpoint (const struct bp_location *bl,
10095 struct address_space *aspace,
10096 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
10097 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
10098 {
10099 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED
10100 || ws->value.sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
10101 return 0;
10102
10103 return breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
10104 bl->length, aspace, bp_addr);
10105 }
10106
10107 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
10108 ranged breakpoints. */
10109
10110 static int
10111 resources_needed_ranged_breakpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
10112 {
10113 return target_ranged_break_num_registers ();
10114 }
10115
10116 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for
10117 ranged breakpoints. */
10118
10119 static enum print_stop_action
10120 print_it_ranged_breakpoint (bpstat bs)
10121 {
10122 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
10123 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
10124 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10125
10126 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
10127
10128 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location. */
10129 gdb_assert (bl && bl->next == NULL);
10130
10131 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
10132 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
10133 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary ranged breakpoint ");
10134 else
10135 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nRanged breakpoint ");
10136 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10137 {
10138 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
10139 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
10140 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
10141 }
10142 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
10143 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
10144
10145 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
10146 }
10147
10148 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for
10149 ranged breakpoints. */
10150
10151 static void
10152 print_one_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
10153 struct bp_location **last_loc)
10154 {
10155 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
10156 struct value_print_options opts;
10157 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10158
10159 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location. */
10160 gdb_assert (bl && bl->next == NULL);
10161
10162 get_user_print_options (&opts);
10163
10164 if (opts.addressprint)
10165 /* We don't print the address range here, it will be printed later
10166 by print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint. */
10167 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
10168 annotate_field (5);
10169 print_breakpoint_location (b, bl);
10170 *last_loc = bl;
10171 }
10172
10173 /* Implement the "print_one_detail" breakpoint_ops method for
10174 ranged breakpoints. */
10175
10176 static void
10177 print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *b,
10178 struct ui_out *uiout)
10179 {
10180 CORE_ADDR address_start, address_end;
10181 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
10182 struct ui_file *stb = mem_fileopen ();
10183 struct cleanup *cleanup = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (stb);
10184
10185 gdb_assert (bl);
10186
10187 address_start = bl->address;
10188 address_end = address_start + bl->length - 1;
10189
10190 ui_out_text (uiout, "\taddress range: ");
10191 fprintf_unfiltered (stb, "[%s, %s]",
10192 print_core_address (bl->gdbarch, address_start),
10193 print_core_address (bl->gdbarch, address_end));
10194 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "addr", stb);
10195 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
10196
10197 do_cleanups (cleanup);
10198 }
10199
10200 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for
10201 ranged breakpoints. */
10202
10203 static void
10204 print_mention_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10205 {
10206 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
10207 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10208
10209 gdb_assert (bl);
10210 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
10211
10212 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10213 return;
10214
10215 printf_filtered (_("Hardware assisted ranged breakpoint %d from %s to %s."),
10216 b->number, paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address),
10217 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address + bl->length - 1));
10218 }
10219
10220 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
10221 ranged breakpoints. */
10222
10223 static void
10224 print_recreate_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
10225 {
10226 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "break-range %s, %s",
10227 event_location_to_string (b->location),
10228 event_location_to_string (b->location_range_end));
10229 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
10230 }
10231
10232 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in ranged breakpoints. */
10233
10234 static struct breakpoint_ops ranged_breakpoint_ops;
10235
10236 /* Find the address where the end of the breakpoint range should be
10237 placed, given the SAL of the end of the range. This is so that if
10238 the user provides a line number, the end of the range is set to the
10239 last instruction of the given line. */
10240
10241 static CORE_ADDR
10242 find_breakpoint_range_end (struct symtab_and_line sal)
10243 {
10244 CORE_ADDR end;
10245
10246 /* If the user provided a PC value, use it. Otherwise,
10247 find the address of the end of the given location. */
10248 if (sal.explicit_pc)
10249 end = sal.pc;
10250 else
10251 {
10252 int ret;
10253 CORE_ADDR start;
10254
10255 ret = find_line_pc_range (sal, &start, &end);
10256 if (!ret)
10257 error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range."));
10258
10259 /* find_line_pc_range returns the start of the next line. */
10260 end--;
10261 }
10262
10263 return end;
10264 }
10265
10266 /* Implement the "break-range" CLI command. */
10267
10268 static void
10269 break_range_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10270 {
10271 char *arg_start, *addr_string_start, *addr_string_end;
10272 struct linespec_result canonical_start, canonical_end;
10273 int bp_count, can_use_bp, length;
10274 CORE_ADDR end;
10275 struct breakpoint *b;
10276 struct symtab_and_line sal_start, sal_end;
10277 struct cleanup *cleanup_bkpt;
10278 struct linespec_sals *lsal_start, *lsal_end;
10279 struct event_location *start_location, *end_location;
10280
10281 /* We don't support software ranged breakpoints. */
10282 if (target_ranged_break_num_registers () < 0)
10283 error (_("This target does not support hardware ranged breakpoints."));
10284
10285 bp_count = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
10286 bp_count += target_ranged_break_num_registers ();
10287 can_use_bp = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
10288 bp_count, 0);
10289 if (can_use_bp < 0)
10290 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
10291
10292 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
10293 if (arg == NULL || arg[0] == '\0')
10294 error(_("No address range specified."));
10295
10296 init_linespec_result (&canonical_start);
10297
10298 arg_start = arg;
10299 start_location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
10300 cleanup_bkpt = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (start_location);
10301 parse_breakpoint_sals (start_location, &canonical_start);
10302 make_cleanup_destroy_linespec_result (&canonical_start);
10303
10304 if (arg[0] != ',')
10305 error (_("Too few arguments."));
10306 else if (VEC_empty (linespec_sals, canonical_start.sals))
10307 error (_("Could not find location of the beginning of the range."));
10308
10309 lsal_start = VEC_index (linespec_sals, canonical_start.sals, 0);
10310
10311 if (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical_start.sals) > 1
10312 || lsal_start->sals.nelts != 1)
10313 error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations."));
10314
10315 sal_start = lsal_start->sals.sals[0];
10316 addr_string_start = savestring (arg_start, arg - arg_start);
10317 make_cleanup (xfree, addr_string_start);
10318
10319 arg++; /* Skip the comma. */
10320 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
10321
10322 /* Parse the end location. */
10323
10324 init_linespec_result (&canonical_end);
10325 arg_start = arg;
10326
10327 /* We call decode_line_full directly here instead of using
10328 parse_breakpoint_sals because we need to specify the start location's
10329 symtab and line as the default symtab and line for the end of the
10330 range. This makes it possible to have ranges like "foo.c:27, +14",
10331 where +14 means 14 lines from the start location. */
10332 end_location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
10333 make_cleanup_delete_event_location (end_location);
10334 decode_line_full (end_location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE,
10335 sal_start.symtab, sal_start.line,
10336 &canonical_end, NULL, NULL);
10337
10338 make_cleanup_destroy_linespec_result (&canonical_end);
10339
10340 if (VEC_empty (linespec_sals, canonical_end.sals))
10341 error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range."));
10342
10343 lsal_end = VEC_index (linespec_sals, canonical_end.sals, 0);
10344 if (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical_end.sals) > 1
10345 || lsal_end->sals.nelts != 1)
10346 error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations."));
10347
10348 sal_end = lsal_end->sals.sals[0];
10349
10350 end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sal_end);
10351 if (sal_start.pc > end)
10352 error (_("Invalid address range, end precedes start."));
10353
10354 length = end - sal_start.pc + 1;
10355 if (length < 0)
10356 /* Length overflowed. */
10357 error (_("Address range too large."));
10358 else if (length == 1)
10359 {
10360 /* This range is simple enough to be handled by
10361 the `hbreak' command. */
10362 hbreak_command (addr_string_start, 1);
10363
10364 do_cleanups (cleanup_bkpt);
10365
10366 return;
10367 }
10368
10369 /* Now set up the breakpoint. */
10370 b = set_raw_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), sal_start,
10371 bp_hardware_breakpoint, &ranged_breakpoint_ops);
10372 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
10373 b->number = breakpoint_count;
10374 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
10375 b->location = copy_event_location (start_location);
10376 b->location_range_end = copy_event_location (end_location);
10377 b->loc->length = length;
10378
10379 do_cleanups (cleanup_bkpt);
10380
10381 mention (b);
10382 observer_notify_breakpoint_created (b);
10383 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
10384 }
10385
10386 /* Return non-zero if EXP is verified as constant. Returned zero
10387 means EXP is variable. Also the constant detection may fail for
10388 some constant expressions and in such case still falsely return
10389 zero. */
10390
10391 static int
10392 watchpoint_exp_is_const (const struct expression *exp)
10393 {
10394 int i = exp->nelts;
10395
10396 while (i > 0)
10397 {
10398 int oplenp, argsp;
10399
10400 /* We are only interested in the descriptor of each element. */
10401 operator_length (exp, i, &oplenp, &argsp);
10402 i -= oplenp;
10403
10404 switch (exp->elts[i].opcode)
10405 {
10406 case BINOP_ADD:
10407 case BINOP_SUB:
10408 case BINOP_MUL:
10409 case BINOP_DIV:
10410 case BINOP_REM:
10411 case BINOP_MOD:
10412 case BINOP_LSH:
10413 case BINOP_RSH:
10414 case BINOP_LOGICAL_AND:
10415 case BINOP_LOGICAL_OR:
10416 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
10417 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
10418 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
10419 case BINOP_EQUAL:
10420 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
10421 case BINOP_LESS:
10422 case BINOP_GTR:
10423 case BINOP_LEQ:
10424 case BINOP_GEQ:
10425 case BINOP_REPEAT:
10426 case BINOP_COMMA:
10427 case BINOP_EXP:
10428 case BINOP_MIN:
10429 case BINOP_MAX:
10430 case BINOP_INTDIV:
10431 case BINOP_CONCAT:
10432 case TERNOP_COND:
10433 case TERNOP_SLICE:
10434
10435 case OP_LONG:
10436 case OP_DOUBLE:
10437 case OP_DECFLOAT:
10438 case OP_LAST:
10439 case OP_COMPLEX:
10440 case OP_STRING:
10441 case OP_ARRAY:
10442 case OP_TYPE:
10443 case OP_TYPEOF:
10444 case OP_DECLTYPE:
10445 case OP_TYPEID:
10446 case OP_NAME:
10447 case OP_OBJC_NSSTRING:
10448
10449 case UNOP_NEG:
10450 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
10451 case UNOP_COMPLEMENT:
10452 case UNOP_ADDR:
10453 case UNOP_HIGH:
10454 case UNOP_CAST:
10455
10456 case UNOP_CAST_TYPE:
10457 case UNOP_REINTERPRET_CAST:
10458 case UNOP_DYNAMIC_CAST:
10459 /* Unary, binary and ternary operators: We have to check
10460 their operands. If they are constant, then so is the
10461 result of that operation. For instance, if A and B are
10462 determined to be constants, then so is "A + B".
10463
10464 UNOP_IND is one exception to the rule above, because the
10465 value of *ADDR is not necessarily a constant, even when
10466 ADDR is. */
10467 break;
10468
10469 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
10470 /* Check whether the associated symbol is a constant.
10471
10472 We use SYMBOL_CLASS rather than TYPE_CONST because it's
10473 possible that a buggy compiler could mark a variable as
10474 constant even when it is not, and TYPE_CONST would return
10475 true in this case, while SYMBOL_CLASS wouldn't.
10476
10477 We also have to check for function symbols because they
10478 are always constant. */
10479 {
10480 struct symbol *s = exp->elts[i + 2].symbol;
10481
10482 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_BLOCK
10483 && SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_CONST
10484 && SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_CONST_BYTES)
10485 return 0;
10486 break;
10487 }
10488
10489 /* The default action is to return 0 because we are using
10490 the optimistic approach here: If we don't know something,
10491 then it is not a constant. */
10492 default:
10493 return 0;
10494 }
10495 }
10496
10497 return 1;
10498 }
10499
10500 /* Implement the "dtor" breakpoint_ops method for watchpoints. */
10501
10502 static void
10503 dtor_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *self)
10504 {
10505 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) self;
10506
10507 xfree (w->cond_exp);
10508 xfree (w->exp);
10509 xfree (w->exp_string);
10510 xfree (w->exp_string_reparse);
10511 value_free (w->val);
10512
10513 base_breakpoint_ops.dtor (self);
10514 }
10515
10516 /* Implement the "re_set" breakpoint_ops method for watchpoints. */
10517
10518 static void
10519 re_set_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10520 {
10521 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10522
10523 /* Watchpoint can be either on expression using entirely global
10524 variables, or it can be on local variables.
10525
10526 Watchpoints of the first kind are never auto-deleted, and even
10527 persist across program restarts. Since they can use variables
10528 from shared libraries, we need to reparse expression as libraries
10529 are loaded and unloaded.
10530
10531 Watchpoints on local variables can also change meaning as result
10532 of solib event. For example, if a watchpoint uses both a local
10533 and a global variables in expression, it's a local watchpoint,
10534 but unloading of a shared library will make the expression
10535 invalid. This is not a very common use case, but we still
10536 re-evaluate expression, to avoid surprises to the user.
10537
10538 Note that for local watchpoints, we re-evaluate it only if
10539 watchpoints frame id is still valid. If it's not, it means the
10540 watchpoint is out of scope and will be deleted soon. In fact,
10541 I'm not sure we'll ever be called in this case.
10542
10543 If a local watchpoint's frame id is still valid, then
10544 w->exp_valid_block is likewise valid, and we can safely use it.
10545
10546 Don't do anything about disabled watchpoints, since they will be
10547 reevaluated again when enabled. */
10548 update_watchpoint (w, 1 /* reparse */);
10549 }
10550
10551 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for hardware watchpoints. */
10552
10553 static int
10554 insert_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
10555 {
10556 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10557 int length = w->exact ? 1 : bl->length;
10558
10559 return target_insert_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type,
10560 w->cond_exp);
10561 }
10562
10563 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for hardware watchpoints. */
10564
10565 static int
10566 remove_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
10567 {
10568 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10569 int length = w->exact ? 1 : bl->length;
10570
10571 return target_remove_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type,
10572 w->cond_exp);
10573 }
10574
10575 static int
10576 breakpoint_hit_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl,
10577 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
10578 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
10579 {
10580 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
10581 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10582
10583 /* Continuable hardware watchpoints are treated as non-existent if the
10584 reason we stopped wasn't a hardware watchpoint (we didn't stop on
10585 some data address). Otherwise gdb won't stop on a break instruction
10586 in the code (not from a breakpoint) when a hardware watchpoint has
10587 been defined. Also skip watchpoints which we know did not trigger
10588 (did not match the data address). */
10589 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
10590 && w->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_no)
10591 return 0;
10592
10593 return 1;
10594 }
10595
10596 static void
10597 check_status_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10598 {
10599 gdb_assert (is_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at));
10600
10601 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bs);
10602 }
10603
10604 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
10605 hardware watchpoints. */
10606
10607 static int
10608 resources_needed_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
10609 {
10610 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10611 int length = w->exact? 1 : bl->length;
10612
10613 return target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (bl->address, length);
10614 }
10615
10616 /* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method for
10617 hardware watchpoints. */
10618
10619 static int
10620 works_in_software_mode_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10621 {
10622 /* Read and access watchpoints only work with hardware support. */
10623 return b->type == bp_watchpoint || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint;
10624 }
10625
10626 static enum print_stop_action
10627 print_it_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10628 {
10629 struct cleanup *old_chain;
10630 struct breakpoint *b;
10631 struct ui_file *stb;
10632 enum print_stop_action result;
10633 struct watchpoint *w;
10634 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10635
10636 gdb_assert (bs->bp_location_at != NULL);
10637
10638 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
10639 w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10640
10641 stb = mem_fileopen ();
10642 old_chain = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (stb);
10643
10644 switch (b->type)
10645 {
10646 case bp_watchpoint:
10647 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10648 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
10649 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10650 ui_out_field_string
10651 (uiout, "reason",
10652 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10653 mention (b);
10654 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
10655 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nOld value = ");
10656 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, stb);
10657 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "old", stb);
10658 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nNew value = ");
10659 watchpoint_value_print (w->val, stb);
10660 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "new", stb);
10661 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
10662 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
10663 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10664 break;
10665
10666 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10667 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10668 ui_out_field_string
10669 (uiout, "reason",
10670 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10671 mention (b);
10672 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
10673 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nValue = ");
10674 watchpoint_value_print (w->val, stb);
10675 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "value", stb);
10676 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
10677 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10678 break;
10679
10680 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10681 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
10682 {
10683 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
10684 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10685 ui_out_field_string
10686 (uiout, "reason",
10687 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10688 mention (b);
10689 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
10690 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nOld value = ");
10691 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, stb);
10692 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "old", stb);
10693 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nNew value = ");
10694 }
10695 else
10696 {
10697 mention (b);
10698 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10699 ui_out_field_string
10700 (uiout, "reason",
10701 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10702 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
10703 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nValue = ");
10704 }
10705 watchpoint_value_print (w->val, stb);
10706 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "new", stb);
10707 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
10708 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10709 break;
10710 default:
10711 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10712 }
10713
10714 do_cleanups (old_chain);
10715 return result;
10716 }
10717
10718 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for hardware
10719 watchpoints. */
10720
10721 static void
10722 print_mention_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10723 {
10724 struct cleanup *ui_out_chain;
10725 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10726 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10727
10728 switch (b->type)
10729 {
10730 case bp_watchpoint:
10731 ui_out_text (uiout, "Watchpoint ");
10732 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
10733 break;
10734 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10735 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware watchpoint ");
10736 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
10737 break;
10738 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10739 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware read watchpoint ");
10740 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-rwpt");
10741 break;
10742 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10743 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
10744 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-awpt");
10745 break;
10746 default:
10747 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10748 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10749 }
10750
10751 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
10752 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
10753 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", w->exp_string);
10754 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
10755 }
10756
10757 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
10758 watchpoints. */
10759
10760 static void
10761 print_recreate_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
10762 {
10763 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10764
10765 switch (b->type)
10766 {
10767 case bp_watchpoint:
10768 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10769 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "watch");
10770 break;
10771 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10772 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "rwatch");
10773 break;
10774 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10775 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "awatch");
10776 break;
10777 default:
10778 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10779 _("Invalid watchpoint type."));
10780 }
10781
10782 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", w->exp_string);
10783 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
10784 }
10785
10786 /* Implement the "explains_signal" breakpoint_ops method for
10787 watchpoints. */
10788
10789 static int
10790 explains_signal_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, enum gdb_signal sig)
10791 {
10792 /* A software watchpoint cannot cause a signal other than
10793 GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP. */
10794 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
10795 return 0;
10796
10797 return 1;
10798 }
10799
10800 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in hardware watchpoints. */
10801
10802 static struct breakpoint_ops watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
10803
10804 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for
10805 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10806
10807 static int
10808 insert_masked_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
10809 {
10810 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10811
10812 return target_insert_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask,
10813 bl->watchpoint_type);
10814 }
10815
10816 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for
10817 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10818
10819 static int
10820 remove_masked_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
10821 {
10822 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10823
10824 return target_remove_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask,
10825 bl->watchpoint_type);
10826 }
10827
10828 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
10829 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10830
10831 static int
10832 resources_needed_masked_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
10833 {
10834 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10835
10836 return target_masked_watch_num_registers (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask);
10837 }
10838
10839 /* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method for
10840 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10841
10842 static int
10843 works_in_software_mode_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10844 {
10845 return 0;
10846 }
10847
10848 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for
10849 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10850
10851 static enum print_stop_action
10852 print_it_masked_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10853 {
10854 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
10855 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10856
10857 /* Masked watchpoints have only one location. */
10858 gdb_assert (b->loc && b->loc->next == NULL);
10859
10860 switch (b->type)
10861 {
10862 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10863 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
10864 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10865 ui_out_field_string
10866 (uiout, "reason",
10867 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10868 break;
10869
10870 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10871 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10872 ui_out_field_string
10873 (uiout, "reason",
10874 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10875 break;
10876
10877 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10878 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10879 ui_out_field_string
10880 (uiout, "reason",
10881 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10882 break;
10883 default:
10884 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10885 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10886 }
10887
10888 mention (b);
10889 ui_out_text (uiout, _("\n\
10890 Check the underlying instruction at PC for the memory\n\
10891 address and value which triggered this watchpoint.\n"));
10892 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
10893
10894 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
10895 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10896 }
10897
10898 /* Implement the "print_one_detail" breakpoint_ops method for
10899 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10900
10901 static void
10902 print_one_detail_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b,
10903 struct ui_out *uiout)
10904 {
10905 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10906
10907 /* Masked watchpoints have only one location. */
10908 gdb_assert (b->loc && b->loc->next == NULL);
10909
10910 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tmask ");
10911 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "mask", b->loc->gdbarch, w->hw_wp_mask);
10912 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
10913 }
10914
10915 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for
10916 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10917
10918 static void
10919 print_mention_masked_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10920 {
10921 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10922 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10923 struct cleanup *ui_out_chain;
10924
10925 switch (b->type)
10926 {
10927 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10928 ui_out_text (uiout, "Masked hardware watchpoint ");
10929 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
10930 break;
10931 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10932 ui_out_text (uiout, "Masked hardware read watchpoint ");
10933 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-rwpt");
10934 break;
10935 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10936 ui_out_text (uiout, "Masked hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
10937 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-awpt");
10938 break;
10939 default:
10940 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10941 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10942 }
10943
10944 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
10945 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
10946 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", w->exp_string);
10947 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
10948 }
10949
10950 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
10951 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10952
10953 static void
10954 print_recreate_masked_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
10955 {
10956 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10957 char tmp[40];
10958
10959 switch (b->type)
10960 {
10961 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10962 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "watch");
10963 break;
10964 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10965 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "rwatch");
10966 break;
10967 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10968 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "awatch");
10969 break;
10970 default:
10971 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10972 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10973 }
10974
10975 sprintf_vma (tmp, w->hw_wp_mask);
10976 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s mask 0x%s", w->exp_string, tmp);
10977 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
10978 }
10979
10980 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in masked hardware watchpoints. */
10981
10982 static struct breakpoint_ops masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
10983
10984 /* Tell whether the given watchpoint is a masked hardware watchpoint. */
10985
10986 static int
10987 is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10988 {
10989 return b->ops == &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
10990 }
10991
10992 /* accessflag: hw_write: watch write,
10993 hw_read: watch read,
10994 hw_access: watch access (read or write) */
10995 static void
10996 watch_command_1 (const char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty,
10997 int just_location, int internal)
10998 {
10999 struct breakpoint *b, *scope_breakpoint = NULL;
11000 struct expression *exp;
11001 const struct block *exp_valid_block = NULL, *cond_exp_valid_block = NULL;
11002 struct value *val, *mark, *result;
11003 int saved_bitpos = 0, saved_bitsize = 0;
11004 struct frame_info *frame;
11005 const char *exp_start = NULL;
11006 const char *exp_end = NULL;
11007 const char *tok, *end_tok;
11008 int toklen = -1;
11009 const char *cond_start = NULL;
11010 const char *cond_end = NULL;
11011 enum bptype bp_type;
11012 int thread = -1;
11013 int pc = 0;
11014 /* Flag to indicate whether we are going to use masks for
11015 the hardware watchpoint. */
11016 int use_mask = 0;
11017 CORE_ADDR mask = 0;
11018 struct watchpoint *w;
11019 char *expression;
11020 struct cleanup *back_to;
11021
11022 /* Make sure that we actually have parameters to parse. */
11023 if (arg != NULL && arg[0] != '\0')
11024 {
11025 const char *value_start;
11026
11027 exp_end = arg + strlen (arg);
11028
11029 /* Look for "parameter value" pairs at the end
11030 of the arguments string. */
11031 for (tok = exp_end - 1; tok > arg; tok--)
11032 {
11033 /* Skip whitespace at the end of the argument list. */
11034 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
11035 tok--;
11036
11037 /* Find the beginning of the last token.
11038 This is the value of the parameter. */
11039 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
11040 tok--;
11041 value_start = tok + 1;
11042
11043 /* Skip whitespace. */
11044 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
11045 tok--;
11046
11047 end_tok = tok;
11048
11049 /* Find the beginning of the second to last token.
11050 This is the parameter itself. */
11051 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
11052 tok--;
11053 tok++;
11054 toklen = end_tok - tok + 1;
11055
11056 if (toklen == 6 && startswith (tok, "thread"))
11057 {
11058 /* At this point we've found a "thread" token, which means
11059 the user is trying to set a watchpoint that triggers
11060 only in a specific thread. */
11061 char *endp;
11062
11063 if (thread != -1)
11064 error(_("You can specify only one thread."));
11065
11066 /* Extract the thread ID from the next token. */
11067 thread = strtol (value_start, &endp, 0);
11068
11069 /* Check if the user provided a valid numeric value for the
11070 thread ID. */
11071 if (*endp != ' ' && *endp != '\t' && *endp != '\0')
11072 error (_("Invalid thread ID specification %s."), value_start);
11073
11074 /* Check if the thread actually exists. */
11075 if (!valid_thread_id (thread))
11076 invalid_thread_id_error (thread);
11077 }
11078 else if (toklen == 4 && startswith (tok, "mask"))
11079 {
11080 /* We've found a "mask" token, which means the user wants to
11081 create a hardware watchpoint that is going to have the mask
11082 facility. */
11083 struct value *mask_value, *mark;
11084
11085 if (use_mask)
11086 error(_("You can specify only one mask."));
11087
11088 use_mask = just_location = 1;
11089
11090 mark = value_mark ();
11091 mask_value = parse_to_comma_and_eval (&value_start);
11092 mask = value_as_address (mask_value);
11093 value_free_to_mark (mark);
11094 }
11095 else
11096 /* We didn't recognize what we found. We should stop here. */
11097 break;
11098
11099 /* Truncate the string and get rid of the "parameter value" pair before
11100 the arguments string is parsed by the parse_exp_1 function. */
11101 exp_end = tok;
11102 }
11103 }
11104 else
11105 exp_end = arg;
11106
11107 /* Parse the rest of the arguments. From here on out, everything
11108 is in terms of a newly allocated string instead of the original
11109 ARG. */
11110 innermost_block = NULL;
11111 expression = savestring (arg, exp_end - arg);
11112 back_to = make_cleanup (xfree, expression);
11113 exp_start = arg = expression;
11114 exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0);
11115 exp_end = arg;
11116 /* Remove trailing whitespace from the expression before saving it.
11117 This makes the eventual display of the expression string a bit
11118 prettier. */
11119 while (exp_end > exp_start && (exp_end[-1] == ' ' || exp_end[-1] == '\t'))
11120 --exp_end;
11121
11122 /* Checking if the expression is not constant. */
11123 if (watchpoint_exp_is_const (exp))
11124 {
11125 int len;
11126
11127 len = exp_end - exp_start;
11128 while (len > 0 && isspace (exp_start[len - 1]))
11129 len--;
11130 error (_("Cannot watch constant value `%.*s'."), len, exp_start);
11131 }
11132
11133 exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
11134 mark = value_mark ();
11135 fetch_subexp_value (exp, &pc, &val, &result, NULL, just_location);
11136
11137 if (val != NULL && just_location)
11138 {
11139 saved_bitpos = value_bitpos (val);
11140 saved_bitsize = value_bitsize (val);
11141 }
11142
11143 if (just_location)
11144 {
11145 int ret;
11146
11147 exp_valid_block = NULL;
11148 val = value_addr (result);
11149 release_value (val);
11150 value_free_to_mark (mark);
11151
11152 if (use_mask)
11153 {
11154 ret = target_masked_watch_num_registers (value_as_address (val),
11155 mask);
11156 if (ret == -1)
11157 error (_("This target does not support masked watchpoints."));
11158 else if (ret == -2)
11159 error (_("Invalid mask or memory region."));
11160 }
11161 }
11162 else if (val != NULL)
11163 release_value (val);
11164
11165 tok = skip_spaces_const (arg);
11166 end_tok = skip_to_space_const (tok);
11167
11168 toklen = end_tok - tok;
11169 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
11170 {
11171 struct expression *cond;
11172
11173 innermost_block = NULL;
11174 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
11175 cond = parse_exp_1 (&tok, 0, 0, 0);
11176
11177 /* The watchpoint expression may not be local, but the condition
11178 may still be. E.g.: `watch global if local > 0'. */
11179 cond_exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
11180
11181 xfree (cond);
11182 cond_end = tok;
11183 }
11184 if (*tok)
11185 error (_("Junk at end of command."));
11186
11187 frame = block_innermost_frame (exp_valid_block);
11188
11189 /* If the expression is "local", then set up a "watchpoint scope"
11190 breakpoint at the point where we've left the scope of the watchpoint
11191 expression. Create the scope breakpoint before the watchpoint, so
11192 that we will encounter it first in bpstat_stop_status. */
11193 if (exp_valid_block && frame)
11194 {
11195 if (frame_id_p (frame_unwind_caller_id (frame)))
11196 {
11197 scope_breakpoint
11198 = create_internal_breakpoint (frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame),
11199 frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame),
11200 bp_watchpoint_scope,
11201 &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
11202
11203 scope_breakpoint->enable_state = bp_enabled;
11204
11205 /* Automatically delete the breakpoint when it hits. */
11206 scope_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del;
11207
11208 /* Only break in the proper frame (help with recursion). */
11209 scope_breakpoint->frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (frame);
11210
11211 /* Set the address at which we will stop. */
11212 scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch
11213 = frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame);
11214 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address
11215 = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
11216 scope_breakpoint->loc->address
11217 = adjust_breakpoint_address (scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch,
11218 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address,
11219 scope_breakpoint->type);
11220 }
11221 }
11222
11223 /* Now set up the breakpoint. We create all watchpoints as hardware
11224 watchpoints here even if hardware watchpoints are turned off, a call
11225 to update_watchpoint later in this function will cause the type to
11226 drop back to bp_watchpoint (software watchpoint) if required. */
11227
11228 if (accessflag == hw_read)
11229 bp_type = bp_read_watchpoint;
11230 else if (accessflag == hw_access)
11231 bp_type = bp_access_watchpoint;
11232 else
11233 bp_type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
11234
11235 w = XCNEW (struct watchpoint);
11236 b = &w->base;
11237 if (use_mask)
11238 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, NULL, bp_type,
11239 &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops);
11240 else
11241 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, NULL, bp_type,
11242 &watchpoint_breakpoint_ops);
11243 b->thread = thread;
11244 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
11245 b->pspace = current_program_space;
11246 w->exp = exp;
11247 w->exp_valid_block = exp_valid_block;
11248 w->cond_exp_valid_block = cond_exp_valid_block;
11249 if (just_location)
11250 {
11251 struct type *t = value_type (val);
11252 CORE_ADDR addr = value_as_address (val);
11253 char *name;
11254
11255 t = check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (check_typedef (t)));
11256 name = type_to_string (t);
11257
11258 w->exp_string_reparse = xstrprintf ("* (%s *) %s", name,
11259 core_addr_to_string (addr));
11260 xfree (name);
11261
11262 w->exp_string = xstrprintf ("-location %.*s",
11263 (int) (exp_end - exp_start), exp_start);
11264
11265 /* The above expression is in C. */
11266 b->language = language_c;
11267 }
11268 else
11269 w->exp_string = savestring (exp_start, exp_end - exp_start);
11270
11271 if (use_mask)
11272 {
11273 w->hw_wp_mask = mask;
11274 }
11275 else
11276 {
11277 w->val = val;
11278 w->val_bitpos = saved_bitpos;
11279 w->val_bitsize = saved_bitsize;
11280 w->val_valid = 1;
11281 }
11282
11283 if (cond_start)
11284 b->cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
11285 else
11286 b->cond_string = 0;
11287
11288 if (frame)
11289 {
11290 w->watchpoint_frame = get_frame_id (frame);
11291 w->watchpoint_thread = inferior_ptid;
11292 }
11293 else
11294 {
11295 w->watchpoint_frame = null_frame_id;
11296 w->watchpoint_thread = null_ptid;
11297 }
11298
11299 if (scope_breakpoint != NULL)
11300 {
11301 /* The scope breakpoint is related to the watchpoint. We will
11302 need to act on them together. */
11303 b->related_breakpoint = scope_breakpoint;
11304 scope_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = b;
11305 }
11306
11307 if (!just_location)
11308 value_free_to_mark (mark);
11309
11310 TRY
11311 {
11312 /* Finally update the new watchpoint. This creates the locations
11313 that should be inserted. */
11314 update_watchpoint (w, 1);
11315 }
11316 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
11317 {
11318 delete_breakpoint (b);
11319 throw_exception (e);
11320 }
11321 END_CATCH
11322
11323 install_breakpoint (internal, b, 1);
11324 do_cleanups (back_to);
11325 }
11326
11327 /* Return count of debug registers needed to watch the given expression.
11328 If the watchpoint cannot be handled in hardware return zero. */
11329
11330 static int
11331 can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *v)
11332 {
11333 int found_memory_cnt = 0;
11334 struct value *head = v;
11335
11336 /* Did the user specifically forbid us to use hardware watchpoints? */
11337 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
11338 return 0;
11339
11340 /* Make sure that the value of the expression depends only upon
11341 memory contents, and values computed from them within GDB. If we
11342 find any register references or function calls, we can't use a
11343 hardware watchpoint.
11344
11345 The idea here is that evaluating an expression generates a series
11346 of values, one holding the value of every subexpression. (The
11347 expression a*b+c has five subexpressions: a, b, a*b, c, and
11348 a*b+c.) GDB's values hold almost enough information to establish
11349 the criteria given above --- they identify memory lvalues,
11350 register lvalues, computed values, etcetera. So we can evaluate
11351 the expression, and then scan the chain of values that leaves
11352 behind to decide whether we can detect any possible change to the
11353 expression's final value using only hardware watchpoints.
11354
11355 However, I don't think that the values returned by inferior
11356 function calls are special in any way. So this function may not
11357 notice that an expression involving an inferior function call
11358 can't be watched with hardware watchpoints. FIXME. */
11359 for (; v; v = value_next (v))
11360 {
11361 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory)
11362 {
11363 if (v != head && value_lazy (v))
11364 /* A lazy memory lvalue in the chain is one that GDB never
11365 needed to fetch; we either just used its address (e.g.,
11366 `a' in `a.b') or we never needed it at all (e.g., `a'
11367 in `a,b'). This doesn't apply to HEAD; if that is
11368 lazy then it was not readable, but watch it anyway. */
11369 ;
11370 else
11371 {
11372 /* Ahh, memory we actually used! Check if we can cover
11373 it with hardware watchpoints. */
11374 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
11375
11376 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked for it
11377 explicitly, never if they just happen to appear in a
11378 middle of some value chain. */
11379 if (v == head
11380 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
11381 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
11382 {
11383 CORE_ADDR vaddr = value_address (v);
11384 int len;
11385 int num_regs;
11386
11387 len = (target_exact_watchpoints
11388 && is_scalar_type_recursive (vtype))?
11389 1 : TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
11390
11391 num_regs = target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (vaddr, len);
11392 if (!num_regs)
11393 return 0;
11394 else
11395 found_memory_cnt += num_regs;
11396 }
11397 }
11398 }
11399 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) != not_lval
11400 && deprecated_value_modifiable (v) == 0)
11401 return 0; /* These are values from the history (e.g., $1). */
11402 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_register)
11403 return 0; /* Cannot watch a register with a HW watchpoint. */
11404 }
11405
11406 /* The expression itself looks suitable for using a hardware
11407 watchpoint, but give the target machine a chance to reject it. */
11408 return found_memory_cnt;
11409 }
11410
11411 void
11412 watch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
11413 {
11414 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_write, from_tty, 0, internal);
11415 }
11416
11417 /* A helper function that looks for the "-location" argument and then
11418 calls watch_command_1. */
11419
11420 static void
11421 watch_maybe_just_location (char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty)
11422 {
11423 int just_location = 0;
11424
11425 if (arg
11426 && (check_for_argument (&arg, "-location", sizeof ("-location") - 1)
11427 || check_for_argument (&arg, "-l", sizeof ("-l") - 1)))
11428 {
11429 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11430 just_location = 1;
11431 }
11432
11433 watch_command_1 (arg, accessflag, from_tty, just_location, 0);
11434 }
11435
11436 static void
11437 watch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11438 {
11439 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_write, from_tty);
11440 }
11441
11442 void
11443 rwatch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
11444 {
11445 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_read, from_tty, 0, internal);
11446 }
11447
11448 static void
11449 rwatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11450 {
11451 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_read, from_tty);
11452 }
11453
11454 void
11455 awatch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
11456 {
11457 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_access, from_tty, 0, internal);
11458 }
11459
11460 static void
11461 awatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11462 {
11463 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_access, from_tty);
11464 }
11465 \f
11466
11467 /* Helper routines for the until_command routine in infcmd.c. Here
11468 because it uses the mechanisms of breakpoints. */
11469
11470 struct until_break_command_continuation_args
11471 {
11472 struct breakpoint *breakpoint;
11473 struct breakpoint *breakpoint2;
11474 int thread_num;
11475 };
11476
11477 /* This function is called by fetch_inferior_event via the
11478 cmd_continuation pointer, to complete the until command. It takes
11479 care of cleaning up the temporary breakpoints set up by the until
11480 command. */
11481 static void
11482 until_break_command_continuation (void *arg, int err)
11483 {
11484 struct until_break_command_continuation_args *a = arg;
11485
11486 delete_breakpoint (a->breakpoint);
11487 if (a->breakpoint2)
11488 delete_breakpoint (a->breakpoint2);
11489 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (a->thread_num);
11490 }
11491
11492 void
11493 until_break_command (char *arg, int from_tty, int anywhere)
11494 {
11495 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
11496 struct symtab_and_line sal;
11497 struct frame_info *frame;
11498 struct gdbarch *frame_gdbarch;
11499 struct frame_id stack_frame_id;
11500 struct frame_id caller_frame_id;
11501 struct breakpoint *breakpoint;
11502 struct breakpoint *breakpoint2 = NULL;
11503 struct cleanup *old_chain, *cleanup;
11504 int thread;
11505 struct thread_info *tp;
11506 struct event_location *location;
11507
11508 clear_proceed_status (0);
11509
11510 /* Set a breakpoint where the user wants it and at return from
11511 this function. */
11512
11513 location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
11514 cleanup = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (location);
11515
11516 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ())
11517 sals = decode_line_1 (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE,
11518 get_last_displayed_symtab (),
11519 get_last_displayed_line ());
11520 else
11521 sals = decode_line_1 (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE,
11522 (struct symtab *) NULL, 0);
11523
11524 if (sals.nelts != 1)
11525 error (_("Couldn't get information on specified line."));
11526
11527 sal = sals.sals[0];
11528 xfree (sals.sals); /* malloc'd, so freed. */
11529
11530 if (*arg)
11531 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11532
11533 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
11534
11535 tp = inferior_thread ();
11536 thread = tp->num;
11537
11538 old_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
11539
11540 /* Note linespec handling above invalidates the frame chain.
11541 Installing a breakpoint also invalidates the frame chain (as it
11542 may need to switch threads), so do any frame handling before
11543 that. */
11544
11545 frame = get_selected_frame (NULL);
11546 frame_gdbarch = get_frame_arch (frame);
11547 stack_frame_id = get_stack_frame_id (frame);
11548 caller_frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (frame);
11549
11550 /* Keep within the current frame, or in frames called by the current
11551 one. */
11552
11553 if (frame_id_p (caller_frame_id))
11554 {
11555 struct symtab_and_line sal2;
11556
11557 sal2 = find_pc_line (frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame), 0);
11558 sal2.pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
11559 breakpoint2 = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame),
11560 sal2,
11561 caller_frame_id,
11562 bp_until);
11563 make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (breakpoint2);
11564
11565 set_longjmp_breakpoint (tp, caller_frame_id);
11566 make_cleanup (delete_longjmp_breakpoint_cleanup, &thread);
11567 }
11568
11569 /* set_momentary_breakpoint could invalidate FRAME. */
11570 frame = NULL;
11571
11572 if (anywhere)
11573 /* If the user told us to continue until a specified location,
11574 we don't specify a frame at which we need to stop. */
11575 breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_gdbarch, sal,
11576 null_frame_id, bp_until);
11577 else
11578 /* Otherwise, specify the selected frame, because we want to stop
11579 only at the very same frame. */
11580 breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_gdbarch, sal,
11581 stack_frame_id, bp_until);
11582 make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (breakpoint);
11583
11584 proceed (-1, GDB_SIGNAL_DEFAULT);
11585
11586 /* If we are running asynchronously, and proceed call above has
11587 actually managed to start the target, arrange for breakpoints to
11588 be deleted when the target stops. Otherwise, we're already
11589 stopped and delete breakpoints via cleanup chain. */
11590
11591 if (target_can_async_p () && is_running (inferior_ptid))
11592 {
11593 struct until_break_command_continuation_args *args =
11594 XNEW (struct until_break_command_continuation_args);
11595
11596 args->breakpoint = breakpoint;
11597 args->breakpoint2 = breakpoint2;
11598 args->thread_num = thread;
11599
11600 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
11601 add_continuation (inferior_thread (),
11602 until_break_command_continuation, args,
11603 xfree);
11604 }
11605 else
11606 do_cleanups (old_chain);
11607
11608 do_cleanups (cleanup);
11609 }
11610
11611 /* This function attempts to parse an optional "if <cond>" clause
11612 from the arg string. If one is not found, it returns NULL.
11613
11614 Else, it returns a pointer to the condition string. (It does not
11615 attempt to evaluate the string against a particular block.) And,
11616 it updates arg to point to the first character following the parsed
11617 if clause in the arg string. */
11618
11619 char *
11620 ep_parse_optional_if_clause (char **arg)
11621 {
11622 char *cond_string;
11623
11624 if (((*arg)[0] != 'i') || ((*arg)[1] != 'f') || !isspace ((*arg)[2]))
11625 return NULL;
11626
11627 /* Skip the "if" keyword. */
11628 (*arg) += 2;
11629
11630 /* Skip any extra leading whitespace, and record the start of the
11631 condition string. */
11632 *arg = skip_spaces (*arg);
11633 cond_string = *arg;
11634
11635 /* Assume that the condition occupies the remainder of the arg
11636 string. */
11637 (*arg) += strlen (cond_string);
11638
11639 return cond_string;
11640 }
11641
11642 /* Commands to deal with catching events, such as signals, exceptions,
11643 process start/exit, etc. */
11644
11645 typedef enum
11646 {
11647 catch_fork_temporary, catch_vfork_temporary,
11648 catch_fork_permanent, catch_vfork_permanent
11649 }
11650 catch_fork_kind;
11651
11652 static void
11653 catch_fork_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
11654 struct cmd_list_element *command)
11655 {
11656 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
11657 char *cond_string = NULL;
11658 catch_fork_kind fork_kind;
11659 int tempflag;
11660
11661 fork_kind = (catch_fork_kind) (uintptr_t) get_cmd_context (command);
11662 tempflag = (fork_kind == catch_fork_temporary
11663 || fork_kind == catch_vfork_temporary);
11664
11665 if (!arg)
11666 arg = "";
11667 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11668
11669 /* The allowed syntax is:
11670 catch [v]fork
11671 catch [v]fork if <cond>
11672
11673 First, check if there's an if clause. */
11674 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
11675
11676 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
11677 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11678
11679 /* If this target supports it, create a fork or vfork catchpoint
11680 and enable reporting of such events. */
11681 switch (fork_kind)
11682 {
11683 case catch_fork_temporary:
11684 case catch_fork_permanent:
11685 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
11686 &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops);
11687 break;
11688 case catch_vfork_temporary:
11689 case catch_vfork_permanent:
11690 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
11691 &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops);
11692 break;
11693 default:
11694 error (_("unsupported or unknown fork kind; cannot catch it"));
11695 break;
11696 }
11697 }
11698
11699 static void
11700 catch_exec_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
11701 struct cmd_list_element *command)
11702 {
11703 struct exec_catchpoint *c;
11704 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
11705 int tempflag;
11706 char *cond_string = NULL;
11707
11708 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
11709
11710 if (!arg)
11711 arg = "";
11712 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11713
11714 /* The allowed syntax is:
11715 catch exec
11716 catch exec if <cond>
11717
11718 First, check if there's an if clause. */
11719 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
11720
11721 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
11722 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11723
11724 c = XNEW (struct exec_catchpoint);
11725 init_catchpoint (&c->base, gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
11726 &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops);
11727 c->exec_pathname = NULL;
11728
11729 install_breakpoint (0, &c->base, 1);
11730 }
11731
11732 void
11733 init_ada_exception_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
11734 struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
11735 struct symtab_and_line sal,
11736 char *addr_string,
11737 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
11738 int tempflag,
11739 int enabled,
11740 int from_tty)
11741 {
11742 if (from_tty)
11743 {
11744 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
11745 if (!loc_gdbarch)
11746 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
11747
11748 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
11749 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, -1);
11750 /* FIXME: brobecker/2006-12-28: Actually, re-implement a special
11751 version for exception catchpoints, because two catchpoints
11752 used for different exception names will use the same address.
11753 In this case, a "breakpoint ... also set at..." warning is
11754 unproductive. Besides, the warning phrasing is also a bit
11755 inappropriate, we should use the word catchpoint, and tell
11756 the user what type of catchpoint it is. The above is good
11757 enough for now, though. */
11758 }
11759
11760 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bp_breakpoint, ops);
11761
11762 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
11763 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
11764 b->location = string_to_event_location (&addr_string,
11765 language_def (language_ada));
11766 b->language = language_ada;
11767 }
11768
11769 static void
11770 catch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11771 {
11772 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
11773 }
11774 \f
11775
11776 static void
11777 tcatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11778 {
11779 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
11780 }
11781
11782 /* A qsort comparison function that sorts breakpoints in order. */
11783
11784 static int
11785 compare_breakpoints (const void *a, const void *b)
11786 {
11787 const breakpoint_p *ba = a;
11788 uintptr_t ua = (uintptr_t) *ba;
11789 const breakpoint_p *bb = b;
11790 uintptr_t ub = (uintptr_t) *bb;
11791
11792 if ((*ba)->number < (*bb)->number)
11793 return -1;
11794 else if ((*ba)->number > (*bb)->number)
11795 return 1;
11796
11797 /* Now sort by address, in case we see, e..g, two breakpoints with
11798 the number 0. */
11799 if (ua < ub)
11800 return -1;
11801 return ua > ub ? 1 : 0;
11802 }
11803
11804 /* Delete breakpoints by address or line. */
11805
11806 static void
11807 clear_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11808 {
11809 struct breakpoint *b, *prev;
11810 VEC(breakpoint_p) *found = 0;
11811 int ix;
11812 int default_match;
11813 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
11814 struct symtab_and_line sal;
11815 int i;
11816 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
11817
11818 if (arg)
11819 {
11820 sals = decode_line_with_current_source (arg,
11821 (DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE
11822 | DECODE_LINE_LIST_MODE));
11823 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
11824 default_match = 0;
11825 }
11826 else
11827 {
11828 sals.sals = XNEW (struct symtab_and_line);
11829 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
11830 init_sal (&sal); /* Initialize to zeroes. */
11831
11832 /* Set sal's line, symtab, pc, and pspace to the values
11833 corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info. If the
11834 codepoint is not valid, this will set all the fields to 0. */
11835 get_last_displayed_sal (&sal);
11836 if (sal.symtab == 0)
11837 error (_("No source file specified."));
11838
11839 sals.sals[0] = sal;
11840 sals.nelts = 1;
11841
11842 default_match = 1;
11843 }
11844
11845 /* We don't call resolve_sal_pc here. That's not as bad as it
11846 seems, because all existing breakpoints typically have both
11847 file/line and pc set. So, if clear is given file/line, we can
11848 match this to existing breakpoint without obtaining pc at all.
11849
11850 We only support clearing given the address explicitly
11851 present in breakpoint table. Say, we've set breakpoint
11852 at file:line. There were several PC values for that file:line,
11853 due to optimization, all in one block.
11854
11855 We've picked one PC value. If "clear" is issued with another
11856 PC corresponding to the same file:line, the breakpoint won't
11857 be cleared. We probably can still clear the breakpoint, but
11858 since the other PC value is never presented to user, user
11859 can only find it by guessing, and it does not seem important
11860 to support that. */
11861
11862 /* For each line spec given, delete bps which correspond to it. Do
11863 it in two passes, solely to preserve the current behavior that
11864 from_tty is forced true if we delete more than one
11865 breakpoint. */
11866
11867 found = NULL;
11868 make_cleanup (VEC_cleanup (breakpoint_p), &found);
11869 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
11870 {
11871 const char *sal_fullname;
11872
11873 /* If exact pc given, clear bpts at that pc.
11874 If line given (pc == 0), clear all bpts on specified line.
11875 If defaulting, clear all bpts on default line
11876 or at default pc.
11877
11878 defaulting sal.pc != 0 tests to do
11879
11880 0 1 pc
11881 1 1 pc _and_ line
11882 0 0 line
11883 1 0 <can't happen> */
11884
11885 sal = sals.sals[i];
11886 sal_fullname = (sal.symtab == NULL
11887 ? NULL : symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab));
11888
11889 /* Find all matching breakpoints and add them to 'found'. */
11890 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
11891 {
11892 int match = 0;
11893 /* Are we going to delete b? */
11894 if (b->type != bp_none && !is_watchpoint (b))
11895 {
11896 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
11897 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
11898 {
11899 /* If the user specified file:line, don't allow a PC
11900 match. This matches historical gdb behavior. */
11901 int pc_match = (!sal.explicit_line
11902 && sal.pc
11903 && (loc->pspace == sal.pspace)
11904 && (loc->address == sal.pc)
11905 && (!section_is_overlay (loc->section)
11906 || loc->section == sal.section));
11907 int line_match = 0;
11908
11909 if ((default_match || sal.explicit_line)
11910 && loc->symtab != NULL
11911 && sal_fullname != NULL
11912 && sal.pspace == loc->pspace
11913 && loc->line_number == sal.line
11914 && filename_cmp (symtab_to_fullname (loc->symtab),
11915 sal_fullname) == 0)
11916 line_match = 1;
11917
11918 if (pc_match || line_match)
11919 {
11920 match = 1;
11921 break;
11922 }
11923 }
11924 }
11925
11926 if (match)
11927 VEC_safe_push(breakpoint_p, found, b);
11928 }
11929 }
11930
11931 /* Now go thru the 'found' chain and delete them. */
11932 if (VEC_empty(breakpoint_p, found))
11933 {
11934 if (arg)
11935 error (_("No breakpoint at %s."), arg);
11936 else
11937 error (_("No breakpoint at this line."));
11938 }
11939
11940 /* Remove duplicates from the vec. */
11941 qsort (VEC_address (breakpoint_p, found),
11942 VEC_length (breakpoint_p, found),
11943 sizeof (breakpoint_p),
11944 compare_breakpoints);
11945 prev = VEC_index (breakpoint_p, found, 0);
11946 for (ix = 1; VEC_iterate (breakpoint_p, found, ix, b); ++ix)
11947 {
11948 if (b == prev)
11949 {
11950 VEC_ordered_remove (breakpoint_p, found, ix);
11951 --ix;
11952 }
11953 }
11954
11955 if (VEC_length(breakpoint_p, found) > 1)
11956 from_tty = 1; /* Always report if deleted more than one. */
11957 if (from_tty)
11958 {
11959 if (VEC_length(breakpoint_p, found) == 1)
11960 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoint "));
11961 else
11962 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoints "));
11963 }
11964
11965 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate(breakpoint_p, found, ix, b); ix++)
11966 {
11967 if (from_tty)
11968 printf_unfiltered ("%d ", b->number);
11969 delete_breakpoint (b);
11970 }
11971 if (from_tty)
11972 putchar_unfiltered ('\n');
11973
11974 do_cleanups (cleanups);
11975 }
11976 \f
11977 /* Delete breakpoint in BS if they are `delete' breakpoints and
11978 all breakpoints that are marked for deletion, whether hit or not.
11979 This is called after any breakpoint is hit, or after errors. */
11980
11981 void
11982 breakpoint_auto_delete (bpstat bs)
11983 {
11984 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
11985
11986 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
11987 if (bs->breakpoint_at
11988 && bs->breakpoint_at->disposition == disp_del
11989 && bs->stop)
11990 delete_breakpoint (bs->breakpoint_at);
11991
11992 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
11993 {
11994 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
11995 delete_breakpoint (b);
11996 }
11997 }
11998
11999 /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP being interfaced to
12000 qsort. Sort elements primarily by their ADDRESS (no matter what
12001 does breakpoint_address_is_meaningful say for its OWNER),
12002 secondarily by ordering first permanent elements and
12003 terciarily just ensuring the array is sorted stable way despite
12004 qsort being an unstable algorithm. */
12005
12006 static int
12007 bp_location_compare (const void *ap, const void *bp)
12008 {
12009 struct bp_location *a = *(void **) ap;
12010 struct bp_location *b = *(void **) bp;
12011
12012 if (a->address != b->address)
12013 return (a->address > b->address) - (a->address < b->address);
12014
12015 /* Sort locations at the same address by their pspace number, keeping
12016 locations of the same inferior (in a multi-inferior environment)
12017 grouped. */
12018
12019 if (a->pspace->num != b->pspace->num)
12020 return ((a->pspace->num > b->pspace->num)
12021 - (a->pspace->num < b->pspace->num));
12022
12023 /* Sort permanent breakpoints first. */
12024 if (a->permanent != b->permanent)
12025 return (a->permanent < b->permanent) - (a->permanent > b->permanent);
12026
12027 /* Make the internal GDB representation stable across GDB runs
12028 where A and B memory inside GDB can differ. Breakpoint locations of
12029 the same type at the same address can be sorted in arbitrary order. */
12030
12031 if (a->owner->number != b->owner->number)
12032 return ((a->owner->number > b->owner->number)
12033 - (a->owner->number < b->owner->number));
12034
12035 return (a > b) - (a < b);
12036 }
12037
12038 /* Set bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max and
12039 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max according to the current
12040 content of the bp_location array. */
12041
12042 static void
12043 bp_location_target_extensions_update (void)
12044 {
12045 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
12046
12047 bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max = 0;
12048 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max = 0;
12049
12050 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
12051 {
12052 CORE_ADDR start, end, addr;
12053
12054 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
12055 continue;
12056
12057 start = bl->target_info.placed_address;
12058 end = start + bl->target_info.shadow_len;
12059
12060 gdb_assert (bl->address >= start);
12061 addr = bl->address - start;
12062 if (addr > bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max)
12063 bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max = addr;
12064
12065 /* Zero SHADOW_LEN would not pass bp_location_has_shadow. */
12066
12067 gdb_assert (bl->address < end);
12068 addr = end - bl->address;
12069 if (addr > bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max)
12070 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max = addr;
12071 }
12072 }
12073
12074 /* Download tracepoint locations if they haven't been. */
12075
12076 static void
12077 download_tracepoint_locations (void)
12078 {
12079 struct breakpoint *b;
12080 struct cleanup *old_chain;
12081
12082 if (!target_can_download_tracepoint ())
12083 return;
12084
12085 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
12086
12087 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
12088 {
12089 struct bp_location *bl;
12090 struct tracepoint *t;
12091 int bp_location_downloaded = 0;
12092
12093 if ((b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint
12094 ? !may_insert_fast_tracepoints
12095 : !may_insert_tracepoints))
12096 continue;
12097
12098 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
12099 {
12100 /* In tracepoint, locations are _never_ duplicated, so
12101 should_be_inserted is equivalent to
12102 unduplicated_should_be_inserted. */
12103 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || bl->inserted)
12104 continue;
12105
12106 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
12107
12108 target_download_tracepoint (bl);
12109
12110 bl->inserted = 1;
12111 bp_location_downloaded = 1;
12112 }
12113 t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
12114 t->number_on_target = b->number;
12115 if (bp_location_downloaded)
12116 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
12117 }
12118
12119 do_cleanups (old_chain);
12120 }
12121
12122 /* Swap the insertion/duplication state between two locations. */
12123
12124 static void
12125 swap_insertion (struct bp_location *left, struct bp_location *right)
12126 {
12127 const int left_inserted = left->inserted;
12128 const int left_duplicate = left->duplicate;
12129 const int left_needs_update = left->needs_update;
12130 const struct bp_target_info left_target_info = left->target_info;
12131
12132 /* Locations of tracepoints can never be duplicated. */
12133 if (is_tracepoint (left->owner))
12134 gdb_assert (!left->duplicate);
12135 if (is_tracepoint (right->owner))
12136 gdb_assert (!right->duplicate);
12137
12138 left->inserted = right->inserted;
12139 left->duplicate = right->duplicate;
12140 left->needs_update = right->needs_update;
12141 left->target_info = right->target_info;
12142 right->inserted = left_inserted;
12143 right->duplicate = left_duplicate;
12144 right->needs_update = left_needs_update;
12145 right->target_info = left_target_info;
12146 }
12147
12148 /* Force the re-insertion of the locations at ADDRESS. This is called
12149 once a new/deleted/modified duplicate location is found and we are evaluating
12150 conditions on the target's side. Such conditions need to be updated on
12151 the target. */
12152
12153 static void
12154 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (struct bp_location *bl)
12155 {
12156 struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
12157 struct bp_location *loc;
12158 CORE_ADDR address = 0;
12159 int pspace_num;
12160
12161 address = bl->address;
12162 pspace_num = bl->pspace->num;
12163
12164 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
12165 evaluating conditions and if the user has
12166 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
12167 side. */
12168 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
12169 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
12170 return;
12171
12172 /* Flag all breakpoint locations with this address and
12173 the same program space as the location
12174 as "its condition has changed". We need to
12175 update the conditions on the target's side. */
12176 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, address)
12177 {
12178 loc = *loc2p;
12179
12180 if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
12181 || pspace_num != loc->pspace->num)
12182 continue;
12183
12184 /* Flag the location appropriately. We use a different state to
12185 let everyone know that we already updated the set of locations
12186 with addr bl->address and program space bl->pspace. This is so
12187 we don't have to keep calling these functions just to mark locations
12188 that have already been marked. */
12189 loc->condition_changed = condition_updated;
12190
12191 /* Free the agent expression bytecode as well. We will compute
12192 it later on. */
12193 if (loc->cond_bytecode)
12194 {
12195 free_agent_expr (loc->cond_bytecode);
12196 loc->cond_bytecode = NULL;
12197 }
12198 }
12199 }
12200 /* Called whether new breakpoints are created, or existing breakpoints
12201 deleted, to update the global location list and recompute which
12202 locations are duplicate of which.
12203
12204 The INSERT_MODE flag determines whether locations may not, may, or
12205 shall be inserted now. See 'enum ugll_insert_mode' for more
12206 info. */
12207
12208 static void
12209 update_global_location_list (enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
12210 {
12211 struct breakpoint *b;
12212 struct bp_location **locp, *loc;
12213 struct cleanup *cleanups;
12214 /* Last breakpoint location address that was marked for update. */
12215 CORE_ADDR last_addr = 0;
12216 /* Last breakpoint location program space that was marked for update. */
12217 int last_pspace_num = -1;
12218
12219 /* Used in the duplicates detection below. When iterating over all
12220 bp_locations, points to the first bp_location of a given address.
12221 Breakpoints and watchpoints of different types are never
12222 duplicates of each other. Keep one pointer for each type of
12223 breakpoint/watchpoint, so we only need to loop over all locations
12224 once. */
12225 struct bp_location *bp_loc_first; /* breakpoint */
12226 struct bp_location *wp_loc_first; /* hardware watchpoint */
12227 struct bp_location *awp_loc_first; /* access watchpoint */
12228 struct bp_location *rwp_loc_first; /* read watchpoint */
12229
12230 /* Saved former bp_location array which we compare against the newly
12231 built bp_location from the current state of ALL_BREAKPOINTS. */
12232 struct bp_location **old_location, **old_locp;
12233 unsigned old_location_count;
12234
12235 old_location = bp_location;
12236 old_location_count = bp_location_count;
12237 bp_location = NULL;
12238 bp_location_count = 0;
12239 cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, old_location);
12240
12241 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
12242 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
12243 bp_location_count++;
12244
12245 bp_location = XNEWVEC (struct bp_location *, bp_location_count);
12246 locp = bp_location;
12247 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
12248 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
12249 *locp++ = loc;
12250 qsort (bp_location, bp_location_count, sizeof (*bp_location),
12251 bp_location_compare);
12252
12253 bp_location_target_extensions_update ();
12254
12255 /* Identify bp_location instances that are no longer present in the
12256 new list, and therefore should be freed. Note that it's not
12257 necessary that those locations should be removed from inferior --
12258 if there's another location at the same address (previously
12259 marked as duplicate), we don't need to remove/insert the
12260 location.
12261
12262 LOCP is kept in sync with OLD_LOCP, each pointing to the current
12263 and former bp_location array state respectively. */
12264
12265 locp = bp_location;
12266 for (old_locp = old_location; old_locp < old_location + old_location_count;
12267 old_locp++)
12268 {
12269 struct bp_location *old_loc = *old_locp;
12270 struct bp_location **loc2p;
12271
12272 /* Tells if 'old_loc' is found among the new locations. If
12273 not, we have to free it. */
12274 int found_object = 0;
12275 /* Tells if the location should remain inserted in the target. */
12276 int keep_in_target = 0;
12277 int removed = 0;
12278
12279 /* Skip LOCP entries which will definitely never be needed.
12280 Stop either at or being the one matching OLD_LOC. */
12281 while (locp < bp_location + bp_location_count
12282 && (*locp)->address < old_loc->address)
12283 locp++;
12284
12285 for (loc2p = locp;
12286 (loc2p < bp_location + bp_location_count
12287 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
12288 loc2p++)
12289 {
12290 /* Check if this is a new/duplicated location or a duplicated
12291 location that had its condition modified. If so, we want to send
12292 its condition to the target if evaluation of conditions is taking
12293 place there. */
12294 if ((*loc2p)->condition_changed == condition_modified
12295 && (last_addr != old_loc->address
12296 || last_pspace_num != old_loc->pspace->num))
12297 {
12298 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (*loc2p);
12299 last_pspace_num = old_loc->pspace->num;
12300 }
12301
12302 if (*loc2p == old_loc)
12303 found_object = 1;
12304 }
12305
12306 /* We have already handled this address, update it so that we don't
12307 have to go through updates again. */
12308 last_addr = old_loc->address;
12309
12310 /* Target-side condition evaluation: Handle deleted locations. */
12311 if (!found_object)
12312 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (old_loc);
12313
12314 /* If this location is no longer present, and inserted, look if
12315 there's maybe a new location at the same address. If so,
12316 mark that one inserted, and don't remove this one. This is
12317 needed so that we don't have a time window where a breakpoint
12318 at certain location is not inserted. */
12319
12320 if (old_loc->inserted)
12321 {
12322 /* If the location is inserted now, we might have to remove
12323 it. */
12324
12325 if (found_object && should_be_inserted (old_loc))
12326 {
12327 /* The location is still present in the location list,
12328 and still should be inserted. Don't do anything. */
12329 keep_in_target = 1;
12330 }
12331 else
12332 {
12333 /* This location still exists, but it won't be kept in the
12334 target since it may have been disabled. We proceed to
12335 remove its target-side condition. */
12336
12337 /* The location is either no longer present, or got
12338 disabled. See if there's another location at the
12339 same address, in which case we don't need to remove
12340 this one from the target. */
12341
12342 /* OLD_LOC comes from existing struct breakpoint. */
12343 if (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (old_loc->owner))
12344 {
12345 for (loc2p = locp;
12346 (loc2p < bp_location + bp_location_count
12347 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
12348 loc2p++)
12349 {
12350 struct bp_location *loc2 = *loc2p;
12351
12352 if (breakpoint_locations_match (loc2, old_loc))
12353 {
12354 /* Read watchpoint locations are switched to
12355 access watchpoints, if the former are not
12356 supported, but the latter are. */
12357 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner))
12358 {
12359 gdb_assert (is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner));
12360 loc2->watchpoint_type = old_loc->watchpoint_type;
12361 }
12362
12363 /* loc2 is a duplicated location. We need to check
12364 if it should be inserted in case it will be
12365 unduplicated. */
12366 if (loc2 != old_loc
12367 && unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc2))
12368 {
12369 swap_insertion (old_loc, loc2);
12370 keep_in_target = 1;
12371 break;
12372 }
12373 }
12374 }
12375 }
12376 }
12377
12378 if (!keep_in_target)
12379 {
12380 if (remove_breakpoint (old_loc, mark_uninserted))
12381 {
12382 /* This is just about all we can do. We could keep
12383 this location on the global list, and try to
12384 remove it next time, but there's no particular
12385 reason why we will succeed next time.
12386
12387 Note that at this point, old_loc->owner is still
12388 valid, as delete_breakpoint frees the breakpoint
12389 only after calling us. */
12390 printf_filtered (_("warning: Error removing "
12391 "breakpoint %d\n"),
12392 old_loc->owner->number);
12393 }
12394 removed = 1;
12395 }
12396 }
12397
12398 if (!found_object)
12399 {
12400 if (removed && target_is_non_stop_p ()
12401 && need_moribund_for_location_type (old_loc))
12402 {
12403 /* This location was removed from the target. In
12404 non-stop mode, a race condition is possible where
12405 we've removed a breakpoint, but stop events for that
12406 breakpoint are already queued and will arrive later.
12407 We apply an heuristic to be able to distinguish such
12408 SIGTRAPs from other random SIGTRAPs: we keep this
12409 breakpoint location for a bit, and will retire it
12410 after we see some number of events. The theory here
12411 is that reporting of events should, "on the average",
12412 be fair, so after a while we'll see events from all
12413 threads that have anything of interest, and no longer
12414 need to keep this breakpoint location around. We
12415 don't hold locations forever so to reduce chances of
12416 mistaking a non-breakpoint SIGTRAP for a breakpoint
12417 SIGTRAP.
12418
12419 The heuristic failing can be disastrous on
12420 decr_pc_after_break targets.
12421
12422 On decr_pc_after_break targets, like e.g., x86-linux,
12423 if we fail to recognize a late breakpoint SIGTRAP,
12424 because events_till_retirement has reached 0 too
12425 soon, we'll fail to do the PC adjustment, and report
12426 a random SIGTRAP to the user. When the user resumes
12427 the inferior, it will most likely immediately crash
12428 with SIGILL/SIGBUS/SIGSEGV, or worse, get silently
12429 corrupted, because of being resumed e.g., in the
12430 middle of a multi-byte instruction, or skipped a
12431 one-byte instruction. This was actually seen happen
12432 on native x86-linux, and should be less rare on
12433 targets that do not support new thread events, like
12434 remote, due to the heuristic depending on
12435 thread_count.
12436
12437 Mistaking a random SIGTRAP for a breakpoint trap
12438 causes similar symptoms (PC adjustment applied when
12439 it shouldn't), but then again, playing with SIGTRAPs
12440 behind the debugger's back is asking for trouble.
12441
12442 Since hardware watchpoint traps are always
12443 distinguishable from other traps, so we don't need to
12444 apply keep hardware watchpoint moribund locations
12445 around. We simply always ignore hardware watchpoint
12446 traps we can no longer explain. */
12447
12448 old_loc->events_till_retirement = 3 * (thread_count () + 1);
12449 old_loc->owner = NULL;
12450
12451 VEC_safe_push (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, old_loc);
12452 }
12453 else
12454 {
12455 old_loc->owner = NULL;
12456 decref_bp_location (&old_loc);
12457 }
12458 }
12459 }
12460
12461 /* Rescan breakpoints at the same address and section, marking the
12462 first one as "first" and any others as "duplicates". This is so
12463 that the bpt instruction is only inserted once. If we have a
12464 permanent breakpoint at the same place as BPT, make that one the
12465 official one, and the rest as duplicates. Permanent breakpoints
12466 are sorted first for the same address.
12467
12468 Do the same for hardware watchpoints, but also considering the
12469 watchpoint's type (regular/access/read) and length. */
12470
12471 bp_loc_first = NULL;
12472 wp_loc_first = NULL;
12473 awp_loc_first = NULL;
12474 rwp_loc_first = NULL;
12475 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp)
12476 {
12477 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always
12478 non-NULL. */
12479 struct bp_location **loc_first_p;
12480 b = loc->owner;
12481
12482 if (!unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc)
12483 || !breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (b)
12484 /* Don't detect duplicate for tracepoint locations because they are
12485 never duplicated. See the comments in field `duplicate' of
12486 `struct bp_location'. */
12487 || is_tracepoint (b))
12488 {
12489 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12490 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
12491 continue;
12492 }
12493
12494 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
12495 loc_first_p = &wp_loc_first;
12496 else if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
12497 loc_first_p = &rwp_loc_first;
12498 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
12499 loc_first_p = &awp_loc_first;
12500 else
12501 loc_first_p = &bp_loc_first;
12502
12503 if (*loc_first_p == NULL
12504 || (overlay_debugging && loc->section != (*loc_first_p)->section)
12505 || !breakpoint_locations_match (loc, *loc_first_p))
12506 {
12507 *loc_first_p = loc;
12508 loc->duplicate = 0;
12509
12510 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->condition_changed)
12511 {
12512 loc->needs_update = 1;
12513 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12514 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
12515 }
12516 continue;
12517 }
12518
12519
12520 /* This and the above ensure the invariant that the first location
12521 is not duplicated, and is the inserted one.
12522 All following are marked as duplicated, and are not inserted. */
12523 if (loc->inserted)
12524 swap_insertion (loc, *loc_first_p);
12525 loc->duplicate = 1;
12526
12527 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12528 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
12529 }
12530
12531 if (insert_mode == UGLL_INSERT || breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now ())
12532 {
12533 if (insert_mode != UGLL_DONT_INSERT)
12534 insert_breakpoint_locations ();
12535 else
12536 {
12537 /* Even though the caller told us to not insert new
12538 locations, we may still need to update conditions on the
12539 target's side of breakpoints that were already inserted
12540 if the target is evaluating breakpoint conditions. We
12541 only update conditions for locations that are marked
12542 "needs_update". */
12543 update_inserted_breakpoint_locations ();
12544 }
12545 }
12546
12547 if (insert_mode != UGLL_DONT_INSERT)
12548 download_tracepoint_locations ();
12549
12550 do_cleanups (cleanups);
12551 }
12552
12553 void
12554 breakpoint_retire_moribund (void)
12555 {
12556 struct bp_location *loc;
12557 int ix;
12558
12559 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
12560 if (--(loc->events_till_retirement) == 0)
12561 {
12562 decref_bp_location (&loc);
12563 VEC_unordered_remove (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix);
12564 --ix;
12565 }
12566 }
12567
12568 static void
12569 update_global_location_list_nothrow (enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
12570 {
12571
12572 TRY
12573 {
12574 update_global_location_list (insert_mode);
12575 }
12576 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
12577 {
12578 }
12579 END_CATCH
12580 }
12581
12582 /* Clear BKP from a BPS. */
12583
12584 static void
12585 bpstat_remove_bp_location (bpstat bps, struct breakpoint *bpt)
12586 {
12587 bpstat bs;
12588
12589 for (bs = bps; bs; bs = bs->next)
12590 if (bs->breakpoint_at == bpt)
12591 {
12592 bs->breakpoint_at = NULL;
12593 bs->old_val = NULL;
12594 /* bs->commands will be freed later. */
12595 }
12596 }
12597
12598 /* Callback for iterate_over_threads. */
12599 static int
12600 bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback (struct thread_info *th, void *data)
12601 {
12602 struct breakpoint *bpt = data;
12603
12604 bpstat_remove_bp_location (th->control.stop_bpstat, bpt);
12605 return 0;
12606 }
12607
12608 /* Helper for breakpoint and tracepoint breakpoint_ops->mention
12609 callbacks. */
12610
12611 static void
12612 say_where (struct breakpoint *b)
12613 {
12614 struct value_print_options opts;
12615
12616 get_user_print_options (&opts);
12617
12618 /* i18n: cagney/2005-02-11: Below needs to be merged into a
12619 single string. */
12620 if (b->loc == NULL)
12621 {
12622 /* For pending locations, the output differs slightly based
12623 on b->extra_string. If this is non-NULL, it contains either
12624 a condition or dprintf arguments. */
12625 if (b->extra_string == NULL)
12626 {
12627 printf_filtered (_(" (%s) pending."),
12628 event_location_to_string (b->location));
12629 }
12630 else if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
12631 {
12632 printf_filtered (_(" (%s,%s) pending."),
12633 event_location_to_string (b->location),
12634 b->extra_string);
12635 }
12636 else
12637 {
12638 printf_filtered (_(" (%s %s) pending."),
12639 event_location_to_string (b->location),
12640 b->extra_string);
12641 }
12642 }
12643 else
12644 {
12645 if (opts.addressprint || b->loc->symtab == NULL)
12646 {
12647 printf_filtered (" at ");
12648 fputs_filtered (paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address),
12649 gdb_stdout);
12650 }
12651 if (b->loc->symtab != NULL)
12652 {
12653 /* If there is a single location, we can print the location
12654 more nicely. */
12655 if (b->loc->next == NULL)
12656 printf_filtered (": file %s, line %d.",
12657 symtab_to_filename_for_display (b->loc->symtab),
12658 b->loc->line_number);
12659 else
12660 /* This is not ideal, but each location may have a
12661 different file name, and this at least reflects the
12662 real situation somewhat. */
12663 printf_filtered (": %s.",
12664 event_location_to_string (b->location));
12665 }
12666
12667 if (b->loc->next)
12668 {
12669 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
12670 int n = 0;
12671 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
12672 ++n;
12673 printf_filtered (" (%d locations)", n);
12674 }
12675 }
12676 }
12677
12678 /* Default bp_location_ops methods. */
12679
12680 static void
12681 bp_location_dtor (struct bp_location *self)
12682 {
12683 xfree (self->cond);
12684 if (self->cond_bytecode)
12685 free_agent_expr (self->cond_bytecode);
12686 xfree (self->function_name);
12687
12688 VEC_free (agent_expr_p, self->target_info.conditions);
12689 VEC_free (agent_expr_p, self->target_info.tcommands);
12690 }
12691
12692 static const struct bp_location_ops bp_location_ops =
12693 {
12694 bp_location_dtor
12695 };
12696
12697 /* Default breakpoint_ops methods all breakpoint_ops ultimately
12698 inherit from. */
12699
12700 static void
12701 base_breakpoint_dtor (struct breakpoint *self)
12702 {
12703 decref_counted_command_line (&self->commands);
12704 xfree (self->cond_string);
12705 xfree (self->extra_string);
12706 xfree (self->filter);
12707 delete_event_location (self->location);
12708 delete_event_location (self->location_range_end);
12709 }
12710
12711 static struct bp_location *
12712 base_breakpoint_allocate_location (struct breakpoint *self)
12713 {
12714 struct bp_location *loc;
12715
12716 loc = XNEW (struct bp_location);
12717 init_bp_location (loc, &bp_location_ops, self);
12718 return loc;
12719 }
12720
12721 static void
12722 base_breakpoint_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12723 {
12724 /* Nothing to re-set. */
12725 }
12726
12727 #define internal_error_pure_virtual_called() \
12728 gdb_assert_not_reached ("pure virtual function called")
12729
12730 static int
12731 base_breakpoint_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12732 {
12733 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12734 }
12735
12736 static int
12737 base_breakpoint_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12738 {
12739 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12740 }
12741
12742 static int
12743 base_breakpoint_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12744 struct address_space *aspace,
12745 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12746 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12747 {
12748 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12749 }
12750
12751 static void
12752 base_breakpoint_check_status (bpstat bs)
12753 {
12754 /* Always stop. */
12755 }
12756
12757 /* A "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method that just internal
12758 errors. */
12759
12760 static int
12761 base_breakpoint_works_in_software_mode (const struct breakpoint *b)
12762 {
12763 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12764 }
12765
12766 /* A "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method that just internal
12767 errors. */
12768
12769 static int
12770 base_breakpoint_resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl)
12771 {
12772 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12773 }
12774
12775 static enum print_stop_action
12776 base_breakpoint_print_it (bpstat bs)
12777 {
12778 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12779 }
12780
12781 static void
12782 base_breakpoint_print_one_detail (const struct breakpoint *self,
12783 struct ui_out *uiout)
12784 {
12785 /* nothing */
12786 }
12787
12788 static void
12789 base_breakpoint_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12790 {
12791 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12792 }
12793
12794 static void
12795 base_breakpoint_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
12796 {
12797 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12798 }
12799
12800 static void
12801 base_breakpoint_create_sals_from_location
12802 (const struct event_location *location,
12803 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12804 enum bptype type_wanted)
12805 {
12806 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12807 }
12808
12809 static void
12810 base_breakpoint_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12811 struct linespec_result *c,
12812 char *cond_string,
12813 char *extra_string,
12814 enum bptype type_wanted,
12815 enum bpdisp disposition,
12816 int thread,
12817 int task, int ignore_count,
12818 const struct breakpoint_ops *o,
12819 int from_tty, int enabled,
12820 int internal, unsigned flags)
12821 {
12822 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12823 }
12824
12825 static void
12826 base_breakpoint_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12827 const struct event_location *location,
12828 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
12829 {
12830 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12831 }
12832
12833 /* The default 'explains_signal' method. */
12834
12835 static int
12836 base_breakpoint_explains_signal (struct breakpoint *b, enum gdb_signal sig)
12837 {
12838 return 1;
12839 }
12840
12841 /* The default "after_condition_true" method. */
12842
12843 static void
12844 base_breakpoint_after_condition_true (struct bpstats *bs)
12845 {
12846 /* Nothing to do. */
12847 }
12848
12849 struct breakpoint_ops base_breakpoint_ops =
12850 {
12851 base_breakpoint_dtor,
12852 base_breakpoint_allocate_location,
12853 base_breakpoint_re_set,
12854 base_breakpoint_insert_location,
12855 base_breakpoint_remove_location,
12856 base_breakpoint_breakpoint_hit,
12857 base_breakpoint_check_status,
12858 base_breakpoint_resources_needed,
12859 base_breakpoint_works_in_software_mode,
12860 base_breakpoint_print_it,
12861 NULL,
12862 base_breakpoint_print_one_detail,
12863 base_breakpoint_print_mention,
12864 base_breakpoint_print_recreate,
12865 base_breakpoint_create_sals_from_location,
12866 base_breakpoint_create_breakpoints_sal,
12867 base_breakpoint_decode_location,
12868 base_breakpoint_explains_signal,
12869 base_breakpoint_after_condition_true,
12870 };
12871
12872 /* Default breakpoint_ops methods. */
12873
12874 static void
12875 bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12876 {
12877 /* FIXME: is this still reachable? */
12878 if (event_location_empty_p (b->location))
12879 {
12880 /* Anything without a location can't be re-set. */
12881 delete_breakpoint (b);
12882 return;
12883 }
12884
12885 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
12886 }
12887
12888 static int
12889 bkpt_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12890 {
12891 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
12892 return target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
12893 else
12894 return target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
12895 }
12896
12897 static int
12898 bkpt_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12899 {
12900 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
12901 return target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
12902 else
12903 return target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
12904 }
12905
12906 static int
12907 bkpt_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12908 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12909 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12910 {
12911 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED
12912 || ws->value.sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
12913 return 0;
12914
12915 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
12916 aspace, bp_addr))
12917 return 0;
12918
12919 if (overlay_debugging /* unmapped overlay section */
12920 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
12921 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
12922 return 0;
12923
12924 return 1;
12925 }
12926
12927 static int
12928 dprintf_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12929 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12930 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12931 {
12932 if (dprintf_style == dprintf_style_agent
12933 && target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
12934 {
12935 /* An agent-style dprintf never causes a stop. If we see a trap
12936 for this address it must be for a breakpoint that happens to
12937 be set at the same address. */
12938 return 0;
12939 }
12940
12941 return bkpt_breakpoint_hit (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws);
12942 }
12943
12944 static int
12945 bkpt_resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl)
12946 {
12947 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
12948
12949 return 1;
12950 }
12951
12952 static enum print_stop_action
12953 bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
12954 {
12955 struct breakpoint *b;
12956 const struct bp_location *bl;
12957 int bp_temp;
12958 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
12959
12960 gdb_assert (bs->bp_location_at != NULL);
12961
12962 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
12963 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
12964
12965 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
12966 if (bl->address != bl->requested_address)
12967 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bl->requested_address,
12968 bl->address,
12969 b->number, 1);
12970 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
12971 if (bp_temp)
12972 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary breakpoint ");
12973 else
12974 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nBreakpoint ");
12975 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
12976 {
12977 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
12978 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
12979 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
12980 }
12981 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
12982 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
12983
12984 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
12985 }
12986
12987 static void
12988 bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12989 {
12990 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (current_uiout))
12991 return;
12992
12993 switch (b->type)
12994 {
12995 case bp_breakpoint:
12996 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
12997 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
12998 printf_filtered (_("Temporary breakpoint"));
12999 else
13000 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint"));
13001 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
13002 if (b->type == bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver)
13003 printf_filtered (_(" at gnu-indirect-function resolver"));
13004 break;
13005 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
13006 printf_filtered (_("Hardware assisted breakpoint %d"), b->number);
13007 break;
13008 case bp_dprintf:
13009 printf_filtered (_("Dprintf %d"), b->number);
13010 break;
13011 }
13012
13013 say_where (b);
13014 }
13015
13016 static void
13017 bkpt_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *tp, struct ui_file *fp)
13018 {
13019 if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint && tp->disposition == disp_del)
13020 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "tbreak");
13021 else if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint)
13022 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "break");
13023 else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
13024 && tp->disposition == disp_del)
13025 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "thbreak");
13026 else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
13027 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "hbreak");
13028 else
13029 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
13030 _("unhandled breakpoint type %d"), (int) tp->type);
13031
13032 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s",
13033 event_location_to_string (tp->location));
13034
13035 /* Print out extra_string if this breakpoint is pending. It might
13036 contain, for example, conditions that were set by the user. */
13037 if (tp->loc == NULL && tp->extra_string != NULL)
13038 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", tp->extra_string);
13039
13040 print_recreate_thread (tp, fp);
13041 }
13042
13043 static void
13044 bkpt_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
13045 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13046 enum bptype type_wanted)
13047 {
13048 create_sals_from_location_default (location, canonical, type_wanted);
13049 }
13050
13051 static void
13052 bkpt_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13053 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13054 char *cond_string,
13055 char *extra_string,
13056 enum bptype type_wanted,
13057 enum bpdisp disposition,
13058 int thread,
13059 int task, int ignore_count,
13060 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
13061 int from_tty, int enabled,
13062 int internal, unsigned flags)
13063 {
13064 create_breakpoints_sal_default (gdbarch, canonical,
13065 cond_string, extra_string,
13066 type_wanted,
13067 disposition, thread, task,
13068 ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
13069 enabled, internal, flags);
13070 }
13071
13072 static void
13073 bkpt_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
13074 const struct event_location *location,
13075 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
13076 {
13077 decode_location_default (b, location, sals);
13078 }
13079
13080 /* Virtual table for internal breakpoints. */
13081
13082 static void
13083 internal_bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
13084 {
13085 switch (b->type)
13086 {
13087 /* Delete overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints; they
13088 will be reset later by breakpoint_re_set. */
13089 case bp_overlay_event:
13090 case bp_longjmp_master:
13091 case bp_std_terminate_master:
13092 case bp_exception_master:
13093 delete_breakpoint (b);
13094 break;
13095
13096 /* This breakpoint is special, it's set up when the inferior
13097 starts and we really don't want to touch it. */
13098 case bp_shlib_event:
13099
13100 /* Like bp_shlib_event, this breakpoint type is special. Once
13101 it is set up, we do not want to touch it. */
13102 case bp_thread_event:
13103 break;
13104 }
13105 }
13106
13107 static void
13108 internal_bkpt_check_status (bpstat bs)
13109 {
13110 if (bs->breakpoint_at->type == bp_shlib_event)
13111 {
13112 /* If requested, stop when the dynamic linker notifies GDB of
13113 events. This allows the user to get control and place
13114 breakpoints in initializer routines for dynamically loaded
13115 objects (among other things). */
13116 bs->stop = stop_on_solib_events;
13117 bs->print = stop_on_solib_events;
13118 }
13119 else
13120 bs->stop = 0;
13121 }
13122
13123 static enum print_stop_action
13124 internal_bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
13125 {
13126 struct breakpoint *b;
13127
13128 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
13129
13130 switch (b->type)
13131 {
13132 case bp_shlib_event:
13133 /* Did we stop because the user set the stop_on_solib_events
13134 variable? (If so, we report this as a generic, "Stopped due
13135 to shlib event" message.) */
13136 print_solib_event (0);
13137 break;
13138
13139 case bp_thread_event:
13140 /* Not sure how we will get here.
13141 GDB should not stop for these breakpoints. */
13142 printf_filtered (_("Thread Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
13143 break;
13144
13145 case bp_overlay_event:
13146 /* By analogy with the thread event, GDB should not stop for these. */
13147 printf_filtered (_("Overlay Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
13148 break;
13149
13150 case bp_longjmp_master:
13151 /* These should never be enabled. */
13152 printf_filtered (_("Longjmp Master Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
13153 break;
13154
13155 case bp_std_terminate_master:
13156 /* These should never be enabled. */
13157 printf_filtered (_("std::terminate Master Breakpoint: "
13158 "gdb should not stop!\n"));
13159 break;
13160
13161 case bp_exception_master:
13162 /* These should never be enabled. */
13163 printf_filtered (_("Exception Master Breakpoint: "
13164 "gdb should not stop!\n"));
13165 break;
13166 }
13167
13168 return PRINT_NOTHING;
13169 }
13170
13171 static void
13172 internal_bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
13173 {
13174 /* Nothing to mention. These breakpoints are internal. */
13175 }
13176
13177 /* Virtual table for momentary breakpoints */
13178
13179 static void
13180 momentary_bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
13181 {
13182 /* Keep temporary breakpoints, which can be encountered when we step
13183 over a dlopen call and solib_add is resetting the breakpoints.
13184 Otherwise these should have been blown away via the cleanup chain
13185 or by breakpoint_init_inferior when we rerun the executable. */
13186 }
13187
13188 static void
13189 momentary_bkpt_check_status (bpstat bs)
13190 {
13191 /* Nothing. The point of these breakpoints is causing a stop. */
13192 }
13193
13194 static enum print_stop_action
13195 momentary_bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
13196 {
13197 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
13198
13199 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
13200 {
13201 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
13202
13203 switch (b->type)
13204 {
13205 case bp_finish:
13206 ui_out_field_string
13207 (uiout, "reason",
13208 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_FUNCTION_FINISHED));
13209 break;
13210
13211 case bp_until:
13212 ui_out_field_string
13213 (uiout, "reason",
13214 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_LOCATION_REACHED));
13215 break;
13216 }
13217 }
13218
13219 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
13220 }
13221
13222 static void
13223 momentary_bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
13224 {
13225 /* Nothing to mention. These breakpoints are internal. */
13226 }
13227
13228 /* Ensure INITIATING_FRAME is cleared when no such breakpoint exists.
13229
13230 It gets cleared already on the removal of the first one of such placed
13231 breakpoints. This is OK as they get all removed altogether. */
13232
13233 static void
13234 longjmp_bkpt_dtor (struct breakpoint *self)
13235 {
13236 struct thread_info *tp = find_thread_id (self->thread);
13237
13238 if (tp)
13239 tp->initiating_frame = null_frame_id;
13240
13241 momentary_breakpoint_ops.dtor (self);
13242 }
13243
13244 /* Specific methods for probe breakpoints. */
13245
13246 static int
13247 bkpt_probe_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
13248 {
13249 int v = bkpt_insert_location (bl);
13250
13251 if (v == 0)
13252 {
13253 /* The insertion was successful, now let's set the probe's semaphore
13254 if needed. */
13255 if (bl->probe.probe->pops->set_semaphore != NULL)
13256 bl->probe.probe->pops->set_semaphore (bl->probe.probe,
13257 bl->probe.objfile,
13258 bl->gdbarch);
13259 }
13260
13261 return v;
13262 }
13263
13264 static int
13265 bkpt_probe_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl)
13266 {
13267 /* Let's clear the semaphore before removing the location. */
13268 if (bl->probe.probe->pops->clear_semaphore != NULL)
13269 bl->probe.probe->pops->clear_semaphore (bl->probe.probe,
13270 bl->probe.objfile,
13271 bl->gdbarch);
13272
13273 return bkpt_remove_location (bl);
13274 }
13275
13276 static void
13277 bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
13278 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13279 enum bptype type_wanted)
13280 {
13281 struct linespec_sals lsal;
13282
13283 lsal.sals = parse_probes (location, canonical);
13284 lsal.canonical = xstrdup (event_location_to_string (canonical->location));
13285 VEC_safe_push (linespec_sals, canonical->sals, &lsal);
13286 }
13287
13288 static void
13289 bkpt_probe_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
13290 const struct event_location *location,
13291 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
13292 {
13293 *sals = parse_probes (location, NULL);
13294 if (!sals->sals)
13295 error (_("probe not found"));
13296 }
13297
13298 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in tracepoints. */
13299
13300 static void
13301 tracepoint_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
13302 {
13303 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
13304 }
13305
13306 static int
13307 tracepoint_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
13308 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
13309 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
13310 {
13311 /* By definition, the inferior does not report stops at
13312 tracepoints. */
13313 return 0;
13314 }
13315
13316 static void
13317 tracepoint_print_one_detail (const struct breakpoint *self,
13318 struct ui_out *uiout)
13319 {
13320 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) self;
13321 if (tp->static_trace_marker_id)
13322 {
13323 gdb_assert (self->type == bp_static_tracepoint);
13324
13325 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tmarker id is ");
13326 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "static-tracepoint-marker-string-id",
13327 tp->static_trace_marker_id);
13328 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
13329 }
13330 }
13331
13332 static void
13333 tracepoint_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
13334 {
13335 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (current_uiout))
13336 return;
13337
13338 switch (b->type)
13339 {
13340 case bp_tracepoint:
13341 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint"));
13342 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
13343 break;
13344 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
13345 printf_filtered (_("Fast tracepoint"));
13346 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
13347 break;
13348 case bp_static_tracepoint:
13349 printf_filtered (_("Static tracepoint"));
13350 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
13351 break;
13352 default:
13353 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
13354 _("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) b->type);
13355 }
13356
13357 say_where (b);
13358 }
13359
13360 static void
13361 tracepoint_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *self, struct ui_file *fp)
13362 {
13363 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) self;
13364
13365 if (self->type == bp_fast_tracepoint)
13366 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "ftrace");
13367 if (self->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
13368 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "strace");
13369 else if (self->type == bp_tracepoint)
13370 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "trace");
13371 else
13372 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
13373 _("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) self->type);
13374
13375 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s",
13376 event_location_to_string (self->location));
13377 print_recreate_thread (self, fp);
13378
13379 if (tp->pass_count)
13380 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " passcount %d\n", tp->pass_count);
13381 }
13382
13383 static void
13384 tracepoint_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
13385 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13386 enum bptype type_wanted)
13387 {
13388 create_sals_from_location_default (location, canonical, type_wanted);
13389 }
13390
13391 static void
13392 tracepoint_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13393 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13394 char *cond_string,
13395 char *extra_string,
13396 enum bptype type_wanted,
13397 enum bpdisp disposition,
13398 int thread,
13399 int task, int ignore_count,
13400 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
13401 int from_tty, int enabled,
13402 int internal, unsigned flags)
13403 {
13404 create_breakpoints_sal_default (gdbarch, canonical,
13405 cond_string, extra_string,
13406 type_wanted,
13407 disposition, thread, task,
13408 ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
13409 enabled, internal, flags);
13410 }
13411
13412 static void
13413 tracepoint_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
13414 const struct event_location *location,
13415 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
13416 {
13417 decode_location_default (b, location, sals);
13418 }
13419
13420 struct breakpoint_ops tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
13421
13422 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be use on tracepoints placed in a
13423 static probe. */
13424
13425 static void
13426 tracepoint_probe_create_sals_from_location
13427 (const struct event_location *location,
13428 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13429 enum bptype type_wanted)
13430 {
13431 /* We use the same method for breakpoint on probes. */
13432 bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location (location, canonical, type_wanted);
13433 }
13434
13435 static void
13436 tracepoint_probe_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
13437 const struct event_location *location,
13438 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
13439 {
13440 /* We use the same method for breakpoint on probes. */
13441 bkpt_probe_decode_location (b, location, sals);
13442 }
13443
13444 static struct breakpoint_ops tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
13445
13446 /* Dprintf breakpoint_ops methods. */
13447
13448 static void
13449 dprintf_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
13450 {
13451 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
13452
13453 /* extra_string should never be non-NULL for dprintf. */
13454 gdb_assert (b->extra_string != NULL);
13455
13456 /* 1 - connect to target 1, that can run breakpoint commands.
13457 2 - create a dprintf, which resolves fine.
13458 3 - disconnect from target 1
13459 4 - connect to target 2, that can NOT run breakpoint commands.
13460
13461 After steps #3/#4, you'll want the dprintf command list to
13462 be updated, because target 1 and 2 may well return different
13463 answers for target_can_run_breakpoint_commands().
13464 Given absence of finer grained resetting, we get to do
13465 it all the time. */
13466 if (b->extra_string != NULL)
13467 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
13468 }
13469
13470 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for dprintf. */
13471
13472 static void
13473 dprintf_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *tp, struct ui_file *fp)
13474 {
13475 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "dprintf %s,%s",
13476 event_location_to_string (tp->location),
13477 tp->extra_string);
13478 print_recreate_thread (tp, fp);
13479 }
13480
13481 /* Implement the "after_condition_true" breakpoint_ops method for
13482 dprintf.
13483
13484 dprintf's are implemented with regular commands in their command
13485 list, but we run the commands here instead of before presenting the
13486 stop to the user, as dprintf's don't actually cause a stop. This
13487 also makes it so that the commands of multiple dprintfs at the same
13488 address are all handled. */
13489
13490 static void
13491 dprintf_after_condition_true (struct bpstats *bs)
13492 {
13493 struct cleanup *old_chain;
13494 struct bpstats tmp_bs = { NULL };
13495 struct bpstats *tmp_bs_p = &tmp_bs;
13496
13497 /* dprintf's never cause a stop. This wasn't set in the
13498 check_status hook instead because that would make the dprintf's
13499 condition not be evaluated. */
13500 bs->stop = 0;
13501
13502 /* Run the command list here. Take ownership of it instead of
13503 copying. We never want these commands to run later in
13504 bpstat_do_actions, if a breakpoint that causes a stop happens to
13505 be set at same address as this dprintf, or even if running the
13506 commands here throws. */
13507 tmp_bs.commands = bs->commands;
13508 bs->commands = NULL;
13509 old_chain = make_cleanup_decref_counted_command_line (&tmp_bs.commands);
13510
13511 bpstat_do_actions_1 (&tmp_bs_p);
13512
13513 /* 'tmp_bs.commands' will usually be NULL by now, but
13514 bpstat_do_actions_1 may return early without processing the whole
13515 list. */
13516 do_cleanups (old_chain);
13517 }
13518
13519 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used on static tracepoints with
13520 markers (`-m'). */
13521
13522 static void
13523 strace_marker_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
13524 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13525 enum bptype type_wanted)
13526 {
13527 struct linespec_sals lsal;
13528 const char *arg_start, *arg;
13529 char *str;
13530 struct cleanup *cleanup;
13531
13532 arg = arg_start = get_linespec_location (location);
13533 lsal.sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&arg);
13534
13535 str = savestring (arg_start, arg - arg_start);
13536 cleanup = make_cleanup (xfree, str);
13537 canonical->location = new_linespec_location (&str);
13538 do_cleanups (cleanup);
13539
13540 lsal.canonical = xstrdup (event_location_to_string (canonical->location));
13541 VEC_safe_push (linespec_sals, canonical->sals, &lsal);
13542 }
13543
13544 static void
13545 strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13546 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13547 char *cond_string,
13548 char *extra_string,
13549 enum bptype type_wanted,
13550 enum bpdisp disposition,
13551 int thread,
13552 int task, int ignore_count,
13553 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
13554 int from_tty, int enabled,
13555 int internal, unsigned flags)
13556 {
13557 int i;
13558 struct linespec_sals *lsal = VEC_index (linespec_sals,
13559 canonical->sals, 0);
13560
13561 /* If the user is creating a static tracepoint by marker id
13562 (strace -m MARKER_ID), then store the sals index, so that
13563 breakpoint_re_set can try to match up which of the newly
13564 found markers corresponds to this one, and, don't try to
13565 expand multiple locations for each sal, given than SALS
13566 already should contain all sals for MARKER_ID. */
13567
13568 for (i = 0; i < lsal->sals.nelts; ++i)
13569 {
13570 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded;
13571 struct tracepoint *tp;
13572 struct cleanup *old_chain;
13573 struct event_location *location;
13574
13575 expanded.nelts = 1;
13576 expanded.sals = &lsal->sals.sals[i];
13577
13578 location = copy_event_location (canonical->location);
13579 old_chain = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (location);
13580
13581 tp = XCNEW (struct tracepoint);
13582 init_breakpoint_sal (&tp->base, gdbarch, expanded,
13583 location, NULL,
13584 cond_string, extra_string,
13585 type_wanted, disposition,
13586 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
13587 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags,
13588 canonical->special_display);
13589 /* Given that its possible to have multiple markers with
13590 the same string id, if the user is creating a static
13591 tracepoint by marker id ("strace -m MARKER_ID"), then
13592 store the sals index, so that breakpoint_re_set can
13593 try to match up which of the newly found markers
13594 corresponds to this one */
13595 tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx = i;
13596
13597 install_breakpoint (internal, &tp->base, 0);
13598
13599 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
13600 }
13601 }
13602
13603 static void
13604 strace_marker_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
13605 const struct event_location *location,
13606 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
13607 {
13608 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
13609 const char *s = get_linespec_location (location);
13610
13611 *sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&s);
13612 if (sals->nelts > tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx)
13613 {
13614 sals->sals[0] = sals->sals[tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx];
13615 sals->nelts = 1;
13616 }
13617 else
13618 error (_("marker %s not found"), tp->static_trace_marker_id);
13619 }
13620
13621 static struct breakpoint_ops strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
13622
13623 static int
13624 strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b)
13625 {
13626 return b->ops == &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
13627 }
13628
13629 /* Delete a breakpoint and clean up all traces of it in the data
13630 structures. */
13631
13632 void
13633 delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
13634 {
13635 struct breakpoint *b;
13636
13637 gdb_assert (bpt != NULL);
13638
13639 /* Has this bp already been deleted? This can happen because
13640 multiple lists can hold pointers to bp's. bpstat lists are
13641 especial culprits.
13642
13643 One example of this happening is a watchpoint's scope bp. When
13644 the scope bp triggers, we notice that the watchpoint is out of
13645 scope, and delete it. We also delete its scope bp. But the
13646 scope bp is marked "auto-deleting", and is already on a bpstat.
13647 That bpstat is then checked for auto-deleting bp's, which are
13648 deleted.
13649
13650 A real solution to this problem might involve reference counts in
13651 bp's, and/or giving them pointers back to their referencing
13652 bpstat's, and teaching delete_breakpoint to only free a bp's
13653 storage when no more references were extent. A cheaper bandaid
13654 was chosen. */
13655 if (bpt->type == bp_none)
13656 return;
13657
13658 /* At least avoid this stale reference until the reference counting
13659 of breakpoints gets resolved. */
13660 if (bpt->related_breakpoint != bpt)
13661 {
13662 struct breakpoint *related;
13663 struct watchpoint *w;
13664
13665 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
13666 w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt->related_breakpoint;
13667 else if (bpt->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
13668 w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
13669 else
13670 w = NULL;
13671 if (w != NULL)
13672 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (w);
13673
13674 /* Unlink bpt from the bpt->related_breakpoint ring. */
13675 for (related = bpt; related->related_breakpoint != bpt;
13676 related = related->related_breakpoint);
13677 related->related_breakpoint = bpt->related_breakpoint;
13678 bpt->related_breakpoint = bpt;
13679 }
13680
13681 /* watch_command_1 creates a watchpoint but only sets its number if
13682 update_watchpoint succeeds in creating its bp_locations. If there's
13683 a problem in that process, we'll be asked to delete the half-created
13684 watchpoint. In that case, don't announce the deletion. */
13685 if (bpt->number)
13686 observer_notify_breakpoint_deleted (bpt);
13687
13688 if (breakpoint_chain == bpt)
13689 breakpoint_chain = bpt->next;
13690
13691 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
13692 if (b->next == bpt)
13693 {
13694 b->next = bpt->next;
13695 break;
13696 }
13697
13698 /* Be sure no bpstat's are pointing at the breakpoint after it's
13699 been freed. */
13700 /* FIXME, how can we find all bpstat's? We just check stop_bpstat
13701 in all threads for now. Note that we cannot just remove bpstats
13702 pointing at bpt from the stop_bpstat list entirely, as breakpoint
13703 commands are associated with the bpstat; if we remove it here,
13704 then the later call to bpstat_do_actions (&stop_bpstat); in
13705 event-top.c won't do anything, and temporary breakpoints with
13706 commands won't work. */
13707
13708 iterate_over_threads (bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback, bpt);
13709
13710 /* Now that breakpoint is removed from breakpoint list, update the
13711 global location list. This will remove locations that used to
13712 belong to this breakpoint. Do this before freeing the breakpoint
13713 itself, since remove_breakpoint looks at location's owner. It
13714 might be better design to have location completely
13715 self-contained, but it's not the case now. */
13716 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
13717
13718 bpt->ops->dtor (bpt);
13719 /* On the chance that someone will soon try again to delete this
13720 same bp, we mark it as deleted before freeing its storage. */
13721 bpt->type = bp_none;
13722 xfree (bpt);
13723 }
13724
13725 static void
13726 do_delete_breakpoint_cleanup (void *b)
13727 {
13728 delete_breakpoint (b);
13729 }
13730
13731 struct cleanup *
13732 make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
13733 {
13734 return make_cleanup (do_delete_breakpoint_cleanup, b);
13735 }
13736
13737 /* Iterator function to call a user-provided callback function once
13738 for each of B and its related breakpoints. */
13739
13740 static void
13741 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (struct breakpoint *b,
13742 void (*function) (struct breakpoint *,
13743 void *),
13744 void *data)
13745 {
13746 struct breakpoint *related;
13747
13748 related = b;
13749 do
13750 {
13751 struct breakpoint *next;
13752
13753 /* FUNCTION may delete RELATED. */
13754 next = related->related_breakpoint;
13755
13756 if (next == related)
13757 {
13758 /* RELATED is the last ring entry. */
13759 function (related, data);
13760
13761 /* FUNCTION may have deleted it, so we'd never reach back to
13762 B. There's nothing left to do anyway, so just break
13763 out. */
13764 break;
13765 }
13766 else
13767 function (related, data);
13768
13769 related = next;
13770 }
13771 while (related != b);
13772 }
13773
13774 static void
13775 do_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore)
13776 {
13777 delete_breakpoint (b);
13778 }
13779
13780 /* A callback for map_breakpoint_numbers that calls
13781 delete_breakpoint. */
13782
13783 static void
13784 do_map_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore)
13785 {
13786 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (b, do_delete_breakpoint, NULL);
13787 }
13788
13789 void
13790 delete_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
13791 {
13792 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
13793
13794 dont_repeat ();
13795
13796 if (arg == 0)
13797 {
13798 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
13799
13800 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument. Do not delete
13801 internal breakpoints, these have to be deleted with an
13802 explicit breakpoint number argument. */
13803 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
13804 if (user_breakpoint_p (b))
13805 {
13806 breaks_to_delete = 1;
13807 break;
13808 }
13809
13810 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
13811 if (!from_tty
13812 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all breakpoints? "))))
13813 {
13814 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
13815 if (user_breakpoint_p (b))
13816 delete_breakpoint (b);
13817 }
13818 }
13819 else
13820 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, do_map_delete_breakpoint, NULL);
13821 }
13822
13823 static int
13824 all_locations_are_pending (struct bp_location *loc)
13825 {
13826 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
13827 if (!loc->shlib_disabled
13828 && !loc->pspace->executing_startup)
13829 return 0;
13830 return 1;
13831 }
13832
13833 /* Subroutine of update_breakpoint_locations to simplify it.
13834 Return non-zero if multiple fns in list LOC have the same name.
13835 Null names are ignored. */
13836
13837 static int
13838 ambiguous_names_p (struct bp_location *loc)
13839 {
13840 struct bp_location *l;
13841 htab_t htab = htab_create_alloc (13, htab_hash_string,
13842 (int (*) (const void *,
13843 const void *)) streq,
13844 NULL, xcalloc, xfree);
13845
13846 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->next)
13847 {
13848 const char **slot;
13849 const char *name = l->function_name;
13850
13851 /* Allow for some names to be NULL, ignore them. */
13852 if (name == NULL)
13853 continue;
13854
13855 slot = (const char **) htab_find_slot (htab, (const void *) name,
13856 INSERT);
13857 /* NOTE: We can assume slot != NULL here because xcalloc never
13858 returns NULL. */
13859 if (*slot != NULL)
13860 {
13861 htab_delete (htab);
13862 return 1;
13863 }
13864 *slot = name;
13865 }
13866
13867 htab_delete (htab);
13868 return 0;
13869 }
13870
13871 /* When symbols change, it probably means the sources changed as well,
13872 and it might mean the static tracepoint markers are no longer at
13873 the same address or line numbers they used to be at last we
13874 checked. Losing your static tracepoints whenever you rebuild is
13875 undesirable. This function tries to resync/rematch gdb static
13876 tracepoints with the markers on the target, for static tracepoints
13877 that have not been set by marker id. Static tracepoint that have
13878 been set by marker id are reset by marker id in breakpoint_re_set.
13879 The heuristic is:
13880
13881 1) For a tracepoint set at a specific address, look for a marker at
13882 the old PC. If one is found there, assume to be the same marker.
13883 If the name / string id of the marker found is different from the
13884 previous known name, assume that means the user renamed the marker
13885 in the sources, and output a warning.
13886
13887 2) For a tracepoint set at a given line number, look for a marker
13888 at the new address of the old line number. If one is found there,
13889 assume to be the same marker. If the name / string id of the
13890 marker found is different from the previous known name, assume that
13891 means the user renamed the marker in the sources, and output a
13892 warning.
13893
13894 3) If a marker is no longer found at the same address or line, it
13895 may mean the marker no longer exists. But it may also just mean
13896 the code changed a bit. Maybe the user added a few lines of code
13897 that made the marker move up or down (in line number terms). Ask
13898 the target for info about the marker with the string id as we knew
13899 it. If found, update line number and address in the matching
13900 static tracepoint. This will get confused if there's more than one
13901 marker with the same ID (possible in UST, although unadvised
13902 precisely because it confuses tools). */
13903
13904 static struct symtab_and_line
13905 update_static_tracepoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct symtab_and_line sal)
13906 {
13907 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
13908 struct static_tracepoint_marker marker;
13909 CORE_ADDR pc;
13910
13911 pc = sal.pc;
13912 if (sal.line)
13913 find_line_pc (sal.symtab, sal.line, &pc);
13914
13915 if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (pc, &marker))
13916 {
13917 if (strcmp (tp->static_trace_marker_id, marker.str_id) != 0)
13918 warning (_("static tracepoint %d changed probed marker from %s to %s"),
13919 b->number,
13920 tp->static_trace_marker_id, marker.str_id);
13921
13922 xfree (tp->static_trace_marker_id);
13923 tp->static_trace_marker_id = xstrdup (marker.str_id);
13924 release_static_tracepoint_marker (&marker);
13925
13926 return sal;
13927 }
13928
13929 /* Old marker wasn't found on target at lineno. Try looking it up
13930 by string ID. */
13931 if (!sal.explicit_pc
13932 && sal.line != 0
13933 && sal.symtab != NULL
13934 && tp->static_trace_marker_id != NULL)
13935 {
13936 VEC(static_tracepoint_marker_p) *markers;
13937
13938 markers
13939 = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid (tp->static_trace_marker_id);
13940
13941 if (!VEC_empty(static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers))
13942 {
13943 struct symtab_and_line sal2;
13944 struct symbol *sym;
13945 struct static_tracepoint_marker *tpmarker;
13946 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
13947 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
13948
13949 tpmarker = VEC_index (static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers, 0);
13950
13951 xfree (tp->static_trace_marker_id);
13952 tp->static_trace_marker_id = xstrdup (tpmarker->str_id);
13953
13954 warning (_("marker for static tracepoint %d (%s) not "
13955 "found at previous line number"),
13956 b->number, tp->static_trace_marker_id);
13957
13958 init_sal (&sal2);
13959
13960 sal2.pc = tpmarker->address;
13961
13962 sal2 = find_pc_line (tpmarker->address, 0);
13963 sym = find_pc_sect_function (tpmarker->address, NULL);
13964 ui_out_text (uiout, "Now in ");
13965 if (sym)
13966 {
13967 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "func",
13968 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym));
13969 ui_out_text (uiout, " at ");
13970 }
13971 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "file",
13972 symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2.symtab));
13973 ui_out_text (uiout, ":");
13974
13975 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
13976 {
13977 const char *fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal2.symtab);
13978
13979 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "fullname", fullname);
13980 }
13981
13982 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "line", sal2.line);
13983 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
13984
13985 b->loc->line_number = sal2.line;
13986 b->loc->symtab = sym != NULL ? sal2.symtab : NULL;
13987
13988 delete_event_location (b->location);
13989 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
13990 explicit_loc.source_filename
13991 = ASTRDUP (symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2.symtab));
13992 explicit_loc.line_offset.offset = b->loc->line_number;
13993 explicit_loc.line_offset.sign = LINE_OFFSET_NONE;
13994 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
13995
13996 /* Might be nice to check if function changed, and warn if
13997 so. */
13998
13999 release_static_tracepoint_marker (tpmarker);
14000 }
14001 }
14002 return sal;
14003 }
14004
14005 /* Returns 1 iff locations A and B are sufficiently same that
14006 we don't need to report breakpoint as changed. */
14007
14008 static int
14009 locations_are_equal (struct bp_location *a, struct bp_location *b)
14010 {
14011 while (a && b)
14012 {
14013 if (a->address != b->address)
14014 return 0;
14015
14016 if (a->shlib_disabled != b->shlib_disabled)
14017 return 0;
14018
14019 if (a->enabled != b->enabled)
14020 return 0;
14021
14022 a = a->next;
14023 b = b->next;
14024 }
14025
14026 if ((a == NULL) != (b == NULL))
14027 return 0;
14028
14029 return 1;
14030 }
14031
14032 /* Create new breakpoint locations for B (a hardware or software breakpoint)
14033 based on SALS and SALS_END. If SALS_END.NELTS is not zero, then B is
14034 a ranged breakpoint. */
14035
14036 void
14037 update_breakpoint_locations (struct breakpoint *b,
14038 struct symtabs_and_lines sals,
14039 struct symtabs_and_lines sals_end)
14040 {
14041 int i;
14042 struct bp_location *existing_locations = b->loc;
14043
14044 if (sals_end.nelts != 0 && (sals.nelts != 1 || sals_end.nelts != 1))
14045 {
14046 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one start location and one end
14047 location. */
14048 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
14049 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
14050 printf_unfiltered (_("Could not reset ranged breakpoint %d: "
14051 "multiple locations found\n"),
14052 b->number);
14053 return;
14054 }
14055
14056 /* If there's no new locations, and all existing locations are
14057 pending, don't do anything. This optimizes the common case where
14058 all locations are in the same shared library, that was unloaded.
14059 We'd like to retain the location, so that when the library is
14060 loaded again, we don't loose the enabled/disabled status of the
14061 individual locations. */
14062 if (all_locations_are_pending (existing_locations) && sals.nelts == 0)
14063 return;
14064
14065 b->loc = NULL;
14066
14067 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
14068 {
14069 struct bp_location *new_loc;
14070
14071 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sals.sals[i].pspace);
14072
14073 new_loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &(sals.sals[i]));
14074
14075 /* Reparse conditions, they might contain references to the
14076 old symtab. */
14077 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
14078 {
14079 const char *s;
14080
14081 s = b->cond_string;
14082 TRY
14083 {
14084 new_loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&s, sals.sals[i].pc,
14085 block_for_pc (sals.sals[i].pc),
14086 0);
14087 }
14088 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
14089 {
14090 warning (_("failed to reevaluate condition "
14091 "for breakpoint %d: %s"),
14092 b->number, e.message);
14093 new_loc->enabled = 0;
14094 }
14095 END_CATCH
14096 }
14097
14098 if (sals_end.nelts)
14099 {
14100 CORE_ADDR end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sals_end.sals[0]);
14101
14102 new_loc->length = end - sals.sals[0].pc + 1;
14103 }
14104 }
14105
14106 /* If possible, carry over 'disable' status from existing
14107 breakpoints. */
14108 {
14109 struct bp_location *e = existing_locations;
14110 /* If there are multiple breakpoints with the same function name,
14111 e.g. for inline functions, comparing function names won't work.
14112 Instead compare pc addresses; this is just a heuristic as things
14113 may have moved, but in practice it gives the correct answer
14114 often enough until a better solution is found. */
14115 int have_ambiguous_names = ambiguous_names_p (b->loc);
14116
14117 for (; e; e = e->next)
14118 {
14119 if (!e->enabled && e->function_name)
14120 {
14121 struct bp_location *l = b->loc;
14122 if (have_ambiguous_names)
14123 {
14124 for (; l; l = l->next)
14125 if (breakpoint_locations_match (e, l))
14126 {
14127 l->enabled = 0;
14128 break;
14129 }
14130 }
14131 else
14132 {
14133 for (; l; l = l->next)
14134 if (l->function_name
14135 && strcmp (e->function_name, l->function_name) == 0)
14136 {
14137 l->enabled = 0;
14138 break;
14139 }
14140 }
14141 }
14142 }
14143 }
14144
14145 if (!locations_are_equal (existing_locations, b->loc))
14146 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
14147
14148 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
14149 }
14150
14151 /* Find the SaL locations corresponding to the given LOCATION.
14152 On return, FOUND will be 1 if any SaL was found, zero otherwise. */
14153
14154 static struct symtabs_and_lines
14155 location_to_sals (struct breakpoint *b, struct event_location *location,
14156 int *found)
14157 {
14158 struct symtabs_and_lines sals = {0};
14159 struct gdb_exception exception = exception_none;
14160
14161 gdb_assert (b->ops != NULL);
14162
14163 TRY
14164 {
14165 b->ops->decode_location (b, location, &sals);
14166 }
14167 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
14168 {
14169 int not_found_and_ok = 0;
14170
14171 exception = e;
14172
14173 /* For pending breakpoints, it's expected that parsing will
14174 fail until the right shared library is loaded. User has
14175 already told to create pending breakpoints and don't need
14176 extra messages. If breakpoint is in bp_shlib_disabled
14177 state, then user already saw the message about that
14178 breakpoint being disabled, and don't want to see more
14179 errors. */
14180 if (e.error == NOT_FOUND_ERROR
14181 && (b->condition_not_parsed
14182 || (b->loc && b->loc->shlib_disabled)
14183 || (b->loc && b->loc->pspace->executing_startup)
14184 || b->enable_state == bp_disabled))
14185 not_found_and_ok = 1;
14186
14187 if (!not_found_and_ok)
14188 {
14189 /* We surely don't want to warn about the same breakpoint
14190 10 times. One solution, implemented here, is disable
14191 the breakpoint on error. Another solution would be to
14192 have separate 'warning emitted' flag. Since this
14193 happens only when a binary has changed, I don't know
14194 which approach is better. */
14195 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
14196 throw_exception (e);
14197 }
14198 }
14199 END_CATCH
14200
14201 if (exception.reason == 0 || exception.error != NOT_FOUND_ERROR)
14202 {
14203 int i;
14204
14205 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
14206 resolve_sal_pc (&sals.sals[i]);
14207 if (b->condition_not_parsed && b->extra_string != NULL)
14208 {
14209 char *cond_string, *extra_string;
14210 int thread, task;
14211
14212 find_condition_and_thread (b->extra_string, sals.sals[0].pc,
14213 &cond_string, &thread, &task,
14214 &extra_string);
14215 gdb_assert (b->cond_string == NULL);
14216 if (cond_string)
14217 b->cond_string = cond_string;
14218 b->thread = thread;
14219 b->task = task;
14220 if (extra_string)
14221 {
14222 xfree (b->extra_string);
14223 b->extra_string = extra_string;
14224 }
14225 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
14226 }
14227
14228 if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint && !strace_marker_p (b))
14229 sals.sals[0] = update_static_tracepoint (b, sals.sals[0]);
14230
14231 *found = 1;
14232 }
14233 else
14234 *found = 0;
14235
14236 return sals;
14237 }
14238
14239 /* The default re_set method, for typical hardware or software
14240 breakpoints. Reevaluate the breakpoint and recreate its
14241 locations. */
14242
14243 static void
14244 breakpoint_re_set_default (struct breakpoint *b)
14245 {
14246 int found;
14247 struct symtabs_and_lines sals, sals_end;
14248 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded = {0};
14249 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded_end = {0};
14250
14251 sals = location_to_sals (b, b->location, &found);
14252 if (found)
14253 {
14254 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
14255 expanded = sals;
14256 }
14257
14258 if (b->location_range_end != NULL)
14259 {
14260 sals_end = location_to_sals (b, b->location_range_end, &found);
14261 if (found)
14262 {
14263 make_cleanup (xfree, sals_end.sals);
14264 expanded_end = sals_end;
14265 }
14266 }
14267
14268 update_breakpoint_locations (b, expanded, expanded_end);
14269 }
14270
14271 /* Default method for creating SALs from an address string. It basically
14272 calls parse_breakpoint_sals. Return 1 for success, zero for failure. */
14273
14274 static void
14275 create_sals_from_location_default (const struct event_location *location,
14276 struct linespec_result *canonical,
14277 enum bptype type_wanted)
14278 {
14279 parse_breakpoint_sals (location, canonical);
14280 }
14281
14282 /* Call create_breakpoints_sal for the given arguments. This is the default
14283 function for the `create_breakpoints_sal' method of
14284 breakpoint_ops. */
14285
14286 static void
14287 create_breakpoints_sal_default (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
14288 struct linespec_result *canonical,
14289 char *cond_string,
14290 char *extra_string,
14291 enum bptype type_wanted,
14292 enum bpdisp disposition,
14293 int thread,
14294 int task, int ignore_count,
14295 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
14296 int from_tty, int enabled,
14297 int internal, unsigned flags)
14298 {
14299 create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, canonical, cond_string,
14300 extra_string,
14301 type_wanted, disposition,
14302 thread, task, ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
14303 enabled, internal, flags);
14304 }
14305
14306 /* Decode the line represented by S by calling decode_line_full. This is the
14307 default function for the `decode_location' method of breakpoint_ops. */
14308
14309 static void
14310 decode_location_default (struct breakpoint *b,
14311 const struct event_location *location,
14312 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
14313 {
14314 struct linespec_result canonical;
14315
14316 init_linespec_result (&canonical);
14317 decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE,
14318 (struct symtab *) NULL, 0,
14319 &canonical, multiple_symbols_all,
14320 b->filter);
14321
14322 /* We should get 0 or 1 resulting SALs. */
14323 gdb_assert (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical.sals) < 2);
14324
14325 if (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical.sals) > 0)
14326 {
14327 struct linespec_sals *lsal;
14328
14329 lsal = VEC_index (linespec_sals, canonical.sals, 0);
14330 *sals = lsal->sals;
14331 /* Arrange it so the destructor does not free the
14332 contents. */
14333 lsal->sals.sals = NULL;
14334 }
14335
14336 destroy_linespec_result (&canonical);
14337 }
14338
14339 /* Prepare the global context for a re-set of breakpoint B. */
14340
14341 static struct cleanup *
14342 prepare_re_set_context (struct breakpoint *b)
14343 {
14344 struct cleanup *cleanups;
14345
14346 input_radix = b->input_radix;
14347 cleanups = save_current_space_and_thread ();
14348 if (b->pspace != NULL)
14349 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (b->pspace);
14350 set_language (b->language);
14351
14352 return cleanups;
14353 }
14354
14355 /* Reset a breakpoint given it's struct breakpoint * BINT.
14356 The value we return ends up being the return value from catch_errors.
14357 Unused in this case. */
14358
14359 static int
14360 breakpoint_re_set_one (void *bint)
14361 {
14362 /* Get past catch_errs. */
14363 struct breakpoint *b = (struct breakpoint *) bint;
14364 struct cleanup *cleanups;
14365
14366 cleanups = prepare_re_set_context (b);
14367 b->ops->re_set (b);
14368 do_cleanups (cleanups);
14369 return 0;
14370 }
14371
14372 /* Re-set all breakpoints after symbols have been re-loaded. */
14373 void
14374 breakpoint_re_set (void)
14375 {
14376 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
14377 enum language save_language;
14378 int save_input_radix;
14379 struct cleanup *old_chain;
14380
14381 save_language = current_language->la_language;
14382 save_input_radix = input_radix;
14383 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
14384
14385 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
14386 {
14387 /* Format possible error msg. */
14388 char *message = xstrprintf ("Error in re-setting breakpoint %d: ",
14389 b->number);
14390 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
14391 catch_errors (breakpoint_re_set_one, b, message, RETURN_MASK_ALL);
14392 do_cleanups (cleanups);
14393 }
14394 set_language (save_language);
14395 input_radix = save_input_radix;
14396
14397 jit_breakpoint_re_set ();
14398
14399 do_cleanups (old_chain);
14400
14401 create_overlay_event_breakpoint ();
14402 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ();
14403 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint ();
14404 create_exception_master_breakpoint ();
14405 }
14406 \f
14407 /* Reset the thread number of this breakpoint:
14408
14409 - If the breakpoint is for all threads, leave it as-is.
14410 - Else, reset it to the current thread for inferior_ptid. */
14411 void
14412 breakpoint_re_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b)
14413 {
14414 if (b->thread != -1)
14415 {
14416 if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid))
14417 b->thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
14418
14419 /* We're being called after following a fork. The new fork is
14420 selected as current, and unless this was a vfork will have a
14421 different program space from the original thread. Reset that
14422 as well. */
14423 b->loc->pspace = current_program_space;
14424 }
14425 }
14426
14427 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
14428 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
14429 which ends with a period (no newline). */
14430
14431 void
14432 set_ignore_count (int bptnum, int count, int from_tty)
14433 {
14434 struct breakpoint *b;
14435
14436 if (count < 0)
14437 count = 0;
14438
14439 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
14440 if (b->number == bptnum)
14441 {
14442 if (is_tracepoint (b))
14443 {
14444 if (from_tty && count != 0)
14445 printf_filtered (_("Ignore count ignored for tracepoint %d."),
14446 bptnum);
14447 return;
14448 }
14449
14450 b->ignore_count = count;
14451 if (from_tty)
14452 {
14453 if (count == 0)
14454 printf_filtered (_("Will stop next time "
14455 "breakpoint %d is reached."),
14456 bptnum);
14457 else if (count == 1)
14458 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next crossing of breakpoint %d."),
14459 bptnum);
14460 else
14461 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next %d "
14462 "crossings of breakpoint %d."),
14463 count, bptnum);
14464 }
14465 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
14466 return;
14467 }
14468
14469 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bptnum);
14470 }
14471
14472 /* Command to set ignore-count of breakpoint N to COUNT. */
14473
14474 static void
14475 ignore_command (char *args, int from_tty)
14476 {
14477 char *p = args;
14478 int num;
14479
14480 if (p == 0)
14481 error_no_arg (_("a breakpoint number"));
14482
14483 num = get_number (&p);
14484 if (num == 0)
14485 error (_("bad breakpoint number: '%s'"), args);
14486 if (*p == 0)
14487 error (_("Second argument (specified ignore-count) is missing."));
14488
14489 set_ignore_count (num,
14490 longest_to_int (value_as_long (parse_and_eval (p))),
14491 from_tty);
14492 if (from_tty)
14493 printf_filtered ("\n");
14494 }
14495 \f
14496 /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints
14497 whose numbers are given in ARGS. */
14498
14499 static void
14500 map_breakpoint_numbers (char *args, void (*function) (struct breakpoint *,
14501 void *),
14502 void *data)
14503 {
14504 int num;
14505 struct breakpoint *b, *tmp;
14506 int match;
14507 struct get_number_or_range_state state;
14508
14509 if (args == 0 || *args == '\0')
14510 error_no_arg (_("one or more breakpoint numbers"));
14511
14512 init_number_or_range (&state, args);
14513
14514 while (!state.finished)
14515 {
14516 const char *p = state.string;
14517
14518 match = 0;
14519
14520 num = get_number_or_range (&state);
14521 if (num == 0)
14522 {
14523 warning (_("bad breakpoint number at or near '%s'"), p);
14524 }
14525 else
14526 {
14527 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, tmp)
14528 if (b->number == num)
14529 {
14530 match = 1;
14531 function (b, data);
14532 break;
14533 }
14534 if (match == 0)
14535 printf_unfiltered (_("No breakpoint number %d.\n"), num);
14536 }
14537 }
14538 }
14539
14540 static struct bp_location *
14541 find_location_by_number (char *number)
14542 {
14543 char *dot = strchr (number, '.');
14544 char *p1;
14545 int bp_num;
14546 int loc_num;
14547 struct breakpoint *b;
14548 struct bp_location *loc;
14549
14550 *dot = '\0';
14551
14552 p1 = number;
14553 bp_num = get_number (&p1);
14554 if (bp_num == 0)
14555 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%s'"), number);
14556
14557 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
14558 if (b->number == bp_num)
14559 {
14560 break;
14561 }
14562
14563 if (!b || b->number != bp_num)
14564 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%s'"), number);
14565
14566 p1 = dot+1;
14567 loc_num = get_number (&p1);
14568 if (loc_num == 0)
14569 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%s'"), number);
14570
14571 --loc_num;
14572 loc = b->loc;
14573 for (;loc_num && loc; --loc_num, loc = loc->next)
14574 ;
14575 if (!loc)
14576 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%s'"), dot+1);
14577
14578 return loc;
14579 }
14580
14581
14582 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
14583 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
14584 which ends with a period (no newline). */
14585
14586 void
14587 disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
14588 {
14589 /* Never disable a watchpoint scope breakpoint; we want to
14590 hit them when we leave scope so we can delete both the
14591 watchpoint and its scope breakpoint at that time. */
14592 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
14593 return;
14594
14595 bpt->enable_state = bp_disabled;
14596
14597 /* Mark breakpoint locations modified. */
14598 mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14599
14600 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14601 && current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt))
14602 {
14603 struct bp_location *location;
14604
14605 for (location = bpt->loc; location; location = location->next)
14606 target_disable_tracepoint (location);
14607 }
14608
14609 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
14610
14611 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14612 }
14613
14614 /* A callback for iterate_over_related_breakpoints. */
14615
14616 static void
14617 do_disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore)
14618 {
14619 disable_breakpoint (b);
14620 }
14621
14622 /* A callback for map_breakpoint_numbers that calls
14623 disable_breakpoint. */
14624
14625 static void
14626 do_map_disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore)
14627 {
14628 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (b, do_disable_breakpoint, NULL);
14629 }
14630
14631 static void
14632 disable_command (char *args, int from_tty)
14633 {
14634 if (args == 0)
14635 {
14636 struct breakpoint *bpt;
14637
14638 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
14639 if (user_breakpoint_p (bpt))
14640 disable_breakpoint (bpt);
14641 }
14642 else
14643 {
14644 char *num = extract_arg (&args);
14645
14646 while (num)
14647 {
14648 if (strchr (num, '.'))
14649 {
14650 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (num);
14651
14652 if (loc)
14653 {
14654 if (loc->enabled)
14655 {
14656 loc->enabled = 0;
14657 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
14658 }
14659 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14660 && current_trace_status ()->running && loc->owner
14661 && is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
14662 target_disable_tracepoint (loc);
14663 }
14664 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
14665 }
14666 else
14667 map_breakpoint_numbers (num, do_map_disable_breakpoint, NULL);
14668 num = extract_arg (&args);
14669 }
14670 }
14671 }
14672
14673 static void
14674 enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *bpt, enum bpdisp disposition,
14675 int count)
14676 {
14677 int target_resources_ok;
14678
14679 if (bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
14680 {
14681 int i;
14682 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
14683 target_resources_ok =
14684 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
14685 i + 1, 0);
14686 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
14687 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
14688 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
14689 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
14690 }
14691
14692 if (is_watchpoint (bpt))
14693 {
14694 /* Initialize it just to avoid a GCC false warning. */
14695 enum enable_state orig_enable_state = bp_disabled;
14696
14697 TRY
14698 {
14699 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
14700
14701 orig_enable_state = bpt->enable_state;
14702 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
14703 update_watchpoint (w, 1 /* reparse */);
14704 }
14705 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
14706 {
14707 bpt->enable_state = orig_enable_state;
14708 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, _("Cannot enable watchpoint %d: "),
14709 bpt->number);
14710 return;
14711 }
14712 END_CATCH
14713 }
14714
14715 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
14716
14717 /* Mark breakpoint locations modified. */
14718 mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14719
14720 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14721 && current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt))
14722 {
14723 struct bp_location *location;
14724
14725 for (location = bpt->loc; location; location = location->next)
14726 target_enable_tracepoint (location);
14727 }
14728
14729 bpt->disposition = disposition;
14730 bpt->enable_count = count;
14731 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
14732
14733 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14734 }
14735
14736
14737 void
14738 enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
14739 {
14740 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, bpt->disposition, 0);
14741 }
14742
14743 static void
14744 do_enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *arg)
14745 {
14746 enable_breakpoint (bpt);
14747 }
14748
14749 /* A callback for map_breakpoint_numbers that calls
14750 enable_breakpoint. */
14751
14752 static void
14753 do_map_enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore)
14754 {
14755 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (b, do_enable_breakpoint, NULL);
14756 }
14757
14758 /* The enable command enables the specified breakpoints (or all defined
14759 breakpoints) so they once again become (or continue to be) effective
14760 in stopping the inferior. */
14761
14762 static void
14763 enable_command (char *args, int from_tty)
14764 {
14765 if (args == 0)
14766 {
14767 struct breakpoint *bpt;
14768
14769 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
14770 if (user_breakpoint_p (bpt))
14771 enable_breakpoint (bpt);
14772 }
14773 else
14774 {
14775 char *num = extract_arg (&args);
14776
14777 while (num)
14778 {
14779 if (strchr (num, '.'))
14780 {
14781 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (num);
14782
14783 if (loc)
14784 {
14785 if (!loc->enabled)
14786 {
14787 loc->enabled = 1;
14788 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
14789 }
14790 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14791 && current_trace_status ()->running && loc->owner
14792 && is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
14793 target_enable_tracepoint (loc);
14794 }
14795 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
14796 }
14797 else
14798 map_breakpoint_numbers (num, do_map_enable_breakpoint, NULL);
14799 num = extract_arg (&args);
14800 }
14801 }
14802 }
14803
14804 /* This struct packages up disposition data for application to multiple
14805 breakpoints. */
14806
14807 struct disp_data
14808 {
14809 enum bpdisp disp;
14810 int count;
14811 };
14812
14813 static void
14814 do_enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *arg)
14815 {
14816 struct disp_data disp_data = *(struct disp_data *) arg;
14817
14818 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_data.disp, disp_data.count);
14819 }
14820
14821 static void
14822 do_map_enable_once_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *ignore)
14823 {
14824 struct disp_data disp = { disp_disable, 1 };
14825
14826 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (bpt, do_enable_breakpoint_disp, &disp);
14827 }
14828
14829 static void
14830 enable_once_command (char *args, int from_tty)
14831 {
14832 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, do_map_enable_once_breakpoint, NULL);
14833 }
14834
14835 static void
14836 do_map_enable_count_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *countptr)
14837 {
14838 struct disp_data disp = { disp_disable, *(int *) countptr };
14839
14840 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (bpt, do_enable_breakpoint_disp, &disp);
14841 }
14842
14843 static void
14844 enable_count_command (char *args, int from_tty)
14845 {
14846 int count;
14847
14848 if (args == NULL)
14849 error_no_arg (_("hit count"));
14850
14851 count = get_number (&args);
14852
14853 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, do_map_enable_count_breakpoint, &count);
14854 }
14855
14856 static void
14857 do_map_enable_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *ignore)
14858 {
14859 struct disp_data disp = { disp_del, 1 };
14860
14861 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (bpt, do_enable_breakpoint_disp, &disp);
14862 }
14863
14864 static void
14865 enable_delete_command (char *args, int from_tty)
14866 {
14867 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, do_map_enable_delete_breakpoint, NULL);
14868 }
14869 \f
14870 static void
14871 set_breakpoint_cmd (char *args, int from_tty)
14872 {
14873 }
14874
14875 static void
14876 show_breakpoint_cmd (char *args, int from_tty)
14877 {
14878 }
14879
14880 /* Invalidate last known value of any hardware watchpoint if
14881 the memory which that value represents has been written to by
14882 GDB itself. */
14883
14884 static void
14885 invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change (struct inferior *inferior,
14886 CORE_ADDR addr, ssize_t len,
14887 const bfd_byte *data)
14888 {
14889 struct breakpoint *bp;
14890
14891 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp)
14892 if (bp->enable_state == bp_enabled
14893 && bp->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
14894 {
14895 struct watchpoint *wp = (struct watchpoint *) bp;
14896
14897 if (wp->val_valid && wp->val)
14898 {
14899 struct bp_location *loc;
14900
14901 for (loc = bp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
14902 if (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
14903 && loc->address + loc->length > addr
14904 && addr + len > loc->address)
14905 {
14906 value_free (wp->val);
14907 wp->val = NULL;
14908 wp->val_valid = 0;
14909 }
14910 }
14911 }
14912 }
14913
14914 /* Create and insert a breakpoint for software single step. */
14915
14916 void
14917 insert_single_step_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
14918 struct address_space *aspace,
14919 CORE_ADDR next_pc)
14920 {
14921 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
14922 struct symtab_and_line sal;
14923 CORE_ADDR pc = next_pc;
14924
14925 if (tp->control.single_step_breakpoints == NULL)
14926 {
14927 tp->control.single_step_breakpoints
14928 = new_single_step_breakpoint (tp->num, gdbarch);
14929 }
14930
14931 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
14932 sal.pc = pc;
14933 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
14934 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
14935 add_location_to_breakpoint (tp->control.single_step_breakpoints, &sal);
14936
14937 update_global_location_list (UGLL_INSERT);
14938 }
14939
14940 /* See breakpoint.h. */
14941
14942 int
14943 breakpoint_has_location_inserted_here (struct breakpoint *bp,
14944 struct address_space *aspace,
14945 CORE_ADDR pc)
14946 {
14947 struct bp_location *loc;
14948
14949 for (loc = bp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
14950 if (loc->inserted
14951 && breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, pc))
14952 return 1;
14953
14954 return 0;
14955 }
14956
14957 /* Check whether a software single-step breakpoint is inserted at
14958 PC. */
14959
14960 int
14961 single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace,
14962 CORE_ADDR pc)
14963 {
14964 struct breakpoint *bpt;
14965
14966 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
14967 {
14968 if (bpt->type == bp_single_step
14969 && breakpoint_has_location_inserted_here (bpt, aspace, pc))
14970 return 1;
14971 }
14972 return 0;
14973 }
14974
14975 /* Tracepoint-specific operations. */
14976
14977 /* Set tracepoint count to NUM. */
14978 static void
14979 set_tracepoint_count (int num)
14980 {
14981 tracepoint_count = num;
14982 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("tpnum"), num);
14983 }
14984
14985 static void
14986 trace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
14987 {
14988 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
14989 struct event_location *location;
14990 struct cleanup *back_to;
14991
14992 location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
14993 back_to = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (location);
14994 if (location != NULL
14995 && event_location_type (location) == PROBE_LOCATION)
14996 ops = &tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
14997 else
14998 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
14999
15000 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
15001 location,
15002 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
15003 0 /* tempflag */,
15004 bp_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
15005 0 /* Ignore count */,
15006 pending_break_support,
15007 ops,
15008 from_tty,
15009 1 /* enabled */,
15010 0 /* internal */, 0);
15011 do_cleanups (back_to);
15012 }
15013
15014 static void
15015 ftrace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
15016 {
15017 struct event_location *location;
15018 struct cleanup *back_to;
15019
15020 location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
15021 back_to = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (location);
15022 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
15023 location,
15024 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
15025 0 /* tempflag */,
15026 bp_fast_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
15027 0 /* Ignore count */,
15028 pending_break_support,
15029 &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops,
15030 from_tty,
15031 1 /* enabled */,
15032 0 /* internal */, 0);
15033 do_cleanups (back_to);
15034 }
15035
15036 /* strace command implementation. Creates a static tracepoint. */
15037
15038 static void
15039 strace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
15040 {
15041 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
15042 struct event_location *location;
15043 struct cleanup *back_to;
15044
15045 /* Decide if we are dealing with a static tracepoint marker (`-m'),
15046 or with a normal static tracepoint. */
15047 if (arg && startswith (arg, "-m") && isspace (arg[2]))
15048 {
15049 ops = &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
15050 location = new_linespec_location (&arg);
15051 }
15052 else
15053 {
15054 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15055 location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
15056 }
15057
15058 back_to = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (location);
15059 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
15060 location,
15061 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
15062 0 /* tempflag */,
15063 bp_static_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
15064 0 /* Ignore count */,
15065 pending_break_support,
15066 ops,
15067 from_tty,
15068 1 /* enabled */,
15069 0 /* internal */, 0);
15070 do_cleanups (back_to);
15071 }
15072
15073 /* Set up a fake reader function that gets command lines from a linked
15074 list that was acquired during tracepoint uploading. */
15075
15076 static struct uploaded_tp *this_utp;
15077 static int next_cmd;
15078
15079 static char *
15080 read_uploaded_action (void)
15081 {
15082 char *rslt;
15083
15084 VEC_iterate (char_ptr, this_utp->cmd_strings, next_cmd, rslt);
15085
15086 next_cmd++;
15087
15088 return rslt;
15089 }
15090
15091 /* Given information about a tracepoint as recorded on a target (which
15092 can be either a live system or a trace file), attempt to create an
15093 equivalent GDB tracepoint. This is not a reliable process, since
15094 the target does not necessarily have all the information used when
15095 the tracepoint was originally defined. */
15096
15097 struct tracepoint *
15098 create_tracepoint_from_upload (struct uploaded_tp *utp)
15099 {
15100 char *addr_str, small_buf[100];
15101 struct tracepoint *tp;
15102 struct event_location *location;
15103 struct cleanup *cleanup;
15104
15105 if (utp->at_string)
15106 addr_str = utp->at_string;
15107 else
15108 {
15109 /* In the absence of a source location, fall back to raw
15110 address. Since there is no way to confirm that the address
15111 means the same thing as when the trace was started, warn the
15112 user. */
15113 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d has no "
15114 "source location, using raw address"),
15115 utp->number);
15116 xsnprintf (small_buf, sizeof (small_buf), "*%s", hex_string (utp->addr));
15117 addr_str = small_buf;
15118 }
15119
15120 /* There's not much we can do with a sequence of bytecodes. */
15121 if (utp->cond && !utp->cond_string)
15122 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d condition "
15123 "has no source form, ignoring it"),
15124 utp->number);
15125
15126 location = string_to_event_location (&addr_str, current_language);
15127 cleanup = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (location);
15128 if (!create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
15129 location,
15130 utp->cond_string, -1, addr_str,
15131 0 /* parse cond/thread */,
15132 0 /* tempflag */,
15133 utp->type /* type_wanted */,
15134 0 /* Ignore count */,
15135 pending_break_support,
15136 &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops,
15137 0 /* from_tty */,
15138 utp->enabled /* enabled */,
15139 0 /* internal */,
15140 CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED))
15141 {
15142 do_cleanups (cleanup);
15143 return NULL;
15144 }
15145
15146 do_cleanups (cleanup);
15147
15148 /* Get the tracepoint we just created. */
15149 tp = get_tracepoint (tracepoint_count);
15150 gdb_assert (tp != NULL);
15151
15152 if (utp->pass > 0)
15153 {
15154 xsnprintf (small_buf, sizeof (small_buf), "%d %d", utp->pass,
15155 tp->base.number);
15156
15157 trace_pass_command (small_buf, 0);
15158 }
15159
15160 /* If we have uploaded versions of the original commands, set up a
15161 special-purpose "reader" function and call the usual command line
15162 reader, then pass the result to the breakpoint command-setting
15163 function. */
15164 if (!VEC_empty (char_ptr, utp->cmd_strings))
15165 {
15166 struct command_line *cmd_list;
15167
15168 this_utp = utp;
15169 next_cmd = 0;
15170
15171 cmd_list = read_command_lines_1 (read_uploaded_action, 1, NULL, NULL);
15172
15173 breakpoint_set_commands (&tp->base, cmd_list);
15174 }
15175 else if (!VEC_empty (char_ptr, utp->actions)
15176 || !VEC_empty (char_ptr, utp->step_actions))
15177 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d actions "
15178 "have no source form, ignoring them"),
15179 utp->number);
15180
15181 /* Copy any status information that might be available. */
15182 tp->base.hit_count = utp->hit_count;
15183 tp->traceframe_usage = utp->traceframe_usage;
15184
15185 return tp;
15186 }
15187
15188 /* Print information on tracepoint number TPNUM_EXP, or all if
15189 omitted. */
15190
15191 static void
15192 tracepoints_info (char *args, int from_tty)
15193 {
15194 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
15195 int num_printed;
15196
15197 num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, 0, is_tracepoint);
15198
15199 if (num_printed == 0)
15200 {
15201 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
15202 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No tracepoints.\n");
15203 else
15204 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No tracepoint matching '%s'.\n", args);
15205 }
15206
15207 default_collect_info ();
15208 }
15209
15210 /* The 'enable trace' command enables tracepoints.
15211 Not supported by all targets. */
15212 static void
15213 enable_trace_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15214 {
15215 enable_command (args, from_tty);
15216 }
15217
15218 /* The 'disable trace' command disables tracepoints.
15219 Not supported by all targets. */
15220 static void
15221 disable_trace_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15222 {
15223 disable_command (args, from_tty);
15224 }
15225
15226 /* Remove a tracepoint (or all if no argument). */
15227 static void
15228 delete_trace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
15229 {
15230 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
15231
15232 dont_repeat ();
15233
15234 if (arg == 0)
15235 {
15236 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
15237
15238 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
15239 Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these
15240 have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number
15241 argument. */
15242 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
15243 if (is_tracepoint (b) && user_breakpoint_p (b))
15244 {
15245 breaks_to_delete = 1;
15246 break;
15247 }
15248
15249 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
15250 if (!from_tty
15251 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all tracepoints? "))))
15252 {
15253 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
15254 if (is_tracepoint (b) && user_breakpoint_p (b))
15255 delete_breakpoint (b);
15256 }
15257 }
15258 else
15259 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, do_map_delete_breakpoint, NULL);
15260 }
15261
15262 /* Helper function for trace_pass_command. */
15263
15264 static void
15265 trace_pass_set_count (struct tracepoint *tp, int count, int from_tty)
15266 {
15267 tp->pass_count = count;
15268 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (&tp->base);
15269 if (from_tty)
15270 printf_filtered (_("Setting tracepoint %d's passcount to %d\n"),
15271 tp->base.number, count);
15272 }
15273
15274 /* Set passcount for tracepoint.
15275
15276 First command argument is passcount, second is tracepoint number.
15277 If tracepoint number omitted, apply to most recently defined.
15278 Also accepts special argument "all". */
15279
15280 static void
15281 trace_pass_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15282 {
15283 struct tracepoint *t1;
15284 unsigned int count;
15285
15286 if (args == 0 || *args == 0)
15287 error (_("passcount command requires an "
15288 "argument (count + optional TP num)"));
15289
15290 count = strtoul (args, &args, 10); /* Count comes first, then TP num. */
15291
15292 args = skip_spaces (args);
15293 if (*args && strncasecmp (args, "all", 3) == 0)
15294 {
15295 struct breakpoint *b;
15296
15297 args += 3; /* Skip special argument "all". */
15298 if (*args)
15299 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
15300
15301 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
15302 {
15303 t1 = (struct tracepoint *) b;
15304 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
15305 }
15306 }
15307 else if (*args == '\0')
15308 {
15309 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, NULL);
15310 if (t1)
15311 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
15312 }
15313 else
15314 {
15315 struct get_number_or_range_state state;
15316
15317 init_number_or_range (&state, args);
15318 while (!state.finished)
15319 {
15320 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, &state);
15321 if (t1)
15322 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
15323 }
15324 }
15325 }
15326
15327 struct tracepoint *
15328 get_tracepoint (int num)
15329 {
15330 struct breakpoint *t;
15331
15332 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
15333 if (t->number == num)
15334 return (struct tracepoint *) t;
15335
15336 return NULL;
15337 }
15338
15339 /* Find the tracepoint with the given target-side number (which may be
15340 different from the tracepoint number after disconnecting and
15341 reconnecting). */
15342
15343 struct tracepoint *
15344 get_tracepoint_by_number_on_target (int num)
15345 {
15346 struct breakpoint *b;
15347
15348 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
15349 {
15350 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
15351
15352 if (t->number_on_target == num)
15353 return t;
15354 }
15355
15356 return NULL;
15357 }
15358
15359 /* Utility: parse a tracepoint number and look it up in the list.
15360 If STATE is not NULL, use, get_number_or_range_state and ignore ARG.
15361 If the argument is missing, the most recent tracepoint
15362 (tracepoint_count) is returned. */
15363
15364 struct tracepoint *
15365 get_tracepoint_by_number (char **arg,
15366 struct get_number_or_range_state *state)
15367 {
15368 struct breakpoint *t;
15369 int tpnum;
15370 char *instring = arg == NULL ? NULL : *arg;
15371
15372 if (state)
15373 {
15374 gdb_assert (!state->finished);
15375 tpnum = get_number_or_range (state);
15376 }
15377 else if (arg == NULL || *arg == NULL || ! **arg)
15378 tpnum = tracepoint_count;
15379 else
15380 tpnum = get_number (arg);
15381
15382 if (tpnum <= 0)
15383 {
15384 if (instring && *instring)
15385 printf_filtered (_("bad tracepoint number at or near '%s'\n"),
15386 instring);
15387 else
15388 printf_filtered (_("No previous tracepoint\n"));
15389 return NULL;
15390 }
15391
15392 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
15393 if (t->number == tpnum)
15394 {
15395 return (struct tracepoint *) t;
15396 }
15397
15398 printf_unfiltered ("No tracepoint number %d.\n", tpnum);
15399 return NULL;
15400 }
15401
15402 void
15403 print_recreate_thread (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
15404 {
15405 if (b->thread != -1)
15406 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " thread %d", b->thread);
15407
15408 if (b->task != 0)
15409 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " task %d", b->task);
15410
15411 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "\n");
15412 }
15413
15414 /* Save information on user settable breakpoints (watchpoints, etc) to
15415 a new script file named FILENAME. If FILTER is non-NULL, call it
15416 on each breakpoint and only include the ones for which it returns
15417 non-zero. */
15418
15419 static void
15420 save_breakpoints (char *filename, int from_tty,
15421 int (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *))
15422 {
15423 struct breakpoint *tp;
15424 int any = 0;
15425 struct cleanup *cleanup;
15426 struct ui_file *fp;
15427 int extra_trace_bits = 0;
15428
15429 if (filename == 0 || *filename == 0)
15430 error (_("Argument required (file name in which to save)"));
15431
15432 /* See if we have anything to save. */
15433 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (tp)
15434 {
15435 /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
15436 if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp))
15437 continue;
15438
15439 /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
15440 if (filter && !filter (tp))
15441 continue;
15442
15443 any = 1;
15444
15445 if (is_tracepoint (tp))
15446 {
15447 extra_trace_bits = 1;
15448
15449 /* We can stop searching. */
15450 break;
15451 }
15452 }
15453
15454 if (!any)
15455 {
15456 warning (_("Nothing to save."));
15457 return;
15458 }
15459
15460 filename = tilde_expand (filename);
15461 cleanup = make_cleanup (xfree, filename);
15462 fp = gdb_fopen (filename, "w");
15463 if (!fp)
15464 error (_("Unable to open file '%s' for saving (%s)"),
15465 filename, safe_strerror (errno));
15466 make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (fp);
15467
15468 if (extra_trace_bits)
15469 save_trace_state_variables (fp);
15470
15471 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (tp)
15472 {
15473 /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
15474 if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp))
15475 continue;
15476
15477 /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
15478 if (filter && !filter (tp))
15479 continue;
15480
15481 tp->ops->print_recreate (tp, fp);
15482
15483 /* Note, we can't rely on tp->number for anything, as we can't
15484 assume the recreated breakpoint numbers will match. Use $bpnum
15485 instead. */
15486
15487 if (tp->cond_string)
15488 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " condition $bpnum %s\n", tp->cond_string);
15489
15490 if (tp->ignore_count)
15491 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " ignore $bpnum %d\n", tp->ignore_count);
15492
15493 if (tp->type != bp_dprintf && tp->commands)
15494 {
15495 struct gdb_exception exception;
15496
15497 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " commands\n");
15498
15499 ui_out_redirect (current_uiout, fp);
15500 TRY
15501 {
15502 print_command_lines (current_uiout, tp->commands->commands, 2);
15503 }
15504 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
15505 {
15506 ui_out_redirect (current_uiout, NULL);
15507 throw_exception (ex);
15508 }
15509 END_CATCH
15510
15511 ui_out_redirect (current_uiout, NULL);
15512 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " end\n");
15513 }
15514
15515 if (tp->enable_state == bp_disabled)
15516 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "disable $bpnum\n");
15517
15518 /* If this is a multi-location breakpoint, check if the locations
15519 should be individually disabled. Watchpoint locations are
15520 special, and not user visible. */
15521 if (!is_watchpoint (tp) && tp->loc && tp->loc->next)
15522 {
15523 struct bp_location *loc;
15524 int n = 1;
15525
15526 for (loc = tp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next, n++)
15527 if (!loc->enabled)
15528 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "disable $bpnum.%d\n", n);
15529 }
15530 }
15531
15532 if (extra_trace_bits && *default_collect)
15533 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "set default-collect %s\n", default_collect);
15534
15535 if (from_tty)
15536 printf_filtered (_("Saved to file '%s'.\n"), filename);
15537 do_cleanups (cleanup);
15538 }
15539
15540 /* The `save breakpoints' command. */
15541
15542 static void
15543 save_breakpoints_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15544 {
15545 save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, NULL);
15546 }
15547
15548 /* The `save tracepoints' command. */
15549
15550 static void
15551 save_tracepoints_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15552 {
15553 save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, is_tracepoint);
15554 }
15555
15556 /* Create a vector of all tracepoints. */
15557
15558 VEC(breakpoint_p) *
15559 all_tracepoints (void)
15560 {
15561 VEC(breakpoint_p) *tp_vec = 0;
15562 struct breakpoint *tp;
15563
15564 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
15565 {
15566 VEC_safe_push (breakpoint_p, tp_vec, tp);
15567 }
15568
15569 return tp_vec;
15570 }
15571
15572 \f
15573 /* This help string is used to consolidate all the help string for specifying
15574 locations used by several commands. */
15575
15576 #define LOCATION_HELP_STRING \
15577 "Linespecs are colon-separated lists of location parameters, such as\n\
15578 source filename, function name, label name, and line number.\n\
15579 Example: To specify the start of a label named \"the_top\" in the\n\
15580 function \"fact\" in the file \"factorial.c\", use\n\
15581 \"factorial.c:fact:the_top\".\n\
15582 \n\
15583 Address locations begin with \"*\" and specify an exact address in the\n\
15584 program. Example: To specify the fourth byte past the start function\n\
15585 \"main\", use \"*main + 4\".\n\
15586 \n\
15587 Explicit locations are similar to linespecs but use an option/argument\n\
15588 syntax to specify location parameters.\n\
15589 Example: To specify the start of the label named \"the_top\" in the\n\
15590 function \"fact\" in the file \"factorial.c\", use \"-source factorial.c\n\
15591 -function fact -label the_top\".\n"
15592
15593 /* This help string is used for the break, hbreak, tbreak and thbreak
15594 commands. It is defined as a macro to prevent duplication.
15595 COMMAND should be a string constant containing the name of the
15596 command. */
15597
15598 #define BREAK_ARGS_HELP(command) \
15599 command" [PROBE_MODIFIER] [LOCATION] [thread THREADNUM] [if CONDITION]\n\
15600 PROBE_MODIFIER shall be present if the command is to be placed in a\n\
15601 probe point. Accepted values are `-probe' (for a generic, automatically\n\
15602 guessed probe type), `-probe-stap' (for a SystemTap probe) or \n\
15603 `-probe-dtrace' (for a DTrace probe).\n\
15604 LOCATION may be a linespec, address, or explicit location as described\n\
15605 below.\n\
15606 \n\
15607 With no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected\n\
15608 stack frame. This is useful for breaking on return to a stack frame.\n\
15609 \n\
15610 THREADNUM is the number from \"info threads\".\n\
15611 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
15612 \n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\
15613 Multiple breakpoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
15614 conditions are different.\n\
15615 \n\
15616 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints."
15617
15618 /* List of subcommands for "catch". */
15619 static struct cmd_list_element *catch_cmdlist;
15620
15621 /* List of subcommands for "tcatch". */
15622 static struct cmd_list_element *tcatch_cmdlist;
15623
15624 void
15625 add_catch_command (char *name, char *docstring,
15626 cmd_sfunc_ftype *sfunc,
15627 completer_ftype *completer,
15628 void *user_data_catch,
15629 void *user_data_tcatch)
15630 {
15631 struct cmd_list_element *command;
15632
15633 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, NULL, docstring,
15634 &catch_cmdlist);
15635 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
15636 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_catch);
15637 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
15638
15639 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, NULL, docstring,
15640 &tcatch_cmdlist);
15641 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
15642 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_tcatch);
15643 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
15644 }
15645
15646 static void
15647 save_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
15648 {
15649 printf_unfiltered (_("\"save\" must be followed by "
15650 "the name of a save subcommand.\n"));
15651 help_list (save_cmdlist, "save ", all_commands, gdb_stdout);
15652 }
15653
15654 struct breakpoint *
15655 iterate_over_breakpoints (int (*callback) (struct breakpoint *, void *),
15656 void *data)
15657 {
15658 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
15659
15660 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
15661 {
15662 if ((*callback) (b, data))
15663 return b;
15664 }
15665
15666 return NULL;
15667 }
15668
15669 /* Zero if any of the breakpoint's locations could be a location where
15670 functions have been inlined, nonzero otherwise. */
15671
15672 static int
15673 is_non_inline_function (struct breakpoint *b)
15674 {
15675 /* The shared library event breakpoint is set on the address of a
15676 non-inline function. */
15677 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
15678 return 1;
15679
15680 return 0;
15681 }
15682
15683 /* Nonzero if the specified PC cannot be a location where functions
15684 have been inlined. */
15685
15686 int
15687 pc_at_non_inline_function (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
15688 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
15689 {
15690 struct breakpoint *b;
15691 struct bp_location *bl;
15692
15693 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
15694 {
15695 if (!is_non_inline_function (b))
15696 continue;
15697
15698 for (bl = b->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
15699 {
15700 if (!bl->shlib_disabled
15701 && bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, pc, ws))
15702 return 1;
15703 }
15704 }
15705
15706 return 0;
15707 }
15708
15709 /* Remove any references to OBJFILE which is going to be freed. */
15710
15711 void
15712 breakpoint_free_objfile (struct objfile *objfile)
15713 {
15714 struct bp_location **locp, *loc;
15715
15716 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp)
15717 if (loc->symtab != NULL && SYMTAB_OBJFILE (loc->symtab) == objfile)
15718 loc->symtab = NULL;
15719 }
15720
15721 void
15722 initialize_breakpoint_ops (void)
15723 {
15724 static int initialized = 0;
15725
15726 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
15727
15728 if (initialized)
15729 return;
15730 initialized = 1;
15731
15732 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be inherit by all kinds of
15733 breakpoints (real breakpoints, i.e., user "break" breakpoints,
15734 internal and momentary breakpoints, etc.). */
15735 ops = &bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15736 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15737 ops->re_set = bkpt_re_set;
15738 ops->insert_location = bkpt_insert_location;
15739 ops->remove_location = bkpt_remove_location;
15740 ops->breakpoint_hit = bkpt_breakpoint_hit;
15741 ops->create_sals_from_location = bkpt_create_sals_from_location;
15742 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = bkpt_create_breakpoints_sal;
15743 ops->decode_location = bkpt_decode_location;
15744
15745 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in regular breakpoints. */
15746 ops = &bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
15747 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15748 ops->re_set = bkpt_re_set;
15749 ops->resources_needed = bkpt_resources_needed;
15750 ops->print_it = bkpt_print_it;
15751 ops->print_mention = bkpt_print_mention;
15752 ops->print_recreate = bkpt_print_recreate;
15753
15754 /* Ranged breakpoints. */
15755 ops = &ranged_breakpoint_ops;
15756 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
15757 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_ranged_breakpoint;
15758 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_ranged_breakpoint;
15759 ops->print_it = print_it_ranged_breakpoint;
15760 ops->print_one = print_one_ranged_breakpoint;
15761 ops->print_one_detail = print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint;
15762 ops->print_mention = print_mention_ranged_breakpoint;
15763 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_ranged_breakpoint;
15764
15765 /* Internal breakpoints. */
15766 ops = &internal_breakpoint_ops;
15767 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15768 ops->re_set = internal_bkpt_re_set;
15769 ops->check_status = internal_bkpt_check_status;
15770 ops->print_it = internal_bkpt_print_it;
15771 ops->print_mention = internal_bkpt_print_mention;
15772
15773 /* Momentary breakpoints. */
15774 ops = &momentary_breakpoint_ops;
15775 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15776 ops->re_set = momentary_bkpt_re_set;
15777 ops->check_status = momentary_bkpt_check_status;
15778 ops->print_it = momentary_bkpt_print_it;
15779 ops->print_mention = momentary_bkpt_print_mention;
15780
15781 /* Momentary breakpoints for bp_longjmp and bp_exception. */
15782 ops = &longjmp_breakpoint_ops;
15783 *ops = momentary_breakpoint_ops;
15784 ops->dtor = longjmp_bkpt_dtor;
15785
15786 /* Probe breakpoints. */
15787 ops = &bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
15788 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
15789 ops->insert_location = bkpt_probe_insert_location;
15790 ops->remove_location = bkpt_probe_remove_location;
15791 ops->create_sals_from_location = bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location;
15792 ops->decode_location = bkpt_probe_decode_location;
15793
15794 /* Watchpoints. */
15795 ops = &watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
15796 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15797 ops->dtor = dtor_watchpoint;
15798 ops->re_set = re_set_watchpoint;
15799 ops->insert_location = insert_watchpoint;
15800 ops->remove_location = remove_watchpoint;
15801 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_watchpoint;
15802 ops->check_status = check_status_watchpoint;
15803 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_watchpoint;
15804 ops->works_in_software_mode = works_in_software_mode_watchpoint;
15805 ops->print_it = print_it_watchpoint;
15806 ops->print_mention = print_mention_watchpoint;
15807 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_watchpoint;
15808 ops->explains_signal = explains_signal_watchpoint;
15809
15810 /* Masked watchpoints. */
15811 ops = &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
15812 *ops = watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
15813 ops->insert_location = insert_masked_watchpoint;
15814 ops->remove_location = remove_masked_watchpoint;
15815 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_masked_watchpoint;
15816 ops->works_in_software_mode = works_in_software_mode_masked_watchpoint;
15817 ops->print_it = print_it_masked_watchpoint;
15818 ops->print_one_detail = print_one_detail_masked_watchpoint;
15819 ops->print_mention = print_mention_masked_watchpoint;
15820 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_masked_watchpoint;
15821
15822 /* Tracepoints. */
15823 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15824 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15825 ops->re_set = tracepoint_re_set;
15826 ops->breakpoint_hit = tracepoint_breakpoint_hit;
15827 ops->print_one_detail = tracepoint_print_one_detail;
15828 ops->print_mention = tracepoint_print_mention;
15829 ops->print_recreate = tracepoint_print_recreate;
15830 ops->create_sals_from_location = tracepoint_create_sals_from_location;
15831 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = tracepoint_create_breakpoints_sal;
15832 ops->decode_location = tracepoint_decode_location;
15833
15834 /* Probe tracepoints. */
15835 ops = &tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
15836 *ops = tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15837 ops->create_sals_from_location = tracepoint_probe_create_sals_from_location;
15838 ops->decode_location = tracepoint_probe_decode_location;
15839
15840 /* Static tracepoints with marker (`-m'). */
15841 ops = &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
15842 *ops = tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15843 ops->create_sals_from_location = strace_marker_create_sals_from_location;
15844 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal;
15845 ops->decode_location = strace_marker_decode_location;
15846
15847 /* Fork catchpoints. */
15848 ops = &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops;
15849 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15850 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_fork;
15851 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_fork;
15852 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_fork;
15853 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_fork;
15854 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_fork;
15855 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_fork;
15856 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_fork;
15857
15858 /* Vfork catchpoints. */
15859 ops = &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops;
15860 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15861 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_vfork;
15862 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_vfork;
15863 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork;
15864 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_vfork;
15865 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_vfork;
15866 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_vfork;
15867 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_vfork;
15868
15869 /* Exec catchpoints. */
15870 ops = &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops;
15871 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15872 ops->dtor = dtor_catch_exec;
15873 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_exec;
15874 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_exec;
15875 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_exec;
15876 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_exec;
15877 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_exec;
15878 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_exec;
15879 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_exec;
15880
15881 /* Solib-related catchpoints. */
15882 ops = &catch_solib_breakpoint_ops;
15883 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15884 ops->dtor = dtor_catch_solib;
15885 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_solib;
15886 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_solib;
15887 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_solib;
15888 ops->check_status = check_status_catch_solib;
15889 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_solib;
15890 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_solib;
15891 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_solib;
15892 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_solib;
15893
15894 ops = &dprintf_breakpoint_ops;
15895 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15896 ops->re_set = dprintf_re_set;
15897 ops->resources_needed = bkpt_resources_needed;
15898 ops->print_it = bkpt_print_it;
15899 ops->print_mention = bkpt_print_mention;
15900 ops->print_recreate = dprintf_print_recreate;
15901 ops->after_condition_true = dprintf_after_condition_true;
15902 ops->breakpoint_hit = dprintf_breakpoint_hit;
15903 }
15904
15905 /* Chain containing all defined "enable breakpoint" subcommands. */
15906
15907 static struct cmd_list_element *enablebreaklist = NULL;
15908
15909 void
15910 _initialize_breakpoint (void)
15911 {
15912 struct cmd_list_element *c;
15913
15914 initialize_breakpoint_ops ();
15915
15916 observer_attach_solib_unloaded (disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib);
15917 observer_attach_free_objfile (disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile);
15918 observer_attach_memory_changed (invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change);
15919
15920 breakpoint_objfile_key
15921 = register_objfile_data_with_cleanup (NULL, free_breakpoint_probes);
15922
15923 breakpoint_chain = 0;
15924 /* Don't bother to call set_breakpoint_count. $bpnum isn't useful
15925 before a breakpoint is set. */
15926 breakpoint_count = 0;
15927
15928 tracepoint_count = 0;
15929
15930 add_com ("ignore", class_breakpoint, ignore_command, _("\
15931 Set ignore-count of breakpoint number N to COUNT.\n\
15932 Usage is `ignore N COUNT'."));
15933
15934 add_com ("commands", class_breakpoint, commands_command, _("\
15935 Set commands to be executed when a breakpoint is hit.\n\
15936 Give breakpoint number as argument after \"commands\".\n\
15937 With no argument, the targeted breakpoint is the last one set.\n\
15938 The commands themselves follow starting on the next line.\n\
15939 Type a line containing \"end\" to indicate the end of them.\n\
15940 Give \"silent\" as the first line to make the breakpoint silent;\n\
15941 then no output is printed when it is hit, except what the commands print."));
15942
15943 c = add_com ("condition", class_breakpoint, condition_command, _("\
15944 Specify breakpoint number N to break only if COND is true.\n\
15945 Usage is `condition N COND', where N is an integer and COND is an\n\
15946 expression to be evaluated whenever breakpoint N is reached."));
15947 set_cmd_completer (c, condition_completer);
15948
15949 c = add_com ("tbreak", class_breakpoint, tbreak_command, _("\
15950 Set a temporary breakpoint.\n\
15951 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
15952 so it will be deleted when hit. Equivalent to \"break\" followed\n\
15953 by using \"enable delete\" on the breakpoint number.\n\
15954 \n"
15955 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("tbreak")));
15956 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15957
15958 c = add_com ("hbreak", class_breakpoint, hbreak_command, _("\
15959 Set a hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
15960 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint requires hardware support,\n\
15961 some target hardware may not have this support.\n\
15962 \n"
15963 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("hbreak")));
15964 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15965
15966 c = add_com ("thbreak", class_breakpoint, thbreak_command, _("\
15967 Set a temporary hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
15968 Like \"hbreak\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
15969 so it will be deleted when hit.\n\
15970 \n"
15971 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("thbreak")));
15972 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15973
15974 add_prefix_cmd ("enable", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
15975 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
15976 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
15977 With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
15978 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
15979 With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."),
15980 &enablelist, "enable ", 1, &cmdlist);
15981
15982 add_com_alias ("en", "enable", class_breakpoint, 1);
15983
15984 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
15985 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
15986 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
15987 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
15988 May be abbreviated to simply \"enable\".\n"),
15989 &enablebreaklist, "enable breakpoints ", 1, &enablelist);
15990
15991 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
15992 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
15993 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
15994 &enablebreaklist);
15995
15996 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
15997 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
15998 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
15999 &enablebreaklist);
16000
16001 add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\
16002 Enable breakpoints for COUNT hits. Give count and then breakpoint numbers.\n\
16003 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\
16004 the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."),
16005 &enablebreaklist);
16006
16007 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
16008 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
16009 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
16010 &enablelist);
16011
16012 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
16013 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
16014 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
16015 &enablelist);
16016
16017 add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\
16018 Enable breakpoints for COUNT hits. Give count and then breakpoint numbers.\n\
16019 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\
16020 the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."),
16021 &enablelist);
16022
16023 add_prefix_cmd ("disable", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
16024 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
16025 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
16026 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
16027 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled."),
16028 &disablelist, "disable ", 1, &cmdlist);
16029 add_com_alias ("dis", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
16030 add_com_alias ("disa", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
16031
16032 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, disable_command, _("\
16033 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
16034 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
16035 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
16036 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled.\n\
16037 This command may be abbreviated \"disable\"."),
16038 &disablelist);
16039
16040 add_prefix_cmd ("delete", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
16041 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
16042 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
16043 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
16044 \n\
16045 Also a prefix command for deletion of other GDB objects.\n\
16046 The \"unset\" command is also an alias for \"delete\"."),
16047 &deletelist, "delete ", 1, &cmdlist);
16048 add_com_alias ("d", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
16049 add_com_alias ("del", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
16050
16051 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, delete_command, _("\
16052 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
16053 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
16054 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
16055 This command may be abbreviated \"delete\"."),
16056 &deletelist);
16057
16058 add_com ("clear", class_breakpoint, clear_command, _("\
16059 Clear breakpoint at specified location.\n\
16060 Argument may be a linespec, explicit, or address location as described below.\n\
16061 \n\
16062 With no argument, clears all breakpoints in the line that the selected frame\n\
16063 is executing in.\n"
16064 "\n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\
16065 See also the \"delete\" command which clears breakpoints by number."));
16066 add_com_alias ("cl", "clear", class_breakpoint, 1);
16067
16068 c = add_com ("break", class_breakpoint, break_command, _("\
16069 Set breakpoint at specified location.\n"
16070 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("break")));
16071 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16072
16073 add_com_alias ("b", "break", class_run, 1);
16074 add_com_alias ("br", "break", class_run, 1);
16075 add_com_alias ("bre", "break", class_run, 1);
16076 add_com_alias ("brea", "break", class_run, 1);
16077
16078 if (dbx_commands)
16079 {
16080 add_abbrev_prefix_cmd ("stop", class_breakpoint, stop_command, _("\
16081 Break in function/address or break at a line in the current file."),
16082 &stoplist, "stop ", 1, &cmdlist);
16083 add_cmd ("in", class_breakpoint, stopin_command,
16084 _("Break in function or address."), &stoplist);
16085 add_cmd ("at", class_breakpoint, stopat_command,
16086 _("Break at a line in the current file."), &stoplist);
16087 add_com ("status", class_info, breakpoints_info, _("\
16088 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
16089 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
16090 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
16091 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
16092 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
16093 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
16094 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
16095 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
16096 \n\
16097 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
16098 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
16099 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
16100 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
16101 breakpoint set."));
16102 }
16103
16104 add_info ("breakpoints", breakpoints_info, _("\
16105 Status of specified breakpoints (all user-settable breakpoints if no argument).\n\
16106 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
16107 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
16108 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
16109 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
16110 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
16111 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
16112 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
16113 \n\
16114 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
16115 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
16116 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
16117 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
16118 breakpoint set."));
16119
16120 add_info_alias ("b", "breakpoints", 1);
16121
16122 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_maintenance, maintenance_info_breakpoints, _("\
16123 Status of all breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
16124 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
16125 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
16126 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
16127 \tlongjmp - internal breakpoint used to step through longjmp()\n\
16128 \tlongjmp resume - internal breakpoint at the target of longjmp()\n\
16129 \tuntil - internal breakpoint used by the \"until\" command\n\
16130 \tfinish - internal breakpoint used by the \"finish\" command\n\
16131 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
16132 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
16133 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
16134 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
16135 \n\
16136 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
16137 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
16138 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
16139 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
16140 breakpoint set."),
16141 &maintenanceinfolist);
16142
16143 add_prefix_cmd ("catch", class_breakpoint, catch_command, _("\
16144 Set catchpoints to catch events."),
16145 &catch_cmdlist, "catch ",
16146 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
16147
16148 add_prefix_cmd ("tcatch", class_breakpoint, tcatch_command, _("\
16149 Set temporary catchpoints to catch events."),
16150 &tcatch_cmdlist, "tcatch ",
16151 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
16152
16153 add_catch_command ("fork", _("Catch calls to fork."),
16154 catch_fork_command_1,
16155 NULL,
16156 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_permanent,
16157 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_temporary);
16158 add_catch_command ("vfork", _("Catch calls to vfork."),
16159 catch_fork_command_1,
16160 NULL,
16161 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_permanent,
16162 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_temporary);
16163 add_catch_command ("exec", _("Catch calls to exec."),
16164 catch_exec_command_1,
16165 NULL,
16166 CATCH_PERMANENT,
16167 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
16168 add_catch_command ("load", _("Catch loads of shared libraries.\n\
16169 Usage: catch load [REGEX]\n\
16170 If REGEX is given, only stop for libraries matching the regular expression."),
16171 catch_load_command_1,
16172 NULL,
16173 CATCH_PERMANENT,
16174 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
16175 add_catch_command ("unload", _("Catch unloads of shared libraries.\n\
16176 Usage: catch unload [REGEX]\n\
16177 If REGEX is given, only stop for libraries matching the regular expression."),
16178 catch_unload_command_1,
16179 NULL,
16180 CATCH_PERMANENT,
16181 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
16182
16183 c = add_com ("watch", class_breakpoint, watch_command, _("\
16184 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
16185 Usage: watch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
16186 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
16187 an expression changes.\n\
16188 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
16189 the memory to which it refers."));
16190 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
16191
16192 c = add_com ("rwatch", class_breakpoint, rwatch_command, _("\
16193 Set a read watchpoint for an expression.\n\
16194 Usage: rwatch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
16195 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
16196 an expression is read.\n\
16197 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
16198 the memory to which it refers."));
16199 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
16200
16201 c = add_com ("awatch", class_breakpoint, awatch_command, _("\
16202 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
16203 Usage: awatch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
16204 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
16205 an expression is either read or written.\n\
16206 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
16207 the memory to which it refers."));
16208 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
16209
16210 add_info ("watchpoints", watchpoints_info, _("\
16211 Status of specified watchpoints (all watchpoints if no argument)."));
16212
16213 /* XXX: cagney/2005-02-23: This should be a boolean, and should
16214 respond to changes - contrary to the description. */
16215 add_setshow_zinteger_cmd ("can-use-hw-watchpoints", class_support,
16216 &can_use_hw_watchpoints, _("\
16217 Set debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
16218 Show debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
16219 If zero, gdb will not use hardware for new watchpoints, even if\n\
16220 such is available. (However, any hardware watchpoints that were\n\
16221 created before setting this to nonzero, will continue to use watchpoint\n\
16222 hardware.)"),
16223 NULL,
16224 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints,
16225 &setlist, &showlist);
16226
16227 can_use_hw_watchpoints = 1;
16228
16229 /* Tracepoint manipulation commands. */
16230
16231 c = add_com ("trace", class_breakpoint, trace_command, _("\
16232 Set a tracepoint at specified location.\n\
16233 \n"
16234 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("trace") "\n\
16235 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
16236 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16237
16238 add_com_alias ("tp", "trace", class_alias, 0);
16239 add_com_alias ("tr", "trace", class_alias, 1);
16240 add_com_alias ("tra", "trace", class_alias, 1);
16241 add_com_alias ("trac", "trace", class_alias, 1);
16242
16243 c = add_com ("ftrace", class_breakpoint, ftrace_command, _("\
16244 Set a fast tracepoint at specified location.\n\
16245 \n"
16246 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("ftrace") "\n\
16247 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
16248 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16249
16250 c = add_com ("strace", class_breakpoint, strace_command, _("\
16251 Set a static tracepoint at location or marker.\n\
16252 \n\
16253 strace [LOCATION] [if CONDITION]\n\
16254 LOCATION may be a linespec, explicit, or address location (described below) \n\
16255 or -m MARKER_ID.\n\n\
16256 If a marker id is specified, probe the marker with that name. With\n\
16257 no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected stack frame.\n\
16258 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action -- ``collect $_sdata''.\n\
16259 This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point call to the\n\
16260 tracing library. You can inspect it when analyzing the trace buffer,\n\
16261 by printing the $_sdata variable like any other convenience variable.\n\
16262 \n\
16263 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
16264 \n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\
16265 Multiple tracepoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
16266 conditions are different.\n\
16267 \n\
16268 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints.\n\
16269 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
16270 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16271
16272 add_info ("tracepoints", tracepoints_info, _("\
16273 Status of specified tracepoints (all tracepoints if no argument).\n\
16274 Convenience variable \"$tpnum\" contains the number of the\n\
16275 last tracepoint set."));
16276
16277 add_info_alias ("tp", "tracepoints", 1);
16278
16279 add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, delete_trace_command, _("\
16280 Delete specified tracepoints.\n\
16281 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
16282 No argument means delete all tracepoints."),
16283 &deletelist);
16284 add_alias_cmd ("tr", "tracepoints", class_trace, 1, &deletelist);
16285
16286 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, disable_trace_command, _("\
16287 Disable specified tracepoints.\n\
16288 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
16289 No argument means disable all tracepoints."),
16290 &disablelist);
16291 deprecate_cmd (c, "disable");
16292
16293 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, enable_trace_command, _("\
16294 Enable specified tracepoints.\n\
16295 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
16296 No argument means enable all tracepoints."),
16297 &enablelist);
16298 deprecate_cmd (c, "enable");
16299
16300 add_com ("passcount", class_trace, trace_pass_command, _("\
16301 Set the passcount for a tracepoint.\n\
16302 The trace will end when the tracepoint has been passed 'count' times.\n\
16303 Usage: passcount COUNT TPNUM, where TPNUM may also be \"all\";\n\
16304 if TPNUM is omitted, passcount refers to the last tracepoint defined."));
16305
16306 add_prefix_cmd ("save", class_breakpoint, save_command,
16307 _("Save breakpoint definitions as a script."),
16308 &save_cmdlist, "save ",
16309 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
16310
16311 c = add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, save_breakpoints_command, _("\
16312 Save current breakpoint definitions as a script.\n\
16313 This includes all types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints,\n\
16314 catchpoints, tracepoints). Use the 'source' command in another debug\n\
16315 session to restore them."),
16316 &save_cmdlist);
16317 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
16318
16319 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, save_tracepoints_command, _("\
16320 Save current tracepoint definitions as a script.\n\
16321 Use the 'source' command in another debug session to restore them."),
16322 &save_cmdlist);
16323 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
16324
16325 c = add_com_alias ("save-tracepoints", "save tracepoints", class_trace, 0);
16326 deprecate_cmd (c, "save tracepoints");
16327
16328 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, set_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
16329 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
16330 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
16331 pending breakpoint behavior"),
16332 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, "set breakpoint ",
16333 0/*allow-unknown*/, &setlist);
16334 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, show_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
16335 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
16336 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
16337 pending breakpoint behavior"),
16338 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist, "show breakpoint ",
16339 0/*allow-unknown*/, &showlist);
16340
16341 add_setshow_auto_boolean_cmd ("pending", no_class,
16342 &pending_break_support, _("\
16343 Set debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
16344 Show debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
16345 If on, an unrecognized breakpoint location will cause gdb to create a\n\
16346 pending breakpoint. If off, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in\n\
16347 an error. If auto, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in a\n\
16348 user-query to see if a pending breakpoint should be created."),
16349 NULL,
16350 show_pending_break_support,
16351 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
16352 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
16353
16354 pending_break_support = AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO;
16355
16356 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("auto-hw", no_class,
16357 &automatic_hardware_breakpoints, _("\
16358 Set automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
16359 Show automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
16360 If set, the debugger will automatically use hardware breakpoints for\n\
16361 breakpoints set with \"break\" but falling in read-only memory. If not set,\n\
16362 a warning will be emitted for such breakpoints."),
16363 NULL,
16364 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints,
16365 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
16366 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
16367
16368 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("always-inserted", class_support,
16369 &always_inserted_mode, _("\
16370 Set mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
16371 Show mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
16372 When this mode is on, breakpoints are inserted immediately as soon as\n\
16373 they're created, kept inserted even when execution stops, and removed\n\
16374 only when the user deletes them. When this mode is off (the default),\n\
16375 breakpoints are inserted only when execution continues, and removed\n\
16376 when execution stops."),
16377 NULL,
16378 &show_always_inserted_mode,
16379 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
16380 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
16381
16382 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("condition-evaluation", class_breakpoint,
16383 condition_evaluation_enums,
16384 &condition_evaluation_mode_1, _("\
16385 Set mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\
16386 Show mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\
16387 When this is set to \"host\", breakpoint conditions will be\n\
16388 evaluated on the host's side by GDB. When it is set to \"target\",\n\
16389 breakpoint conditions will be downloaded to the target (if the target\n\
16390 supports such feature) and conditions will be evaluated on the target's side.\n\
16391 If this is set to \"auto\" (default), this will be automatically set to\n\
16392 \"target\" if it supports condition evaluation, otherwise it will\n\
16393 be set to \"gdb\""),
16394 &set_condition_evaluation_mode,
16395 &show_condition_evaluation_mode,
16396 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
16397 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
16398
16399 add_com ("break-range", class_breakpoint, break_range_command, _("\
16400 Set a breakpoint for an address range.\n\
16401 break-range START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION\n\
16402 where START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION can be one of the following:\n\
16403 LINENUM, for that line in the current file,\n\
16404 FILE:LINENUM, for that line in that file,\n\
16405 +OFFSET, for that number of lines after the current line\n\
16406 or the start of the range\n\
16407 FUNCTION, for the first line in that function,\n\
16408 FILE:FUNCTION, to distinguish among like-named static functions.\n\
16409 *ADDRESS, for the instruction at that address.\n\
16410 \n\
16411 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it executes\n\
16412 an instruction at any address within the [START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION]\n\
16413 range (including START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION)."));
16414
16415 c = add_com ("dprintf", class_breakpoint, dprintf_command, _("\
16416 Set a dynamic printf at specified location.\n\
16417 dprintf location,format string,arg1,arg2,...\n\
16418 location may be a linespec, explicit, or address location.\n"
16419 "\n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING));
16420 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16421
16422 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("dprintf-style", class_support,
16423 dprintf_style_enums, &dprintf_style, _("\
16424 Set the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\
16425 Show the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\
16426 This setting chooses how GDB will do a dynamic printf.\n\
16427 If the value is \"gdb\", then the printing is done by GDB to its own\n\
16428 console, as with the \"printf\" command.\n\
16429 If the value is \"call\", the print is done by calling a function in your\n\
16430 program; by default printf(), but you can choose a different function or\n\
16431 output stream by setting dprintf-function and dprintf-channel."),
16432 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
16433 &setlist, &showlist);
16434
16435 dprintf_function = xstrdup ("printf");
16436 add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-function", class_support,
16437 &dprintf_function, _("\
16438 Set the function to use for dynamic printf"), _("\
16439 Show the function to use for dynamic printf"), NULL,
16440 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
16441 &setlist, &showlist);
16442
16443 dprintf_channel = xstrdup ("");
16444 add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-channel", class_support,
16445 &dprintf_channel, _("\
16446 Set the channel to use for dynamic printf"), _("\
16447 Show the channel to use for dynamic printf"), NULL,
16448 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
16449 &setlist, &showlist);
16450
16451 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("disconnected-dprintf", no_class,
16452 &disconnected_dprintf, _("\
16453 Set whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\
16454 Show whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\
16455 Use this to let dprintf commands continue to hit and produce output\n\
16456 even if GDB disconnects or detaches from the target."),
16457 NULL,
16458 NULL,
16459 &setlist, &showlist);
16460
16461 add_com ("agent-printf", class_vars, agent_printf_command, _("\
16462 agent-printf \"printf format string\", arg1, arg2, arg3, ..., argn\n\
16463 (target agent only) This is useful for formatted output in user-defined commands."));
16464
16465 automatic_hardware_breakpoints = 1;
16466
16467 observer_attach_about_to_proceed (breakpoint_about_to_proceed);
16468 observer_attach_thread_exit (remove_threaded_breakpoints);
16469 }
This page took 0.428916 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.